|
Public Act 095-0707 |
SB0783 Re-Enrolled |
LRB095 05523 BDD 25613 b |
|
|
AN ACT concerning State government.
|
Be it enacted by the People of the State of Illinois, |
represented in the General Assembly:
|
ARTICLE 1. SHORT TITLE; PURPOSE |
Section 1-1. Short title. This Act may be cited as the |
FY2008 Budget Implementation Act. |
Section 1-5. Purpose. It is the purpose of this Act to make |
changes in State programs that are necessary to implement the |
FY2008 budget. |
ARTICLE 3. STATE SERVICES ASSURANCE ACT FOR 2008 |
Section 3-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as the |
State Services Assurance Act for FY2008 , and references in this |
Article to "this Act" mean this Article. |
Section 3-5. Definitions. For the purposes of this Act: |
"Frontline staff" means State employees in the RC 6, RC 9, |
RC 10, RC 14, RC 28, RC 42, RC 62, RC 63, and CU 500 bargaining |
units in titles represented by AFSCME as of June 1, 2007. |
"On-board frontline staff" means frontline staff in paid |
status. |
|
Section 3-10. Legislative intent and policy. The General |
Assembly finds that State government delivers a myriad of |
services that are necessary for the health, welfare, safety, |
and quality of life of all Illinois residents. Because State |
services are used by many Illinois citizens who cannot speak |
the English language fluently, there is a need for bilingual |
State employees. The number of workers in State government who |
speak a language other than English is inadequate, leaving |
those workers who do speak another language overworked and |
incapable of meeting the rising demand for their services. |
In response to this crisis, it is the intent of the General |
Assembly in FY 2008 to ensure the hiring and retention of |
additional bilingual frontline staff in State agencies where |
public services are most used. These additions take into |
account our State's current revenue crisis, and are a first |
step. Raising bilingual staffing to meet higher national |
standards to fully ensure the effective delivery of essential |
services is the long-term goal of the General Assembly. |
Section 3-15. Staffing standards. On or before July 1, 2008 |
each named agency shall increase and maintain the number of |
bilingual on-board frontline staff over the levels that it |
maintained on June 30, 2007 as follows: |
(1) The Department of Corrections shall have at least |
40 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff. |
|
(2) Mental health and developmental centers operated |
by the Department of Human Services shall have at least 20 |
additional bilingual on-board frontline staff. |
(3) Family and Community Resource Centers operated by |
the Department of Human Services shall have at least 100 |
additional bilingual on-board frontline staff. |
(4) The Department of Children and Family Services |
shall have at least 40 additional bilingual on-board |
frontline staff. |
(5) The Department of Veterans Affairs shall have at |
least 5 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff. |
(6) The Environmental Protection Agency shall have at |
least 5 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff. |
(7) The Department of Employment Security shall have at |
least 10 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff. |
(8) The Department of Natural Resources shall have at |
least 5 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff. |
(9) The Department of Public Health shall have at least |
5 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff. |
(10) The Department of State Police shall have at least |
5 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff. |
(11) The Department of Juvenile Justice shall have at |
least 25 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff. |
Section 3-20. Accountability. On or before April 1, 2008 |
and each year thereafter, each executive branch agency, board, |
|
and commission shall prepare and submit a report to the General |
Assembly on the staffing level of bilingual employees. The |
report shall provide data from the previous month, including |
but not limited to each employees name, job title, job |
description, and languages spoken. |
ARTICLE 5. AMENDATORY PROVISIONS |
Section 5-1. The State Employees Group Insurance Act of |
1971 is amended by changing Section 10 as follows:
|
(5 ILCS 375/10) (from Ch. 127, par. 530)
|
Sec. 10. Payments by State; premiums.
|
(a) The State shall pay the cost of basic non-contributory |
group life
insurance and, subject to member paid contributions |
set by the Department or
required by this Section, the basic |
program of group health benefits on each
eligible member, |
except a member, not otherwise
covered by this Act, who has |
retired as a participating member under Article 2
of the |
Illinois Pension Code but is ineligible for the retirement |
annuity under
Section 2-119 of the Illinois Pension Code, and |
part of each eligible member's
and retired member's premiums |
for health insurance coverage for enrolled
dependents as |
provided by Section 9. The State shall pay the cost of the |
basic
program of group health benefits only after benefits are |
reduced by the amount
of benefits covered by Medicare for all |
|
members and dependents
who are eligible for benefits under |
Social Security or
the Railroad Retirement system or who had |
sufficient Medicare-covered
government employment, except that |
such reduction in benefits shall apply only
to those members |
and dependents who (1) first become eligible
for such Medicare |
coverage on or after July 1, 1992; or (2) are
Medicare-eligible |
members or dependents of a local government unit which began
|
participation in the program on or after July 1, 1992; or (3) |
remain eligible
for, but no longer receive Medicare coverage |
which they had been receiving on
or after July 1, 1992. The |
Department may determine the aggregate level of the
State's |
contribution on the basis of actual cost of medical services |
adjusted
for age, sex or geographic or other demographic |
characteristics which affect
the costs of such programs.
|
The cost of participation in the basic program of group |
health benefits
for the dependent or survivor of a living or |
deceased retired employee who was
formerly employed by the |
University of Illinois in the Cooperative Extension
Service and |
would be an annuitant but for the fact that he or she was made
|
ineligible to participate in the State Universities Retirement |
System by clause
(4) of subsection (a) of Section 15-107 of the |
Illinois Pension Code shall not
be greater than the cost of |
participation that would otherwise apply to that
dependent or |
survivor if he or she were the dependent or survivor of an
|
annuitant under the State Universities Retirement System.
|
(a-1) Beginning January 1, 1998, for each person who |
|
becomes a new SERS
annuitant and participates in the basic |
program of group health benefits, the
State shall contribute |
toward the cost of the annuitant's
coverage under the basic |
program of group health benefits an amount equal
to 5% of that |
cost for each full year of creditable service upon which the
|
annuitant's retirement annuity is based, up to a maximum of |
100% for an
annuitant with 20 or more years of creditable |
service.
The remainder of the cost of a new SERS annuitant's |
coverage under the basic
program of group health benefits shall |
be the responsibility of the
annuitant. In the case of a new |
SERS annuitant who has elected to receive an alternative |
retirement cancellation payment under Section 14-108.5 of the |
Illinois Pension Code in lieu of an annuity, for the purposes |
of this subsection the annuitant shall be deemed to be |
receiving a retirement annuity based on the number of years of |
creditable service that the annuitant had established at the |
time of his or her termination of service under SERS.
|
(a-2) Beginning January 1, 1998, for each person who |
becomes a new SERS
survivor and participates in the basic |
program of group health benefits, the
State shall contribute |
toward the cost of the survivor's
coverage under the basic |
program of group health benefits an amount equal
to 5% of that |
cost for each full year of the deceased employee's or deceased
|
annuitant's creditable service in the State Employees' |
Retirement System of
Illinois on the date of death, up to a |
maximum of 100% for a survivor of an
employee or annuitant with |
|
20 or more years of creditable service. The
remainder of the |
cost of the new SERS survivor's coverage under the basic
|
program of group health benefits shall be the responsibility of |
the survivor. In the case of a new SERS survivor who was the |
dependent of an annuitant who elected to receive an alternative |
retirement cancellation payment under Section 14-108.5 of the |
Illinois Pension Code in lieu of an annuity, for the purposes |
of this subsection the deceased annuitant's creditable service |
shall be determined as of the date of termination of service |
rather than the date of death.
|
(a-3) Beginning January 1, 1998, for each person who |
becomes a new SURS
annuitant and participates in the basic |
program of group health benefits, the
State shall contribute |
toward the cost of the annuitant's
coverage under the basic |
program of group health benefits an amount equal
to 5% of that |
cost for each full year of creditable service upon which the
|
annuitant's retirement annuity is based, up to a maximum of |
100% for an
annuitant with 20 or more years of creditable |
service.
The remainder of the cost of a new SURS annuitant's |
coverage under the basic
program of group health benefits shall |
be the responsibility of the
annuitant.
|
(a-4) (Blank).
|
(a-5) Beginning January 1, 1998, for each person who |
becomes a new SURS
survivor and participates in the basic |
program of group health benefits, the
State shall contribute |
toward the cost of the survivor's coverage under the
basic |
|
program of group health benefits an amount equal to 5% of that |
cost for
each full year of the deceased employee's or deceased |
annuitant's creditable
service in the State Universities |
Retirement System on the date of death, up to
a maximum of 100% |
for a survivor of an
employee or annuitant with 20 or more |
years of creditable service. The
remainder of the cost of the |
new SURS survivor's coverage under the basic
program of group |
health benefits shall be the responsibility of the survivor.
|
(a-6) Beginning July 1, 1998, for each person who becomes a |
new TRS
State annuitant and participates in the basic program |
of group health benefits,
the State shall contribute toward the |
cost of the annuitant's coverage under
the basic program of |
group health benefits an amount equal to 5% of that cost
for |
each full year of creditable service
as a teacher as defined in |
paragraph (2), (3), or (5) of Section 16-106 of the
Illinois |
Pension Code
upon which the annuitant's retirement annuity is |
based, up to a maximum of
100%;
except that
the State |
contribution shall be 12.5% per year (rather than 5%) for each |
full
year of creditable service as a regional superintendent or |
assistant regional
superintendent of schools. The
remainder of |
the cost of a new TRS State annuitant's coverage under the |
basic
program of group health benefits shall be the |
responsibility of the
annuitant.
|
(a-7) Beginning July 1, 1998, for each person who becomes a |
new TRS
State survivor and participates in the basic program of |
group health benefits,
the State shall contribute toward the |
|
cost of the survivor's coverage under the
basic program of |
group health benefits an amount equal to 5% of that cost for
|
each full year of the deceased employee's or deceased |
annuitant's creditable
service
as a teacher as defined in |
paragraph (2), (3), or (5) of Section 16-106 of the
Illinois |
Pension Code
on the date of death, up to a maximum of 100%;
|
except that the State contribution shall be 12.5% per year |
(rather than 5%) for
each full year of the deceased employee's |
or deceased annuitant's creditable
service as a regional |
superintendent or assistant regional superintendent of
|
schools.
The remainder of
the cost of the new TRS State |
survivor's coverage under the basic program of
group health |
benefits shall be the responsibility of the survivor.
|
(a-8) A new SERS annuitant, new SERS survivor, new SURS
|
annuitant, new SURS survivor, new TRS State
annuitant, or new |
TRS State survivor may waive or terminate coverage in
the |
program of group health benefits. Any such annuitant or |
survivor
who has waived or terminated coverage may enroll or |
re-enroll in the
program of group health benefits only during |
the annual benefit choice period,
as determined by the |
Director; except that in the event of termination of
coverage |
due to nonpayment of premiums, the annuitant or survivor
may |
not re-enroll in the program.
|
(a-9) No later than May 1 of each calendar year, the |
Director
of Central Management Services shall certify in |
writing to the Executive
Secretary of the State Employees' |
|
Retirement System of Illinois the amounts
of the Medicare |
supplement health care premiums and the amounts of the
health |
care premiums for all other retirees who are not Medicare |
eligible.
|
A separate calculation of the premiums based upon the |
actual cost of each
health care plan shall be so certified.
|
The Director of Central Management Services shall provide |
to the
Executive Secretary of the State Employees' Retirement |
System of
Illinois such information, statistics, and other data |
as he or she
may require to review the premium amounts |
certified by the Director
of Central Management Services.
|
The Department of Healthcare and Family Services, or any |
successor agency designated to procure healthcare contracts |
pursuant to this Act, is authorized to establish funds, |
separate accounts provided by any bank or banks as defined by |
the Illinois Banking Act, or separate accounts provided by any |
savings and loan association or associations as defined by the |
Illinois Savings and Loan Act of 1985 to be held by the |
Director, outside the State treasury, for the purpose of |
receiving the transfer of moneys from the Local Government |
Health Insurance Reserve Fund. The Department may promulgate |
rules further defining the methodology for the transfers. Any |
interest earned by moneys in the funds or accounts shall inure |
to the Local Government Health Insurance Reserve Fund. The |
transferred moneys, and interest accrued thereon, shall be used |
exclusively for transfers to administrative service |
|
organizations or their financial institutions for payments of |
claims to claimants and providers under the self-insurance |
health plan. The transferred moneys, and interest accrued |
thereon, shall not be used for any other purpose including, but |
not limited to, reimbursement of administration fees due the |
administrative service organization pursuant to its contract |
or contracts with the Department.
|
(b) State employees who become eligible for this program on |
or after January
1, 1980 in positions normally requiring actual |
performance of duty not less
than 1/2 of a normal work period |
but not equal to that of a normal work period,
shall be given |
the option of participating in the available program. If the
|
employee elects coverage, the State shall contribute on behalf |
of such employee
to the cost of the employee's benefit and any |
applicable dependent supplement,
that sum which bears the same |
percentage as that percentage of time the
employee regularly |
works when compared to normal work period.
|
(c) The basic non-contributory coverage from the basic |
program of
group health benefits shall be continued for each |
employee not in pay status or
on active service by reason of |
(1) leave of absence due to illness or injury,
(2) authorized |
educational leave of absence or sabbatical leave, or (3)
|
military leave with pay and benefits. This coverage shall |
continue until
expiration of authorized leave and return to |
active service, but not to exceed
24 months for leaves under |
item (1) or (2). This 24-month limitation and the
requirement |
|
of returning to active service shall not apply to persons |
receiving
ordinary or accidental disability benefits or |
retirement benefits through the
appropriate State retirement |
system or benefits under the Workers' Compensation
or |
Occupational Disease Act.
|
(d) The basic group life insurance coverage shall continue, |
with
full State contribution, where such person is (1) absent |
from active
service by reason of disability arising from any |
cause other than
self-inflicted, (2) on authorized educational |
leave of absence or
sabbatical leave, or (3) on military leave |
with pay and benefits.
|
(e) Where the person is in non-pay status for a period in |
excess of
30 days or on leave of absence, other than by reason |
of disability,
educational or sabbatical leave, or military |
leave with pay and benefits, such
person may continue coverage |
only by making personal
payment equal to the amount normally |
contributed by the State on such person's
behalf. Such payments |
and coverage may be continued: (1) until such time as
the |
person returns to a status eligible for coverage at State |
expense, but not
to exceed 24 months, (2) until such person's |
employment or annuitant status
with the State is terminated, or |
(3) for a maximum period of 4 years for
members on military |
leave with pay and benefits and military leave without pay
and |
benefits (exclusive of any additional service imposed pursuant |
to law).
|
(f) The Department shall establish by rule the extent to |
|
which other
employee benefits will continue for persons in |
non-pay status or who are
not in active service.
|
(g) The State shall not pay the cost of the basic |
non-contributory
group life insurance, program of health |
benefits and other employee benefits
for members who are |
survivors as defined by paragraphs (1) and (2) of
subsection |
(q) of Section 3 of this Act. The costs of benefits for these
|
survivors shall be paid by the survivors or by the University |
of Illinois
Cooperative Extension Service, or any combination |
thereof.
However, the State shall pay the amount of the |
reduction in the cost of
participation, if any, resulting from |
the amendment to subsection (a) made
by this amendatory Act of |
the 91st General Assembly.
|
(h) Those persons occupying positions with any department |
as a result
of emergency appointments pursuant to Section 8b.8 |
of the Personnel Code
who are not considered employees under |
this Act shall be given the option
of participating in the |
programs of group life insurance, health benefits and
other |
employee benefits. Such persons electing coverage may |
participate only
by making payment equal to the amount normally |
contributed by the State for
similarly situated employees. Such |
amounts shall be determined by the
Director. Such payments and |
coverage may be continued until such time as the
person becomes |
an employee pursuant to this Act or such person's appointment |
is
terminated.
|
(i) Any unit of local government within the State of |
|
Illinois
may apply to the Director to have its employees, |
annuitants, and their
dependents provided group health |
coverage under this Act on a non-insured
basis. To participate, |
a unit of local government must agree to enroll
all of its |
employees, who may select coverage under either the State group
|
health benefits plan or a health maintenance organization that |
has
contracted with the State to be available as a health care |
provider for
employees as defined in this Act. A unit of local |
government must remit the
entire cost of providing coverage |
under the State group health benefits plan
or, for coverage |
under a health maintenance organization, an amount determined
|
by the Director based on an analysis of the sex, age, |
geographic location, or
other relevant demographic variables |
for its employees, except that the unit of
local government |
shall not be required to enroll those of its employees who are
|
covered spouses or dependents under this plan or another group |
policy or plan
providing health benefits as long as (1) an |
appropriate official from the unit
of local government attests |
that each employee not enrolled is a covered spouse
or |
dependent under this plan or another group policy or plan, and |
(2) at least
85% of the employees are enrolled and the unit of |
local government remits
the entire cost of providing coverage |
to those employees, except that a
participating school district |
must have enrolled at least 85% of its full-time
employees who |
have not waived coverage under the district's group health
plan |
by participating in a component of the district's cafeteria |
|
plan. A
participating school district is not required to enroll |
a full-time employee
who has waived coverage under the |
district's health plan, provided that an
appropriate official |
from the participating school district attests that the
|
full-time employee has waived coverage by participating in a |
component of the
district's cafeteria plan. For the purposes of |
this subsection, "participating
school district" includes a |
unit of local government whose primary purpose is
education as |
defined by the Department's rules.
|
Employees of a participating unit of local government who |
are not enrolled
due to coverage under another group health |
policy or plan may enroll in
the event of a qualifying change |
in status, special enrollment, special
circumstance as defined |
by the Director, or during the annual Benefit Choice
Period. A |
participating unit of local government may also elect to cover |
its
annuitants. Dependent coverage shall be offered on an |
optional basis, with the
costs paid by the unit of local |
government, its employees, or some combination
of the two as |
determined by the unit of local government. The unit of local
|
government shall be responsible for timely collection and |
transmission of
dependent premiums.
|
The Director shall annually determine monthly rates of |
payment, subject
to the following constraints:
|
(1) In the first year of coverage, the rates shall be |
equal to the
amount normally charged to State employees for |
elected optional coverages
or for enrolled dependents |
|
coverages or other contributory coverages, or
contributed |
by the State for basic insurance coverages on behalf of its
|
employees, adjusted for differences between State |
employees and employees
of the local government in age, |
sex, geographic location or other relevant
demographic |
variables, plus an amount sufficient to pay for the |
additional
administrative costs of providing coverage to |
employees of the unit of
local government and their |
dependents.
|
(2) In subsequent years, a further adjustment shall be |
made to reflect
the actual prior years' claims experience |
of the employees of the unit of
local government.
|
In the case of coverage of local government employees under |
a health
maintenance organization, the Director shall annually |
determine for each
participating unit of local government the |
maximum monthly amount the unit
may contribute toward that |
coverage, based on an analysis of (i) the age,
sex, geographic |
location, and other relevant demographic variables of the
|
unit's employees and (ii) the cost to cover those employees |
under the State
group health benefits plan. The Director may |
similarly determine the
maximum monthly amount each unit of |
local government may contribute toward
coverage of its |
employees' dependents under a health maintenance organization.
|
Monthly payments by the unit of local government or its |
employees for
group health benefits plan or health maintenance |
organization coverage shall
be deposited in the Local |
|
Government Health Insurance Reserve Fund.
|
The Local Government Health Insurance Reserve Fund is |
hereby created as a nonappropriated trust fund to be held |
outside the State Treasury, with the State Treasurer as |
custodian. The Local Government Health Insurance Reserve Fund |
shall be a continuing
fund not subject to fiscal year |
limitations. All revenues arising from the administration of |
the health benefits program established under this Section |
shall be deposited into the Local Government Health Insurance |
Reserve Fund. Any interest earned on moneys in the Local |
Government Health Insurance Reserve Fund shall be deposited |
into the Fund. All expenditures from this Fund
shall be used |
for payments for health care benefits for local government and |
rehabilitation facility
employees, annuitants, and dependents, |
and to reimburse the Department or
its administrative service |
organization for all expenses incurred in the
administration of |
benefits. No other State funds may be used for these
purposes.
|
A local government employer's participation or desire to |
participate
in a program created under this subsection shall |
not limit that employer's
duty to bargain with the |
representative of any collective bargaining unit
of its |
employees.
|
(j) Any rehabilitation facility within the State of |
Illinois may apply
to the Director to have its employees, |
annuitants, and their eligible
dependents provided group |
health coverage under this Act on a non-insured
basis. To |
|
participate, a rehabilitation facility must agree to enroll all
|
of its employees and remit the entire cost of providing such |
coverage for
its employees, except that the rehabilitation |
facility shall not be
required to enroll those of its employees |
who are covered spouses or
dependents under this plan or |
another group policy or plan providing health
benefits as long |
as (1) an appropriate official from the rehabilitation
facility |
attests that each employee not enrolled is a covered spouse or
|
dependent under this plan or another group policy or plan, and |
(2) at least
85% of the employees are enrolled and the |
rehabilitation facility remits
the entire cost of providing |
coverage to those employees. Employees of a
participating |
rehabilitation facility who are not enrolled due to coverage
|
under another group health policy or plan may enroll
in the |
event of a qualifying change in status, special enrollment, |
special
circumstance as defined by the Director, or during the |
annual Benefit Choice
Period. A participating rehabilitation |
facility may also elect
to cover its annuitants. Dependent |
coverage shall be offered on an optional
basis, with the costs |
paid by the rehabilitation facility, its employees, or
some |
combination of the 2 as determined by the rehabilitation |
facility. The
rehabilitation facility shall be responsible for |
timely collection and
transmission of dependent premiums.
|
The Director shall annually determine quarterly rates of |
payment, subject
to the following constraints:
|
(1) In the first year of coverage, the rates shall be |
|
equal to the amount
normally charged to State employees for |
elected optional coverages or for
enrolled dependents |
coverages or other contributory coverages on behalf of
its |
employees, adjusted for differences between State |
employees and
employees of the rehabilitation facility in |
age, sex, geographic location
or other relevant |
demographic variables, plus an amount sufficient to pay
for |
the additional administrative costs of providing coverage |
to employees
of the rehabilitation facility and their |
dependents.
|
(2) In subsequent years, a further adjustment shall be |
made to reflect
the actual prior years' claims experience |
of the employees of the
rehabilitation facility.
|
Monthly payments by the rehabilitation facility or its |
employees for
group health benefits shall be deposited in the |
Local Government Health
Insurance Reserve Fund.
|
(k) Any domestic violence shelter or service within the |
State of Illinois
may apply to the Director to have its |
employees, annuitants, and their
dependents provided group |
health coverage under this Act on a non-insured
basis. To |
participate, a domestic violence shelter or service must agree |
to
enroll all of its employees and pay the entire cost of |
providing such coverage
for its employees. A participating |
domestic violence shelter may also elect
to cover its |
annuitants. Dependent coverage shall be offered on an optional
|
basis, with
employees, or some combination of the 2 as |
|
determined by the domestic violence
shelter or service. The |
domestic violence shelter or service shall be
responsible for |
timely collection and transmission of dependent premiums.
|
The Director shall annually determine rates of payment,
|
subject to the following constraints:
|
(1) In the first year of coverage, the rates shall be |
equal to the
amount normally charged to State employees for |
elected optional coverages
or for enrolled dependents |
coverages or other contributory coverages on
behalf of its |
employees, adjusted for differences between State |
employees and
employees of the domestic violence shelter or |
service in age, sex, geographic
location or other relevant |
demographic variables, plus an amount sufficient
to pay for |
the additional administrative costs of providing coverage |
to
employees of the domestic violence shelter or service |
and their dependents.
|
(2) In subsequent years, a further adjustment shall be |
made to reflect
the actual prior years' claims experience |
of the employees of the domestic
violence shelter or |
service.
|
Monthly payments by the domestic violence shelter or |
service or its employees
for group health insurance shall be |
deposited in the Local Government Health
Insurance Reserve |
Fund.
|
(l) A public community college or entity organized pursuant |
to the
Public Community College Act may apply to the Director |
|
initially to have
only annuitants not covered prior to July 1, |
1992 by the district's health
plan provided health coverage |
under this Act on a non-insured basis. The
community college |
must execute a 2-year contract to participate in the
Local |
Government Health Plan.
Any annuitant may enroll in the event |
of a qualifying change in status, special
enrollment, special |
circumstance as defined by the Director, or during the
annual |
Benefit Choice Period.
|
The Director shall annually determine monthly rates of |
payment subject to
the following constraints: for those |
community colleges with annuitants
only enrolled, first year |
rates shall be equal to the average cost to cover
claims for a |
State member adjusted for demographics, Medicare
|
participation, and other factors; and in the second year, a |
further adjustment
of rates shall be made to reflect the actual |
first year's claims experience
of the covered annuitants.
|
(l-5) The provisions of subsection (l) become inoperative |
on July 1, 1999.
|
(m) The Director shall adopt any rules deemed necessary for
|
implementation of this amendatory Act of 1989 (Public Act |
86-978).
|
(n) Any child advocacy center within the State of Illinois |
may apply to the Director to have its employees, annuitants, |
and their dependents provided group health coverage under this |
Act on a non-insured basis. To participate, a child advocacy |
center must agree to enroll all of its employees and pay the |
|
entire cost of providing coverage for its employees. A |
participating child advocacy center may also elect to cover its |
annuitants. Dependent coverage shall be offered on an optional |
basis, with the costs paid by the child advocacy center, its |
employees, or some combination of the 2 as determined by the |
child advocacy center. The child advocacy center shall be |
responsible for timely collection and transmission of |
dependent premiums. |
The Director shall annually determine rates of payment, |
subject to the following constraints: |
(1) In the first year of coverage, the rates shall be |
equal to the amount normally charged to State employees for |
elected optional coverages or for enrolled dependents |
coverages or other contributory coverages on behalf of its |
employees, adjusted for differences between State |
employees and employees of the child advocacy center in |
age, sex, geographic location, or other relevant |
demographic variables, plus an amount sufficient to pay for |
the additional administrative costs of providing coverage |
to employees of the child advocacy center and their |
dependents. |
(2) In subsequent years, a further adjustment shall be |
made to reflect the actual prior years' claims experience |
of the employees of the child advocacy center. |
Monthly payments by the child advocacy center or its |
employees for group health insurance shall be deposited into |
|
the Local Government Health Insurance Reserve Fund. |
(Source: P.A. 94-839, eff. 6-6-06; 94-860, eff. 6-16-06; |
95-331, eff. 8-21-07; 95-632, eff. 9-25-07.)
|
Section 5-5. The Mental Health and Developmental |
Disabilities Administrative Act is amended by changing |
Sections 18.4, 18.5, and 57.5 as follows:
|
(20 ILCS 1705/18.4)
|
Sec. 18.4. Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund; |
reimbursement.
|
(a) The Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund is |
hereby created
in the State Treasury.
|
(b) Amounts
Except as otherwise provided in this Section, |
following repayment of interfund transfers under subsection |
(b-1), amounts paid to the State during each State fiscal year |
by the federal government under Title XIX
or Title XXI of the |
Social Security Act for services delivered by community
mental |
health providers, and any interest earned thereon, shall be
|
deposited as follows: |
(1) The first $75,000,000 shall be deposited directly |
into the Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund to be |
used for the purchase of community mental health services; |
(2) The next $4,500,000 shall be deposited directly |
into the Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund to be |
used by the Department of Human Services' Division of |
|
Mental Health for the oversight and administration of |
community mental health services and up to $1,000,000 of |
this amount may be used for support of community mental |
health service initiatives; and |
(3) The next $3,500,000 shall be deposited directly |
into the General Revenue Fund;
|
(4) Any additional amounts shall be deposited 50% into |
the Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund to be used |
for the purchase of community mental health services and |
50% into the General Revenue Fund .
|
(b-1) For State fiscal year 2005, the first $73,000,000 in |
any funds paid to the State by the federal government under |
Title XIX or Title XXI of the Social Security Act for services |
delivered by community mental health services providers, and |
any interest earned thereon, shall be deposited directly into |
the Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund before any |
deposits are made into the General Revenue Fund. The next |
$25,000,000, less any deposits made prior to the effective date |
of this amendatory Act of the 94th General Assembly, shall be |
deposited into the General Revenue Fund. Amounts received in |
excess of $98,000,000 shall be deposited 50% into the General |
Revenue Fund and 50% into the Community Mental Health Medicaid |
Trust Fund. At the direction of the Director of Healthcare and |
Family Services, on April 1, 2005, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the Comptroller shall direct and the State Treasurer |
shall transfer amounts not to exceed $14,000,000 into the |
|
Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust
Fund from the Public Aid |
Recoveries Trust Fund. |
(b-2) For State fiscal year 2006, and in subsequent fiscal |
years until any transfers under subsection (b-1) are repaid, |
the first $73,000,000 in any funds paid to the State by the |
federal government under Title XIX or Title XXI of the Social |
Security Act for services delivered by community mental health |
providers, and any interest earned thereon, shall be deposited |
directly into the Community Mental Health Medicaid
Trust Fund. |
Then the next $14,000,000, or such amount as was transferred |
under subsection (b-1) at the direction of the Director of |
Healthcare and Family Services, shall be deposited into the |
Public Aid Recoveries Trust Fund.
Any additional amounts |
received shall be deposited in accordance with subsection (b).
|
(c) The Department shall reimburse community mental health
|
providers for
services provided to eligible
individuals. |
Moneys in the Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund may |
be
used for that purpose.
|
(d) As used in this Section:
|
"Community mental health provider" means a community |
agency that is funded by the Department to
provide a service.
|
"Service" means a mental health service
provided pursuant |
to the provisions of administrative rules adopted by the |
Department and funded by the Department of Human Services' |
Division of Mental Health.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-841, eff. 7-30-04; 94-58, eff. 6-17-05; |
|
94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
|
(20 ILCS 1705/18.5) |
Sec. 18.5. Community Developmental Disability Services |
Medicaid Trust Fund; reimbursement. |
(a) The Community Developmental Disability Services |
Medicaid Trust Fund is hereby created in the State treasury.
|
(b) Except as provided in subsection (b-5), any Any funds |
in excess of $16,700,000 in any fiscal year paid to the State |
by the federal government under Title XIX or Title XXI of the |
Social Security Act for services delivered by community |
developmental disability services providers for services |
relating to Developmental Training and Community Integrated |
Living Arrangements as a result of the conversion of such |
providers from a grant payment methodology to a fee-for-service |
payment methodology, or any other funds paid to the State for |
any subsequent revenue maximization initiatives performed by |
such providers, and any interest earned thereon, shall be |
deposited directly into the Community Developmental Disability |
Services Medicaid Trust Fund. One-third of this amount shall be |
used only to pay for Medicaid-reimbursed community |
developmental disability services provided to eligible |
individuals, and the remainder shall be transferred to the |
General Revenue Fund. |
(b-5) Beginning in State fiscal year 2008, any funds paid |
to the State by the federal government under Title XIX or Title |
|
XXI of the Social Security Act for services delivered through |
the Children's Residential Waiver and the Children's In-Home |
Support Waiver shall be deposited directly into the Community |
Developmental Disability Services Medicaid Trust Fund and |
shall not be subject to the transfer provisions of subsection |
(b). |
(c) For purposes of this Section: |
"Medicaid-reimbursed developmental disability services" |
means services provided by a community developmental |
disability provider under an agreement with the Department that |
is eligible for reimbursement under the federal Title XIX |
program or Title XXI program. |
"Provider" means a qualified entity as defined in the |
State's Home and
Community-Based Services Waiver for Persons |
with Developmental Disabilities that is funded by the |
Department to provide a Medicaid-reimbursed service. |
"Revenue maximization alternatives" do not include |
increases in
funds paid to the State as a result of growth in |
spending through service expansion or
rate increases.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-841, eff. 7-30-04.)
|
(20 ILCS 1705/57.5)
|
Sec. 57.5. Autism diagnosis education program.
|
(a) Subject to appropriations, the Department shall |
contract to establish an
autism
diagnosis
education program for |
young children. The Department
shall
establish the program at 3 |
|
different sites in the State. The program shall have
the
|
following goals:
|
(1) Providing, to medical professionals and others |
statewide, a systems
development initiative that promotes |
best practice standards for the diagnosis
and
treatment |
planning for young children who have autism
spectrum |
disorders, for the purpose of helping existing systems of |
care to
build
solid circles of expertise within their |
ranks.
|
(2) Educating medical practitioners, school personnel, |
day care providers,
parents, and community service |
providers (including, but not limited to, early
|
intervention and developmental disabilities providers) |
throughout the State on
appropriate diagnosis and |
treatment of autism.
|
(3) Supporting systems of care for young children with |
autism spectrum
disorders.
|
(4) Working together with universities and |
developmental disabilities
providers to identify unmet |
needs and resources.
|
(5) Encouraging and supporting research on optional |
services for young
children with autism spectrum |
disorders.
|
In addition to the aforementioned items, on January 1, |
2008, The Autism Program shall expand training and direct |
services by deploying additional regional centers, outreach |
|
centers, and community planning and network development |
initiatives. The expanded Autism Program Service Network shall |
consist of a comprehensive program of outreach and center |
development utilizing model programs developed by The Autism |
Program. This expansion shall span Illinois and support |
consensus building, outreach, and service provision for |
children with autism spectrums disorders and their families. |
(b) Before January 1, 2006, the Department shall report to |
the Governor and
the
General Assembly concerning the progress |
of the autism diagnosis education
program
established under |
this Section.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-395, eff. 7-29-03.)
|
Section 5-7. The Hospital Basic Services Preservation Act |
is amended by changing Sections 5 and 20 as follows: |
(20 ILCS 4050/5)
|
Sec. 5. Definitions. As used in this Act: |
"Basic services" means emergency room and obstetrical |
services provided within a hospital. "Basic services" is |
limited to the emergency and obstetric units and services |
provided by those units. |
"Eligible expenses" means expenses for expanding |
obstetrical or emergency units, updating equipment, repairing |
essential equipment, and purchasing new equipment that will |
increase the quality of basic services provided. "Eligible |
|
expenses" does not include expenses related to cosmetic |
upgrades, staff expansion or salary, or structural expansion of |
any unit or department of a hospital other than obstetrical or |
emergency units . |
"Essential community hospital provider" means a facility |
meeting criteria established by rule by the State Treasurer.
|
(Source: P.A. 94-648, eff. 1-1-06.) |
(20 ILCS 4050/20)
|
Sec. 20. Responsibility of hospitals. Each hospital that |
receives a loan collateralized under this Act shall take the |
necessary measures, as defined by the State Treasurer by rule, |
to account for all moneys and to ensure that they are spent on |
the basic services for which the loan was approved. Any |
hospital receiving a loan collateralized under this Act is not |
eligible for collateralization of another basic services loan |
under this Act within 10 years after the deposit of funds |
awarded under the first collateralized loan.
|
(Source: P.A. 94-648, eff. 1-1-06.)
|
Section 5-10. The State Finance Act is amended by changing |
Sections 6z-65.5, 6z-66, 6z-67, 8.3, 8.27, 8g, 13.2, and 14.1 |
and by adding Sections 5.675, 5.676, 5.677, 5.678, 6z-69, |
6z-70, and 25.5 as follows: |
(30 ILCS 105/5.675 new) |
|
Sec. 5.675. The Human Services Priority Capital Program |
Fund. |
(30 ILCS 105/5.676 new)
|
Sec. 5.676. The Predatory Lending Database Program Fund. |
(30 ILCS 105/5.677 new)
|
Sec. 5.677. The Secretary of State Identification Security |
and Theft Prevention Fund.
|
(30 ILCS 105/5.678 new)
|
Sec. 5.678. The Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty |
Administration Fund.
|
(30 ILCS 105/6z-65.5)
|
Sec. 6z-65.5. SBE Federal Department of Education Fund. The |
SBE Federal Department of Education Fund is created as a |
federal trust fund in the State treasury. This fund is |
established to receive funds from the federal Department of |
Education, including non-indirect cost administrative funds |
recovered from federal programs, for the specific purposes |
established by the terms and conditions of federal awards. |
Moneys in the SBE Federal Department of Education Fund shall be |
used, subject to appropriation by the General Assembly, for |
grants and contracts to local education agencies, colleges and |
universities, and other State agencies and for administrative |
|
expenses of the State Board of Education. However, |
non-appropriated spending is allowed for the refund of |
unexpended grant moneys to the federal government. The SBE |
Federal Department of Education Fund shall serve as the |
successor fund to the National Center for Education Statistics |
Fund, and any balance remaining in the National Center for |
Education Statistics Fund on the effective date of this |
amendatory Act of the 94th General Assembly must be transferred |
to the SBE Federal Department of Education Fund by the State |
Treasurer. Any future deposits that would otherwise be made |
into the National Center for Education Statistics Fund must |
instead be made into the SBE Federal Department of Education |
Fund.
|
On or after July 1, 2007, the State Board of Education |
shall notify the State Comptroller of the amount of indirect |
federal funds in the SBE Federal Department of Education Fund |
to be transferred to the State Board of Education Special |
Purpose Trust Fund. The State Comptroller shall direct and the |
State Treasurer shall transfer this amount to the State Board |
of Education Special Purpose Trust Fund as soon as practical |
thereafter. |
(Source: P.A. 93-838, eff. 7-30-04; 94-69, eff. 7-1-05.)
|
(30 ILCS 105/6z-66) |
Sec. 6z-66. SBE Federal Agency Services Fund. The SBE |
Federal Agency Services Fund is created as a federal trust fund |
|
in the State treasury. This fund is established to receive |
funds from all federal departments and agencies except the |
Departments of Education and Agriculture (including among |
others the Departments of Health and Human Services, Defense, |
and Labor and the Corporation for National and Community |
Service), including non-indirect cost administrative funds |
recovered from federal programs, for the specific purposes |
established by the terms and conditions of federal awards. |
Moneys in the SBE Federal Agency Services Fund shall be used, |
subject to appropriation by the General Assembly, for grants |
and contracts to local education agencies, colleges and |
universities, and other State agencies and for administrative |
expenses of the State Board of Education. However, |
non-appropriated spending is allowed for the refund of |
unexpended grant moneys to the federal government. The SBE |
Federal Agency Services Fund shall serve as the successor fund |
to the SBE Department of Health and Human Services Fund, the |
SBE Federal Department of Labor Federal Trust Fund, and the SBE |
Federal National Community Service Fund; and any balance |
remaining in the SBE Department of Health and Human Services |
Fund, the SBE Federal Department of Labor Federal Trust Fund, |
or the SBE Federal National Community Service Fund on the |
effective date of this amendatory Act of the 94th General |
Assembly must be transferred to the SBE Federal Agency Services |
Fund by the State Treasurer. Any future deposits that would |
otherwise be made into the SBE Department of Health and Human |
|
Services Fund, the SBE Federal Department of Labor Federal |
Trust Fund, or the SBE Federal National Community Service Fund |
must instead be made into the SBE Federal Agency Services Fund.
|
On or after July 1, 2007, the State Board of Education |
shall notify the State Comptroller of the amount of indirect |
federal funds in the SBE Federal Agency Services Fund to be |
transferred to the State Board of Education Special Purpose |
Trust Fund. The State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer this amount to the State Board of |
Education Special Purpose Trust Fund as soon as practical |
thereafter. |
(Source: P.A. 93-838, eff. 7-30-04; 94-69, eff. 7-1-05.) |
(30 ILCS 105/6z-67) |
Sec. 6z-67. SBE Federal Department of Agriculture Fund. The |
SBE Federal Department of Agriculture Fund is created as a |
federal trust fund in the State treasury. This fund is |
established to receive funds from the federal Department of |
Agriculture, including non-indirect cost administrative funds |
recovered from federal programs, for the specific purposes |
established by the terms and conditions of federal awards. |
Moneys in the SBE Federal Department of Agriculture Fund shall |
be used, subject to appropriation by the General Assembly, for |
grants and contracts to local education agencies, colleges and |
universities, and other State agencies and for administrative |
expenses of the State Board of Education. However, |
|
non-appropriated spending is allowed for the refund of |
unexpended grant moneys to the federal government.
|
On or after July 1, 2007, the State Board of Education |
shall notify the State Comptroller of the amount of indirect |
federal funds in the SBE Federal Department of Agriculture Fund |
to be transferred to the State Board of Education Special |
Purpose Trust Fund. The State Comptroller shall direct and the |
State Treasurer shall transfer this amount to the State Board |
of Education Special Purpose Trust Fund as soon as practical |
thereafter. |
(Source: P.A. 93-838, eff. 7-30-04; 94-69, eff. 7-1-05; 94-835, |
eff. 6-6-06.) |
(30 ILCS 105/6z-69 new)
|
Sec. 6z-69. Human Services Priority Capital Program Fund. |
The Human Services Priority Capital Program Fund is created as |
a special fund in the State treasury. Subject to appropriation, |
the Department of Human Services shall use moneys in the Human |
Services Priority Capital Program Fund to make grants to the |
Illinois Facilities Fund, a not-for-profit corporation, to |
make long term below market rate loans to nonprofit human |
service providers working under contract to the State of |
Illinois to assist those providers in meeting their capital |
needs. The loans shall be for the purpose of such capital |
needs, including but not limited to special use facilities, |
requirements for serving the disabled, mentally ill, or |
|
substance abusers, and medical and technology equipment. Loan |
repayments shall be deposited into the Human Services Priority |
Capital Program Fund. Interest income may be used to cover |
expenses of the program. The Illinois Facilities Fund shall |
report to the Department of Human Services and the General |
Assembly by April 1, 2008 as to the use and earnings of the |
program. |
(30 ILCS 105/6z-70 new) |
Sec. 6z-70. The Secretary of State Identification Security |
and Theft Prevention Fund. |
(a) The Secretary of State Identification Security and |
Theft Prevention Fund is created as a special fund in the State |
treasury. The Fund shall consist of any fund transfers, grants, |
fees, or moneys from other sources received for the purpose of |
funding identification security and theft prevention measures. |
(b) All moneys in the Secretary of State Identification |
Security and Theft Prevention Fund shall be used, subject to |
appropriation, for any costs related to implementing |
identification security and theft prevention measures. |
(c) Notwithstanding any other provision of State law to the |
contrary, on or after July 1, 2007, and until June 30, 2008, in |
addition to any other transfers that may be provided for by |
law, at the direction of and upon notification of the Secretary |
of State, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer amounts into the Secretary of State |
|
Identification Security and Theft Prevention Fund from the |
designated funds not exceeding the following totals: |
Lobbyist Registration Administration Fund .......$100,000 |
Registered Limited Liability Partnership Fund ....$75,000 |
Securities Investors Education Fund .............$500,000 |
Securities Audit and Enforcement Fund .........$5,725,000 |
Department of Business Services |
Special Operations Fund .......................$3,000,000 |
Corporate Franchise Tax Refund Fund ..........$3,000,000.
|
(30 ILCS 105/8.3) (from Ch. 127, par. 144.3)
|
Sec. 8.3. Money in the Road Fund shall, if and when the |
State of
Illinois incurs any bonded indebtedness for the |
construction of
permanent highways, be set aside and used for |
the purpose of paying and
discharging annually the principal |
and interest on that bonded
indebtedness then due and payable, |
and for no other purpose. The
surplus, if any, in the Road Fund |
after the payment of principal and
interest on that bonded |
indebtedness then annually due shall be used as
follows:
|
first -- to pay the cost of administration of Chapters |
2 through 10 of
the Illinois Vehicle Code, except the cost |
of administration of Articles I and
II of Chapter 3 of that |
Code; and
|
secondly -- for expenses of the Department of |
Transportation for
construction, reconstruction, |
improvement, repair, maintenance,
operation, and |
|
administration of highways in accordance with the
|
provisions of laws relating thereto, or for any purpose |
related or
incident to and connected therewith, including |
the separation of grades
of those highways with railroads |
and with highways and including the
payment of awards made |
by the Illinois Workers' Compensation Commission under the |
terms of
the Workers' Compensation Act or Workers' |
Occupational Diseases Act for
injury or death of an |
employee of the Division of Highways in the
Department of |
Transportation; or for the acquisition of land and the
|
erection of buildings for highway purposes, including the |
acquisition of
highway right-of-way or for investigations |
to determine the reasonably
anticipated future highway |
needs; or for making of surveys, plans,
specifications and |
estimates for and in the construction and maintenance
of |
flight strips and of highways necessary to provide access |
to military
and naval reservations, to defense industries |
and defense-industry
sites, and to the sources of raw |
materials and for replacing existing
highways and highway |
connections shut off from general public use at
military |
and naval reservations and defense-industry sites, or for |
the
purchase of right-of-way, except that the State shall |
be reimbursed in
full for any expense incurred in building |
the flight strips; or for the
operating and maintaining of |
highway garages; or for patrolling and
policing the public |
highways and conserving the peace; or for the operating |
|
expenses of the Department relating to the administration |
of public transportation programs; or for any of
those |
purposes or any other purpose that may be provided by law.
|
Appropriations for any of those purposes are payable from |
the Road
Fund. Appropriations may also be made from the Road |
Fund for the
administrative expenses of any State agency that |
are related to motor
vehicles or arise from the use of motor |
vehicles.
|
Beginning with fiscal year 1980 and thereafter, no Road |
Fund monies
shall be appropriated to the following Departments |
or agencies of State
government for administration, grants, or |
operations; but this
limitation is not a restriction upon |
appropriating for those purposes any
Road Fund monies that are |
eligible for federal reimbursement;
|
1. Department of Public Health;
|
2. Department of Transportation, only with respect to |
subsidies for
one-half fare Student Transportation and |
Reduced Fare for Elderly;
|
3. Department of Central Management
Services, except |
for expenditures
incurred for group insurance premiums of |
appropriate personnel;
|
4. Judicial Systems and Agencies.
|
Beginning with fiscal year 1981 and thereafter, no Road |
Fund monies
shall be appropriated to the following Departments |
or agencies of State
government for administration, grants, or |
operations; but this
limitation is not a restriction upon |
|
appropriating for those purposes any
Road Fund monies that are |
eligible for federal reimbursement:
|
1. Department of State Police, except for expenditures |
with
respect to the Division of Operations;
|
2. Department of Transportation, only with respect to |
Intercity Rail
Subsidies and Rail Freight Services.
|
Beginning with fiscal year 1982 and thereafter, no Road |
Fund monies
shall be appropriated to the following Departments |
or agencies of State
government for administration, grants, or |
operations; but this
limitation is not a restriction upon |
appropriating for those purposes any
Road Fund monies that are |
eligible for federal reimbursement: Department
of Central |
Management Services, except for awards made by
the Illinois |
Workers' Compensation Commission under the terms of the |
Workers' Compensation Act
or Workers' Occupational Diseases |
Act for injury or death of an employee of
the Division of |
Highways in the Department of Transportation.
|
Beginning with fiscal year 1984 and thereafter, no Road |
Fund monies
shall be appropriated to the following Departments |
or agencies of State
government for administration, grants, or |
operations; but this
limitation is not a restriction upon |
appropriating for those purposes any
Road Fund monies that are |
eligible for federal reimbursement:
|
1. Department of State Police, except not more than 40% |
of the
funds appropriated for the Division of Operations;
|
2. State Officers.
|
|
Beginning with fiscal year 1984 and thereafter, no Road |
Fund monies
shall be appropriated to any Department or agency |
of State government
for administration, grants, or operations |
except as provided hereafter;
but this limitation is not a |
restriction upon appropriating for those
purposes any Road Fund |
monies that are eligible for federal
reimbursement. It shall |
not be lawful to circumvent the above
appropriation limitations |
by governmental reorganization or other
methods. |
Appropriations shall be made from the Road Fund only in
|
accordance with the provisions of this Section.
|
Money in the Road Fund shall, if and when the State of |
Illinois
incurs any bonded indebtedness for the construction of |
permanent
highways, be set aside and used for the purpose of |
paying and
discharging during each fiscal year the principal |
and interest on that
bonded indebtedness as it becomes due and |
payable as provided in the
Transportation Bond Act, and for no |
other
purpose. The surplus, if any, in the Road Fund after the |
payment of
principal and interest on that bonded indebtedness |
then annually due
shall be used as follows:
|
first -- to pay the cost of administration of Chapters |
2 through 10
of the Illinois Vehicle Code; and
|
secondly -- no Road Fund monies derived from fees, |
excises, or
license taxes relating to registration, |
operation and use of vehicles on
public highways or to |
fuels used for the propulsion of those vehicles,
shall be |
appropriated or expended other than for costs of |
|
administering
the laws imposing those fees, excises, and |
license taxes, statutory
refunds and adjustments allowed |
thereunder, administrative costs of the
Department of |
Transportation, including, but not limited to, the |
operating expenses of the Department relating to the |
administration of public transportation programs, payment |
of debts and liabilities incurred
in construction and |
reconstruction of public highways and bridges,
acquisition |
of rights-of-way for and the cost of construction,
|
reconstruction, maintenance, repair, and operation of |
public highways and
bridges under the direction and |
supervision of the State, political
subdivision, or |
municipality collecting those monies, and the costs for
|
patrolling and policing the public highways (by State, |
political
subdivision, or municipality collecting that |
money) for enforcement of
traffic laws. The separation of |
grades of such highways with railroads
and costs associated |
with protection of at-grade highway and railroad
crossing |
shall also be permissible.
|
Appropriations for any of such purposes are payable from |
the Road
Fund or the Grade Crossing Protection Fund as provided |
in Section 8 of
the Motor Fuel Tax Law.
|
Except as provided in this paragraph, beginning with fiscal |
year 1991 and
thereafter, no Road Fund monies
shall be |
appropriated to the Department of State Police for the purposes |
of
this Section in excess of its total fiscal year 1990 Road |
|
Fund
appropriations for those purposes unless otherwise |
provided in Section 5g of
this Act.
For fiscal years 2003,
|
2004, 2005, 2006, and 2007 only, no Road Fund monies shall
be |
appropriated to the
Department of State Police for the purposes |
of this Section in excess of
$97,310,000.
For fiscal year 2008 |
only, no Road
Fund monies shall be appropriated to the |
Department of State Police for the purposes of
this Section in |
excess of $106,100,000. It shall not be lawful to circumvent |
this limitation on
appropriations by governmental |
reorganization or other methods unless
otherwise provided in |
Section 5g of this Act.
|
In fiscal year 1994, no Road Fund monies shall be |
appropriated
to the
Secretary of State for the purposes of this |
Section in excess of the total
fiscal year 1991 Road Fund |
appropriations to the Secretary of State for
those purposes, |
plus $9,800,000. It
shall not be
lawful to circumvent
this |
limitation on appropriations by governmental reorganization or |
other
method.
|
Beginning with fiscal year 1995 and thereafter, no Road |
Fund
monies
shall be appropriated to the Secretary of State for |
the purposes of this
Section in excess of the total fiscal year |
1994 Road Fund
appropriations to
the Secretary of State for |
those purposes. It shall not be lawful to
circumvent this |
limitation on appropriations by governmental reorganization
or |
other methods.
|
Beginning with fiscal year 2000, total Road Fund |
|
appropriations to the
Secretary of State for the purposes of |
this Section shall not exceed the
amounts specified for the |
following fiscal years:
|
|
Fiscal Year 2000 |
$80,500,000; |
|
Fiscal Year 2001 |
$80,500,000; |
|
Fiscal Year 2002 |
$80,500,000; |
|
Fiscal Year 2003 |
$130,500,000; |
|
Fiscal Year 2004 |
$130,500,000; |
|
Fiscal Year 2005 |
$130,500,000;
|
|
Fiscal Year 2006
| $130,500,000;
|
|
Fiscal Year 2007
| $130,500,000;
|
|
Fiscal Year 2008 and |
$130,500,000; $30,500,000. |
|
Fiscal Year 2009 and each year thereafter |
|
It shall not be lawful to circumvent this limitation on |
appropriations by
governmental reorganization or other |
methods.
|
No new program may be initiated in fiscal year 1991 and
|
thereafter that is not consistent with the limitations imposed |
by this
Section for fiscal year 1984 and thereafter, insofar as |
appropriation of
Road Fund monies is concerned.
|
Nothing in this Section prohibits transfers from the Road |
Fund to the
State Construction Account Fund under Section 5e of |
this Act; nor to the
General Revenue Fund, as authorized by |
this amendatory Act of
the 93rd
General Assembly.
|
The additional amounts authorized for expenditure in this |
Section by Public Acts 92-0600, 93-0025, 93-0839, and 94-91
|
|
shall be repaid to the Road Fund
from the General Revenue Fund |
in the next succeeding fiscal year that the
General Revenue |
Fund has a positive budgetary balance, as determined by
|
generally accepted accounting principles applicable to |
government.
|
The additional amounts authorized for expenditure by the |
Secretary of State
and
the Department of State Police in this |
Section by this amendatory Act of the
94th General Assembly |
shall be repaid to the Road Fund from the General Revenue Fund |
in the
next
succeeding fiscal year that the General Revenue |
Fund has a positive budgetary
balance,
as determined by |
generally accepted accounting principles applicable to
|
government.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-25, eff. 6-20-03; 93-721, eff. 1-1-05; 93-839, |
eff. 7-30-04; 94-91, eff. 7-1-05; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
|
(30 ILCS 105/8.27) (from Ch. 127, par. 144.27)
|
Sec. 8.27. All receipts from federal financial |
participation in the
Foster Care and Adoption Services program |
under Title IV-E of the federal
Social Security Act, including |
receipts
for related indirect costs,
shall be deposited in the |
DCFS Children's Services Fund.
|
Eighty percent of the federal funds received by the |
Illinois Department
of Human Services under the Title IV-A |
Emergency Assistance program as
reimbursement for expenditures |
made from the Illinois Department of Children
and Family |
|
Services appropriations for the costs of services in behalf of
|
Department of Children and Family Services clients shall be |
deposited into
the DCFS Children's Services Fund.
|
All receipts from federal financial participation in the |
Child Welfare
Services program under Title IV-B of the federal |
Social Security Act,
including receipts for related indirect |
costs, shall be deposited into the
DCFS Children's Services |
Fund for those moneys received as reimbursement for
services |
provided on or after July 1, 1994.
|
In addition, as soon as may be practicable after the first |
day of November,
1994, the Department of Children and Family |
Services shall request the
Comptroller to order transferred and |
the Treasurer shall transfer the
unexpended balance of the |
Child Welfare Services Fund to the DCFS Children's
Services |
Fund. Upon completion of the transfer, the Child Welfare |
Services
Fund will be considered dissolved and any outstanding |
obligations or
liabilities of that fund will pass to the DCFS |
Children's Services Fund.
|
For services provided on or after July 1, 2007, all federal |
funds received pursuant to the John H. Chafee Foster Care |
Independence Program shall be deposited into the DCFS |
Children's Services Fund. |
Monies in the Fund may be used by the Department, pursuant |
to
appropriation by the General Assembly, for the ordinary and |
contingent
expenses of the Department.
|
In fiscal year 1988 and in each fiscal year thereafter |
|
through fiscal
year 2000, the Comptroller
shall order |
transferred and the Treasurer shall transfer an amount of
|
$16,100,000 from the DCFS Children's Services Fund to the |
General Revenue
Fund in the following manner: As soon as may be |
practicable after the 15th
day of September, December, March |
and June, the Comptroller shall order
transferred and the |
Treasurer shall transfer, to the extent that funds are
|
available, 1/4 of $16,100,000, plus any cumulative |
deficiencies in such
transfers for prior transfer dates during |
such fiscal year. In no event
shall any such transfer reduce |
the available balance in the DCFS Children's
Services Fund |
below $350,000.
|
In accordance with subsection (q) of Section 5 of the |
Children and Family
Services Act, disbursements from |
individual children's accounts shall be
deposited into the DCFS |
Children's Services Fund.
|
Receipts from public and unsolicited private grants, fees |
for training, and royalties earned from the publication of |
materials owned by or licensed to the Department of Children |
and Family Services shall be deposited into the DCFS Children's |
Services Fund. |
As soon as may be practical after September 1, 2005, upon |
the request of the Department of Children and Family Services, |
the Comptroller shall order transferred and the Treasurer shall |
transfer the unexpended balance of the Department of Children |
and Family Services Training Fund into the DCFS Children's |
|
Services Fund. Upon completion of the transfer, the Department |
of Children and Family Services Training Fund is dissolved and |
any outstanding obligations or liabilities of that Fund pass to |
the DCFS Children's Services Fund.
|
(Source: P.A. 94-91, eff. 7-1-05.)
|
(30 ILCS 105/8g)
|
Sec. 8g. Fund transfers.
|
(a) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, as
soon as may be practical after the effective |
date of this amendatory Act of
the 91st General Assembly, the |
State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall |
transfer the sum of $10,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund
|
to the Motor Vehicle License Plate Fund created by Senate Bill |
1028 of the 91st
General Assembly.
|
(b) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, as
soon as may be practical after the effective |
date of this amendatory Act of
the 91st General Assembly, the |
State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall |
transfer the sum of $25,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund
|
to the Fund for Illinois' Future created by Senate Bill 1066 of |
the 91st
General Assembly.
|
(c) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law,
on August 30 of each fiscal year's license period, |
the Illinois Liquor Control
Commission shall direct and the |
State Comptroller and State Treasurer shall
transfer from the |
|
General Revenue Fund to the Youth Alcoholism and Substance
|
Abuse Prevention Fund an amount equal to the number of retail |
liquor licenses
issued for that fiscal year multiplied by $50.
|
(d) The payments to programs required under subsection (d) |
of Section 28.1
of the Horse Racing Act of 1975 shall be made, |
pursuant to appropriation, from
the special funds referred to |
in the statutes cited in that subsection, rather
than directly |
from the General Revenue Fund.
|
Beginning January 1, 2000, on the first day of each month, |
or as soon
as may be practical thereafter, the State |
Comptroller shall direct and the
State Treasurer shall transfer |
from the General Revenue Fund to each of the
special funds from |
which payments are to be made under Section 28.1(d) of the
|
Horse Racing Act of 1975 an amount equal to 1/12 of the annual |
amount required
for those payments from that special fund, |
which annual amount shall not exceed
the annual amount for |
those payments from that special fund for the calendar
year |
1998. The special funds to which transfers shall be made under |
this
subsection (d) include, but are not necessarily limited |
to, the Agricultural
Premium Fund; the Metropolitan Exposition |
Auditorium and Office Building Fund;
the Fair and Exposition |
Fund; the Standardbred Breeders Fund; the Thoroughbred
|
Breeders Fund; and the Illinois Veterans' Rehabilitation Fund.
|
(e) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law,
as soon as may be practical after the effective |
date of this amendatory Act of
the 91st General Assembly, but |
|
in no event later than June 30, 2000, the State
Comptroller |
shall direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of
|
$15,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Fund for |
Illinois' Future.
|
(f) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law,
as soon as may be practical after the effective |
date of this amendatory Act of
the 91st General Assembly, but |
in no event later than June 30, 2000, the State
Comptroller |
shall direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of
|
$70,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Long-Term Care |
Provider
Fund.
|
(f-1) In fiscal year 2002, in addition to any other |
transfers that may
be provided for by law, at the direction of |
and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller |
shall direct and the State Treasurer shall
transfer amounts not |
exceeding a total of $160,000,000 from the General
Revenue Fund |
to the Long-Term Care Provider Fund.
|
(g) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law,
on July 1, 2001, or as soon thereafter as may be |
practical, the State
Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of
$1,200,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the Violence Prevention Fund.
|
(h) In each of fiscal years 2002 through 2004, but not
|
thereafter, in
addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, the State
Comptroller shall direct and the |
State Treasurer shall transfer $5,000,000
from the General |
|
Revenue Fund to the Tourism Promotion Fund.
|
(i) On or after July 1, 2001 and until May 1, 2002, in |
addition to any
other transfers that may be provided for by |
law, at the direction of and upon
notification from the |
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the
State |
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not exceeding a total of |
$80,000,000
from the General Revenue Fund to the Tobacco |
Settlement Recovery Fund.
Any amounts so transferred shall be |
re-transferred by the State Comptroller
and the State Treasurer |
from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the
General |
Revenue Fund at the direction of and upon notification from the
|
Governor, but in any event on or before June 30, 2002.
|
(i-1) On or after July 1, 2002 and until May 1, 2003, in |
addition to any
other transfers that may be provided for by |
law, at the direction of and upon
notification from the |
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the
State |
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not exceeding a total of |
$80,000,000
from the General Revenue Fund to the Tobacco |
Settlement Recovery Fund.
Any amounts so transferred shall be |
re-transferred by the State Comptroller
and the State Treasurer |
from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the
General |
Revenue Fund at the direction of and upon notification from the
|
Governor, but in any event on or before June 30, 2003.
|
(j) On or after July 1, 2001 and no later than June 30, |
2002, in addition to
any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, at the direction of and
upon notification from the |
|
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the
State |
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not to exceed the following |
sums into
the Statistical Services Revolving Fund:
|
|
From the General Revenue Fund ................. |
$8,450,000 |
|
From the Public Utility Fund .................. |
1,700,000 |
|
From the Transportation Regulatory Fund ....... |
2,650,000 |
|
From the Title III Social Security and |
|
|
Employment Fund .............................. |
3,700,000 |
|
From the Professions Indirect Cost Fund ....... |
4,050,000 |
|
From the Underground Storage Tank Fund ........ |
550,000 |
|
From the Agricultural Premium Fund ............ |
750,000 |
|
From the State Pensions Fund .................. |
200,000 |
|
From the Road Fund ............................ |
2,000,000 |
|
From the Health Facilities |
|
|
Planning Fund ................................ |
1,000,000 |
|
From the Savings and Residential Finance |
|
|
Regulatory Fund .............................. |
130,800 |
|
From the Appraisal Administration Fund ........ |
28,600 |
|
From the Pawnbroker Regulation Fund ........... |
3,600 |
|
From the Auction Regulation |
|
|
Administration Fund .......................... |
35,800 |
|
From the Bank and Trust Company Fund .......... |
634,800 |
|
From the Real Estate License |
|
|
Administration Fund .......................... |
313,600 |
|
(k) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law,
as soon as may be practical after the effective |
|
date of this amendatory Act of
the 92nd General Assembly, the |
State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall |
transfer the sum of $2,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund
to |
the Teachers Health Insurance Security Fund.
|
(k-1) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by
law, on July 1, 2002, or as soon as may be |
practical thereafter, the State
Comptroller shall direct and |
the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of
$2,000,000 from |
the General Revenue Fund to the Teachers Health Insurance
|
Security Fund.
|
(k-2) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by
law, on July 1, 2003, or as soon as may be |
practical thereafter, the State
Comptroller shall direct and |
the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of
$2,000,000 from |
the General Revenue Fund to the Teachers Health Insurance
|
Security Fund.
|
(k-3) On or after July 1, 2002 and no later than June 30, |
2003, in
addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, at the
direction of and upon notification from the |
Governor, the State Comptroller
shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not to exceed the
following |
sums into the Statistical Services Revolving Fund:
|
|
Appraisal Administration Fund ................. |
$150,000 |
|
General Revenue Fund .......................... |
10,440,000 |
|
Savings and Residential Finance |
|
|
Regulatory Fund ........................... |
200,000 |
|
|
|
State Pensions Fund ........................... |
100,000 |
|
Bank and Trust Company Fund ................... |
100,000 |
|
Professions Indirect Cost Fund ................ |
3,400,000 |
|
Public Utility Fund ........................... |
2,081,200 |
|
Real Estate License Administration Fund ....... |
150,000 |
|
Title III Social Security and |
|
|
Employment Fund ........................... |
1,000,000 |
|
Transportation Regulatory Fund ................ |
3,052,100 |
|
Underground Storage Tank Fund ................. |
50,000 |
|
(l) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, on
July 1, 2002, or as soon as may be practical |
thereafter, the State Comptroller
shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $3,000,000 from
the General |
Revenue Fund to the Presidential Library and Museum Operating
|
Fund.
|
(m) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, on
July 1, 2002 and on the effective date of this |
amendatory Act of the 93rd
General Assembly, or as soon |
thereafter as may be practical, the State Comptroller
shall |
direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of |
$1,200,000 from
the General Revenue Fund to the Violence |
Prevention Fund.
|
(n) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law,
on July 1,
2003, or as soon thereafter as may be |
practical, the State Comptroller shall
direct and the
State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $6,800,000 from the General |
|
Revenue
Fund to
the DHS Recoveries Trust Fund.
|
(o) On or after July 1, 2003, and no later than June 30, |
2004, in
addition to any
other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, at the direction of and upon
notification
from the |
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer
shall
transfer amounts not to exceed the following |
sums into the Vehicle Inspection
Fund:
|
|
From the Underground Storage Tank Fund ....... |
$35,000,000. |
|
(p) On or after July 1, 2003 and until May 1, 2004, in |
addition to any
other
transfers that may be provided for by |
law, at the direction of and upon
notification from
the |
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall
transfer
amounts not exceeding a total of |
$80,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to
the
Tobacco |
Settlement Recovery Fund. Any amounts so transferred shall be
|
re-transferred
from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the |
General Revenue Fund at the
direction of and upon notification |
from the Governor, but in any event on or
before June
30, 2004.
|
(q) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, on
July 1,
2003, or as soon as may be practical |
thereafter, the State Comptroller shall
direct and the
State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $5,000,000 from the General |
Revenue
Fund to
the Illinois Military Family Relief Fund.
|
(r) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, on
July 1,
2003, or as soon as may be practical |
thereafter, the State Comptroller shall
direct and the
State |
|
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,922,000 from the General |
Revenue
Fund to
the Presidential Library and Museum Operating |
Fund.
|
(s) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, on
or after
July 1, 2003, the State Comptroller |
shall direct and the State Treasurer shall
transfer the
sum of |
$4,800,000 from the Statewide Economic Development Fund to the |
General
Revenue Fund.
|
(t) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, on
or after
July 1, 2003, the State Comptroller |
shall direct and the State Treasurer shall
transfer the
sum of |
$50,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Budget |
Stabilization
Fund.
|
(u) On or after July 1, 2004 and until May 1, 2005, in |
addition to any other transfers that may be provided for by |
law, at the direction of and upon notification from the |
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not exceeding a total of |
$80,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Tobacco |
Settlement Recovery Fund. Any amounts so transferred shall be |
retransferred by the State Comptroller and the State Treasurer |
from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the General |
Revenue Fund at the direction of and upon notification from the |
Governor, but in any event on or before June 30, 2005.
|
(v) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, on July 1, 2004, or as soon thereafter as may be |
|
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,200,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the Violence Prevention Fund. |
(w) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, on July 1, 2004, or as soon thereafter as may be |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $6,445,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the Presidential Library and Museum Operating |
Fund.
|
(x) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, on January 15, 2005, or as soon thereafter as may |
be practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer to the General Revenue Fund the |
following sums: |
From the State Crime Laboratory Fund, $200,000; |
From the State Police Wireless Service Emergency Fund, |
$200,000; |
From the State Offender DNA Identification System |
Fund, $800,000; and |
From the State Police Whistleblower Reward and |
Protection Fund, $500,000.
|
(y) Notwithstanding any other provision of law to the |
contrary, in addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law on June 30, 2005, or as soon as may be |
practical thereafter, the State Comptroller shall direct and |
the State Treasurer shall transfer the remaining balance from |
|
the designated funds into the General Revenue Fund and any |
future deposits that would otherwise be made into these funds |
must instead be made into the General Revenue Fund:
|
(1) the Keep Illinois Beautiful Fund;
|
(2) the
Metropolitan Fair and Exposition Authority |
Reconstruction Fund; |
(3) the
New Technology Recovery Fund; |
(4) the Illinois Rural Bond Bank Trust Fund; |
(5) the ISBE School Bus Driver Permit Fund; |
(6) the
Solid Waste Management Revolving Loan Fund; |
(7)
the State Postsecondary Review Program Fund; |
(8) the
Tourism Attraction Development Matching Grant |
Fund; |
(9) the
Patent and Copyright Fund; |
(10) the
Credit Enhancement Development Fund; |
(11) the
Community Mental Health and Developmental |
Disabilities Services Provider Participation Fee Trust |
Fund; |
(12) the
Nursing Home Grant Assistance Fund; |
(13) the
By-product Material Safety Fund; |
(14) the
Illinois Student Assistance Commission Higher |
EdNet Fund; |
(15) the
DORS State Project Fund; |
(16) the School Technology Revolving Fund; |
(17) the
Energy Assistance Contribution Fund; |
(18) the
Illinois Building Commission Revolving Fund; |
|
(19) the
Illinois Aquaculture Development Fund; |
(20) the
Homelessness Prevention Fund; |
(21) the
DCFS Refugee Assistance Fund; |
(22) the
Illinois Century Network Special Purposes |
Fund; and |
(23) the
Build Illinois Purposes Fund.
|
(z) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, on July 1, 2005, or as soon as may be practical |
thereafter, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,200,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the Violence Prevention Fund.
|
(aa) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2005, or as soon as may be |
practical thereafter, the State Comptroller shall direct and |
the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $9,000,000 from |
the General Revenue Fund to the Presidential Library and Museum |
Operating Fund.
|
(bb) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2005, or as soon as may be |
practical thereafter, the State Comptroller shall direct and |
the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $6,803,600 from |
the General Revenue Fund to the Securities Audit and |
Enforcement Fund.
|
(cc) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on or after July 1, 2005 and until May 1, |
2006, at the direction of and upon notification from the |
|
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not exceeding a total of |
$80,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Tobacco |
Settlement Recovery Fund. Any amounts so transferred shall be |
re-transferred by the State Comptroller and the State Treasurer |
from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the General |
Revenue Fund at the direction of and upon notification from the |
Governor, but in any event on or before June 30, 2006.
|
(dd) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on April 1, 2005, or as soon thereafter as |
may be practical, at the direction of the Director of Public |
Aid (now Director of Healthcare and Family Services), the State |
Comptroller shall direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer |
from the Public Aid Recoveries Trust Fund amounts not to exceed |
$14,000,000 to the Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund. |
(ee) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, on July 1, |
2006, or as soon thereafter as practical, the State Comptroller |
shall direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer the |
remaining balance from the Illinois Civic Center Bond Fund to |
the Illinois Civic Center Bond Retirement and Interest Fund. |
(ff) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on and after July 1, 2006 and until June |
30, 2007, at the direction of and upon notification from the |
Director of the Governor's Office of Management and Budget, the |
State Comptroller shall direct and the State Treasurer shall |
transfer amounts not exceeding a total of $1,900,000 from the |
|
General Revenue Fund to the Illinois Capital Revolving Loan |
Fund. |
(gg) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on and after July 1, 2006 and until May 1, |
2007, at the direction of and upon notification from the |
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not exceeding a total of |
$80,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Tobacco |
Settlement Recovery Fund. Any amounts so transferred shall be |
retransferred by the State Comptroller and the State Treasurer |
from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the General |
Revenue Fund at the direction of and upon notification from the |
Governor, but in any event on or before June 30, 2007. |
(hh) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on and after July 1, 2006 and until June |
30, 2007, at the direction of and upon notification from the |
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer amounts from the Illinois Affordable |
Housing Trust Fund to the designated funds not exceeding the |
following amounts: |
DCFS Children's Services Fund .................$2,200,000
|
Department of Corrections Reimbursement |
and Education Fund ........................$1,500,000
|
Supplemental Low-Income Energy |
Assistance Fund ..............................$75,000
|
(ii) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
|
provided for by law, on or before August 31, 2006, the Governor |
and the State Comptroller may agree to transfer the surplus |
cash balance from the General Revenue Fund to the Budget |
Stabilization Fund and the Pension Stabilization Fund in equal |
proportions. The determination of the amount of the surplus |
cash balance shall be made by the Governor, with the |
concurrence of the State Comptroller, after taking into account |
the June 30, 2006 balances in the general funds and the actual |
or estimated spending from the general funds during the lapse |
period. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the maximum amount that |
may be transferred under this subsection (ii) is $50,000,000. |
(jj) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2006, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $8,250,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the Presidential Library and Museum Operating |
Fund. |
(kk) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2006, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,400,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the Violence Prevention Fund.
|
(ll) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on the first day of each calendar quarter |
of the fiscal year beginning July 1, 2006, or as soon |
thereafter as practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and |
|
the State Treasurer shall transfer from the General Revenue |
Fund amounts equal to one-fourth of $20,000,000 to the |
Renewable Energy Resources Trust Fund. |
(mm) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2006, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,320,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the I-FLY Fund. |
(nn) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2006, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $3,000,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the African-American HIV/AIDS Response Fund. |
(oo) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on and after July 1, 2006 and until June |
30, 2007, at the direction of and upon notification from the |
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer amounts identified as net receipts |
from the sale of all or part of the Illinois Student Assistance |
Commission loan portfolio from the Student Loan Operating Fund |
to the General Revenue Fund. The maximum amount that may be |
transferred pursuant to this Section is $38,800,000. In |
addition, no transfer may be made pursuant to this Section that |
would have the effect of reducing the available balance in the |
Student Loan Operating Fund to an amount less than the amount |
remaining unexpended and unreserved from the total |
|
appropriations from the Fund estimated to be expended for the |
fiscal year. The State Treasurer and Comptroller shall transfer |
the amounts designated under this Section as soon as may be |
practical after receiving the direction to transfer from the |
Governor.
|
(pp)
(ee) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2006, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $2,000,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the Illinois Veterans Assistance Fund. |
(qq) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on and after July 1, 2007 and until May 1, |
2008, at the direction of and upon notification from the |
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not exceeding a total of |
$80,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Tobacco |
Settlement Recovery Fund. Any amounts so transferred shall be |
retransferred by the State Comptroller and the State Treasurer |
from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the General |
Revenue Fund at the direction of and upon notification from the |
Governor, but in any event on or before June 30, 2008. |
(rr) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on and after July 1, 2007 and until June |
30, 2008, at the direction of and upon notification from the |
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer amounts from the Illinois Affordable |
|
Housing Trust Fund to the designated funds not exceeding the |
following amounts: |
DCFS Children's Services Fund .................$2,200,000
|
Department of Corrections Reimbursement |
and Education Fund ........................$1,500,000
|
Supplemental Low-Income Energy |
Assistance Fund ..............................$75,000
|
(ss) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $8,250,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the Presidential Library and Museum Operating |
Fund. |
(tt) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,400,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the Violence Prevention Fund.
|
(uu) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,320,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the I-FLY Fund. |
(vv) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
|
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $3,000,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the African-American HIV/AIDS Response Fund. |
(ww) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $3,500,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the Predatory Lending Database Program Fund. |
(xx) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $5,000,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the Digital Divide Elimination Fund. |
(yy) In addition to any other transfers that may be |
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $4,000,000 from the General |
Revenue Fund to the Digital Divide Elimination Infrastructure |
Fund. |
(Source: P.A. 93-32, eff. 6-20-03; 93-648, eff. 1-8-04; 93-839, |
eff. 7-30-04; 93-1067, eff. 1-15-05; 94-58, eff. 6-17-05; |
94-91, eff. 7-1-05; 94-816, eff. 5-30-06; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06; |
revised 8-3-06.)
|
(30 ILCS 105/13.2) (from Ch. 127, par. 149.2)
|
Sec. 13.2. Transfers among line item appropriations.
|
(a) Transfers among line item appropriations from the same
|
|
treasury fund for the objects specified in this Section may be |
made in
the manner provided in this Section when the balance |
remaining in one or
more such line item appropriations is |
insufficient for the purpose for
which the appropriation was |
made.
|
(a-1) No transfers may be made from one
agency to another |
agency, nor may transfers be made from one institution
of |
higher education to another institution of higher education.
|
(a-2) Except as otherwise provided in this Section, |
transfers may be made only among the objects of expenditure |
enumerated
in this Section, except that no funds may be |
transferred from any
appropriation for personal services, from |
any appropriation for State
contributions to the State |
Employees' Retirement System, from any
separate appropriation |
for employee retirement contributions paid by the
employer, nor |
from any appropriation for State contribution for
employee |
group insurance. During State fiscal year 2005, an agency may |
transfer amounts among its appropriations within the same |
treasury fund for personal services, employee retirement |
contributions paid by employer, and State Contributions to |
retirement systems; notwithstanding and in addition to the |
transfers authorized in subsection (c) of this Section, the |
fiscal year 2005 transfers authorized in this sentence may be |
made in an amount not to exceed 2% of the aggregate amount |
appropriated to an agency within the same treasury fund. During |
State fiscal year 2007, the Departments of Children and Family |
|
Services, Corrections, Human Services, and Juvenile Justice |
may transfer amounts among their respective appropriations |
within the same treasury fund for personal services, employee |
retirement contributions paid by employer, and State |
contributions to retirement systems. Notwithstanding, and in |
addition to, the transfers authorized in subsection (c) of this |
Section, these transfers may be made in an amount not to exceed |
2% of the aggregate amount appropriated to an agency within the |
same treasury fund.
|
(a-3) Further, if an agency receives a separate
|
appropriation for employee retirement contributions paid by |
the employer,
any transfer by that agency into an appropriation |
for personal services
must be accompanied by a corresponding |
transfer into the appropriation for
employee retirement |
contributions paid by the employer, in an amount
sufficient to |
meet the employer share of the employee contributions
required |
to be remitted to the retirement system.
|
(b) In addition to the general transfer authority provided |
under
subsection (c), the following agencies have the specific |
transfer authority
granted in this subsection:
|
The Department of Healthcare and Family Services is |
authorized to make transfers
representing savings attributable |
to not increasing grants due to the
births of additional |
children from line items for payments of cash grants to
line |
items for payments for employment and social services for the |
purposes
outlined in subsection (f) of Section 4-2 of the |
|
Illinois Public Aid Code.
|
The Department of Children and Family Services is |
authorized to make
transfers not exceeding 2% of the aggregate |
amount appropriated to it within
the same treasury fund for the |
following line items among these same line
items: Foster Home |
and Specialized Foster Care and Prevention, Institutions
and |
Group Homes and Prevention, and Purchase of Adoption and |
Guardianship
Services.
|
The Department on Aging is authorized to make transfers not
|
exceeding 2% of the aggregate amount appropriated to it within |
the same
treasury fund for the following Community Care Program |
line items among these
same line items: Homemaker and Senior |
Companion Services, Alternative Senior Services, Case |
Coordination
Units, and Adult Day Care Services.
|
The State Treasurer is authorized to make transfers among |
line item
appropriations
from the Capital Litigation Trust |
Fund, with respect to costs incurred in
fiscal years 2002 and |
2003 only, when the balance remaining in one or
more such
line |
item appropriations is insufficient for the purpose for which |
the
appropriation was
made, provided that no such transfer may |
be made unless the amount transferred
is no
longer required for |
the purpose for which that appropriation was made.
|
The State Board of Education is authorized to make |
transfers from line item appropriations within the same |
treasury fund for General State Aid and General State Aid - |
Hold Harmless, provided that no such transfer may be made |
|
unless the amount transferred is no longer required for the |
purpose for which that appropriation was made, to the line item |
appropriation for Transitional Assistance when the balance |
remaining in such line item appropriation is insufficient for |
the purpose for which the appropriation was made. |
The State Board of Education is authorized to make |
transfers between the following line item appropriations |
within the same treasury fund: Disabled Student |
Services/Materials (Section 14-13.01 of the School Code), |
Disabled Student Transportation Reimbursement (Section |
14-13.01 of the School Code), Disabled Student Tuition - |
Private Tuition (Section 14-7.02 of the School Code), |
Extraordinary Special Education (Section 14-7.02b of the |
School Code), Reimbursement for Free Lunch/Breakfast Program, |
Summer School Payments (Section 18-4.3 of the School Code), and |
Transportation - Regular/Vocational Reimbursement (Section |
29-5 of the School Code). Such transfers shall be made only |
when the balance remaining in one or more such line item |
appropriations is insufficient for the purpose for which the |
appropriation was made and provided that no such transfer may |
be made unless the amount transferred is no longer required for |
the purpose for which that appropriation was made. |
(c) The sum of such transfers for an agency in a fiscal |
year shall not
exceed 2% of the aggregate amount appropriated |
to it within the same treasury
fund for the following objects: |
Personal Services; Extra Help; Student and
Inmate |
|
Compensation; State Contributions to Retirement Systems; State
|
Contributions to Social Security; State Contribution for |
Employee Group
Insurance; Contractual Services; Travel; |
Commodities; Printing; Equipment;
Electronic Data Processing; |
Operation of Automotive Equipment;
Telecommunications |
Services; Travel and Allowance for Committed, Paroled
and |
Discharged Prisoners; Library Books; Federal Matching Grants |
for
Student Loans; Refunds; Workers' Compensation, |
Occupational Disease, and
Tort Claims; and, in appropriations |
to institutions of higher education,
Awards and Grants. |
Notwithstanding the above, any amounts appropriated for
|
payment of workers' compensation claims to an agency to which |
the authority
to evaluate, administer and pay such claims has |
been delegated by the
Department of Central Management Services |
may be transferred to any other
expenditure object where such |
amounts exceed the amount necessary for the
payment of such |
claims.
|
(c-1) Special provisions for State fiscal year 2003. |
Notwithstanding any
other provision of this Section to the |
contrary, for State fiscal year 2003
only, transfers among line |
item appropriations to an agency from the same
treasury fund |
may be made provided that the sum of such transfers for an |
agency
in State fiscal year 2003 shall not exceed 3% of the |
aggregate amount
appropriated to that State agency for State |
fiscal year 2003 for the following
objects: personal services, |
except that no transfer may be approved which
reduces the |
|
aggregate appropriations for personal services within an |
agency;
extra help; student and inmate compensation; State
|
contributions to retirement systems; State contributions to |
social security;
State contributions for employee group |
insurance; contractual services; travel;
commodities; |
printing; equipment; electronic data processing; operation of
|
automotive equipment; telecommunications services; travel and |
allowance for
committed, paroled, and discharged prisoners; |
library books; federal matching
grants for student loans; |
refunds; workers' compensation, occupational disease,
and tort |
claims; and, in appropriations to institutions of higher |
education,
awards and grants.
|
(c-2) Special provisions for State fiscal year 2005. |
Notwithstanding subsections (a), (a-2), and (c), for State |
fiscal year 2005 only, transfers may be made among any line |
item appropriations from the same or any other treasury fund |
for any objects or purposes, without limitation, when the |
balance remaining in one or more such line item appropriations |
is insufficient for the purpose for which the appropriation was |
made, provided that the sum of those transfers by a State |
agency shall not exceed 4% of the aggregate amount appropriated |
to that State agency for fiscal year 2005.
|
(d) Transfers among appropriations made to agencies of the |
Legislative
and Judicial departments and to the |
constitutionally elected officers in the
Executive branch |
require the approval of the officer authorized in Section 10
of |
|
this Act to approve and certify vouchers. Transfers among |
appropriations
made to the University of Illinois, Southern |
Illinois University, Chicago State
University, Eastern |
Illinois University, Governors State University, Illinois
|
State University, Northeastern Illinois University, Northern |
Illinois
University, Western Illinois University, the Illinois |
Mathematics and Science
Academy and the Board of Higher |
Education require the approval of the Board of
Higher Education |
and the Governor. Transfers among appropriations to all other
|
agencies require the approval of the Governor.
|
The officer responsible for approval shall certify that the
|
transfer is necessary to carry out the programs and purposes |
for which
the appropriations were made by the General Assembly |
and shall transmit
to the State Comptroller a certified copy of |
the approval which shall
set forth the specific amounts |
transferred so that the Comptroller may
change his records |
accordingly. The Comptroller shall furnish the
Governor with |
information copies of all transfers approved for agencies
of |
the Legislative and Judicial departments and transfers |
approved by
the constitutionally elected officials of the |
Executive branch other
than the Governor, showing the amounts |
transferred and indicating the
dates such changes were entered |
on the Comptroller's records.
|
(e) The State Board of Education, in consultation with the |
State Comptroller, may transfer line item appropriations for |
General State Aid from the Common School Fund to the Education |
|
Assistance Fund. |
(Source: P.A. 93-680, eff. 7-1-04; 93-839, eff. 7-30-04; |
94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
|
(30 ILCS 105/14.1)
(from Ch. 127, par. 150.1)
|
Sec. 14.1. Appropriations for State contributions to the |
State
Employees' Retirement System; payroll requirements.
|
(a) Appropriations for State contributions to the State
|
Employees' Retirement System of Illinois shall be expended in |
the manner
provided in this Section.
Except as otherwise |
provided in subsection (a-1),
at the time of each payment of |
salary to an
employee under the personal services line item, |
payment shall be made to
the State Employees' Retirement |
System, from the amount appropriated for
State contributions to |
the State Employees' Retirement System, of an amount
calculated |
at the rate certified for the applicable fiscal year by the
|
Board of Trustees of the State Employees' Retirement System |
under Section
14-135.08 of the Illinois Pension Code. If a line |
item appropriation to an
employer for this purpose is exhausted |
or is unavailable due to any limitation on appropriations that |
may apply, (including, but not limited to, limitations on |
appropriations from the Road Fund under Section 8.3 of the |
State Finance Act), the amounts shall be
paid under the |
continuing appropriation for this purpose contained in the |
State
Pension Funds Continuing Appropriation Act.
|
(a-1) Beginning on the effective date of this amendatory |
|
Act of the 93rd
General Assembly through the payment of the |
final payroll from fiscal
year 2004 appropriations, |
appropriations for State contributions to the
State Employees' |
Retirement System of Illinois shall be expended in the
manner |
provided in this subsection (a-1). At the time of each payment |
of
salary to an employee under the personal services line item |
from a fund
other than the General Revenue Fund, payment shall |
be made for deposit
into the General Revenue Fund from the |
amount appropriated for State
contributions to the State |
Employees' Retirement System of an amount
calculated at the |
rate certified for fiscal year 2004 by the Board of
Trustees of |
the State Employees' Retirement System under Section
14-135.08 |
of the Illinois Pension Code. This payment shall be made to
the |
extent that a line item appropriation to an employer for this |
purpose is
available or unexhausted. No payment from |
appropriations for State
contributions shall be made in |
conjunction with payment of salary to an
employee under the |
personal services line item from the General Revenue
Fund.
|
(b) Except during the period beginning on the effective |
date of this
amendatory
Act of the 93rd General Assembly and |
ending at the time of the payment of the
final payroll from |
fiscal year 2004 appropriations, the State Comptroller
shall |
not approve for payment any payroll
voucher that (1) includes |
payments of salary to eligible employees in the
State |
Employees' Retirement System of Illinois and (2) does not |
include the
corresponding payment of State contributions to |
|
that retirement system at the
full rate certified under Section |
14-135.08 for that fiscal year for eligible
employees, unless |
the balance in the fund on which the payroll voucher is drawn
|
is insufficient to pay the total payroll voucher, or |
unavailable due to any limitation on appropriations that may |
apply, including, but not limited to, limitations on |
appropriations from the Road Fund under Section 8.3 of the |
State Finance Act. If the State Comptroller
approves a payroll |
voucher under this Section for which the fund balance is
|
insufficient to pay the full amount of the required State |
contribution to the
State Employees' Retirement System, the |
Comptroller shall promptly so notify
the Retirement System.
|
(c) Notwithstanding any other provisions of law, beginning |
July 1, 2007, required State and employee contributions to the |
State Employees' Retirement System of Illinois relating to |
affected legislative staff employees shall be paid out of |
moneys appropriated for that purpose to the Commission on |
Government Forecasting and Accountability, rather than out of |
the lump-sum appropriations otherwise made for the payroll and |
other costs of those employees. |
These payments must be made pursuant to payroll vouchers |
submitted by the employing entity as part of the regular |
payroll voucher process. |
For the purpose of this subsection, "affected legislative |
staff employees" means legislative staff employees paid out of |
lump-sum appropriations made to the General Assembly, an |
|
Officer of the General Assembly, or the Senate Operations |
Commission, but does not include district-office staff or |
employees of legislative support services agencies. |
(Source: P.A. 93-665, eff. 3-5-04; 93-1067, eff. 1-15-05.)
|
(30 ILCS 105/25.5 new) |
Sec. 25.5. FY2008 payment validation. All expenses |
lawfully incurred during July of 2007 under an appropriation or |
reappropriation included in Public Act 95-11 shall be paid by |
the State Comptroller and State Treasurer at the time and in |
the manner normally provided by law, notwithstanding that the |
appropriation under that Public Act may have expired prior to |
the actual date of payment due to the repeal of that Public |
Act. Any otherwise lawful action of the State Comptroller, the |
State Treasurer, or any public employee in the course of making |
payment in accordance with this Section is hereby validated. |
Section 5-13. The Budget Stabilization Act is amended by |
changing Section 10 as follows: |
(30 ILCS 122/10)
|
Sec. 10. Budget limitations.
|
(a) Except as provided in subsection (b-5), in In addition |
to Section 50-5 of the State Budget Law
of the Civil |
Administrative Code of Illinois, the General
Assembly's |
appropriations and transfers or diversions as required by
law |
|
from general funds shall not exceed
99%
of the estimated |
general funds revenues for the fiscal
year when revenue |
estimates of the State's general funds
revenues exceed the |
prior fiscal year's estimated general
funds revenues by more |
than 4%.
|
(b) Except as provided in subsection (b-5), the The General |
Assembly's appropriations and transfers or
diversions as |
required by law from general
funds shall not exceed 98% of the |
estimated general funds
revenues for the fiscal year when |
revenue estimates of the
State's general funds revenues exceed |
the prior fiscal year's
estimated general funds revenues by |
more than 4% for 2 or
more consecutive fiscal years.
|
(b-5) The limitations on appropriations and transfers or |
diversions set forth under subsections (a) and (b) do not apply |
for State fiscal year 2008. |
(c) For the purpose of this Act, "estimated general funds |
revenues"
include, for each budget year, all taxes, fees, and |
other revenues
expected to be deposited into the State's |
general funds, including
recurring transfers from other State |
funds into the general funds.
|
Year-over-year comparisons used to determine the |
percentage growth
factor of estimated general funds revenues |
shall exclude the sum of the
following: (i) expected revenues |
resulting from new taxes or fees or
from tax or fee increases |
during the first year of the change, (ii)
expected revenues |
resulting from one-time receipts or non-recurring
transfers |
|
in, (iii) expected proceeds resulting from borrowing, and
(iv) |
increases in federal grants that must be completely |
appropriated
based on the terms of the grants.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-660, eff. 7-1-04; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06.) |
Section 5-15. The Illinois Income Tax Act is amended by |
changing Sections 203, 304, 704A, 709.5, 901, 1001, 1007, |
1405.5, 1405.6 and 1501 as follows:
|
(35 ILCS 5/203) (from Ch. 120, par. 2-203)
|
Sec. 203. Base income defined.
|
(a) Individuals.
|
(1) In general. In the case of an individual, base |
income means an
amount equal to the taxpayer's adjusted |
gross income for the taxable
year as modified by paragraph |
(2).
|
(2) Modifications. The adjusted gross income referred |
to in
paragraph (1) shall be modified by adding thereto the |
sum of the
following amounts:
|
(A) An amount equal to all amounts paid or accrued |
to the taxpayer
as interest or dividends during the |
taxable year to the extent excluded
from gross income |
in the computation of adjusted gross income, except |
stock
dividends of qualified public utilities |
described in Section 305(e) of the
Internal Revenue |
Code;
|
|
(B) An amount equal to the amount of tax imposed by |
this Act to the
extent deducted from gross income in |
the computation of adjusted gross
income for the |
taxable year;
|
(C) An amount equal to the amount received during |
the taxable year
as a recovery or refund of real |
property taxes paid with respect to the
taxpayer's |
principal residence under the Revenue Act of
1939 and |
for which a deduction was previously taken under |
subparagraph (L) of
this paragraph (2) prior to July 1, |
1991, the retrospective application date of
Article 4 |
of Public Act 87-17. In the case of multi-unit or |
multi-use
structures and farm dwellings, the taxes on |
the taxpayer's principal residence
shall be that |
portion of the total taxes for the entire property |
which is
attributable to such principal residence;
|
(D) An amount equal to the amount of the capital |
gain deduction
allowable under the Internal Revenue |
Code, to the extent deducted from gross
income in the |
computation of adjusted gross income;
|
(D-5) An amount, to the extent not included in |
adjusted gross income,
equal to the amount of money |
withdrawn by the taxpayer in the taxable year from
a |
medical care savings account and the interest earned on |
the account in the
taxable year of a withdrawal |
pursuant to subsection (b) of Section 20 of the
Medical |
|
Care Savings Account Act or subsection (b) of Section |
20 of the
Medical Care Savings Account Act of 2000;
|
(D-10) For taxable years ending after December 31, |
1997, an
amount equal to any eligible remediation costs |
that the individual
deducted in computing adjusted |
gross income and for which the
individual claims a |
credit under subsection (l) of Section 201;
|
(D-15) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, an |
amount equal to the
bonus depreciation deduction taken |
on the taxpayer's federal income tax return for the |
taxable
year under subsection (k) of Section 168 of the |
Internal Revenue Code;
|
(D-16) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons, |
or otherwise disposes of property for which the |
taxpayer was required in any taxable year to
make an |
addition modification under subparagraph (D-15), then |
an amount equal
to the aggregate amount of the |
deductions taken in all taxable
years under |
subparagraph (Z) with respect to that property.
|
If the taxpayer continues to own property through |
the last day of the last tax year for which the |
taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for |
federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer |
was allowed in any taxable year to make a subtraction |
modification under subparagraph (Z), then an amount |
equal to that subtraction modification.
|
|
The taxpayer is required to make the addition |
modification under this
subparagraph
only once with |
respect to any one piece of property;
|
(D-17) An amount equal to the amount otherwise |
allowed as a deduction in computing base income for |
interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, (i) for taxable years ending on or after |
December 31, 2004, to a foreign person who would be a |
member of the same unitary business group but for the |
fact that foreign person's business activity outside |
the United States is 80% or more of the foreign |
person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person |
who would be a member of the same unitary business |
group but for the fact that the person is prohibited |
under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the |
unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily |
required to apportion business income under different |
subsections of Section 304. The addition modification |
required by this subparagraph shall be reduced to the |
extent that dividends were included in base income of |
the unitary group for the same taxable year and |
received by the taxpayer or by a member of the |
taxpayer's unitary business group (including amounts |
included in gross income under Sections 951 through 964 |
of the Internal Revenue Code and amounts included in |
|
gross income under Section 78 of the Internal Revenue |
Code) with respect to the stock of the same person to |
whom the interest was paid, accrued, or incurred. |
This paragraph shall not apply to the following:
|
(i) an item of interest paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign |
person who is subject in a foreign country or |
state, other than a state which requires mandatory |
unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net |
income with respect to such interest; or |
(ii) an item of interest paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign |
person if the taxpayer can establish, based on a |
preponderance of the evidence, both of the |
following: |
(a) the foreign person, during the same |
taxable year, paid, accrued, or incurred, the |
interest to a person that is not a related |
member, and |
(b) the transaction giving rise to the |
interest expense between the taxpayer and the |
foreign person did not have as a principal |
purpose the avoidance of Illinois income tax, |
and is paid pursuant to a contract or agreement |
that reflects an arm's-length interest rate |
and terms; or
|
|
(iii) the taxpayer can establish, based on |
clear and convincing evidence, that the interest |
paid, accrued, or incurred relates to a contract or |
agreement entered into at arm's-length rates and |
terms and the principal purpose for the payment is |
not federal or Illinois tax avoidance; or
|
(iv) an item of interest paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign |
person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and |
convincing evidence that the adjustments are |
unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director |
agree in writing to the application or use of an |
alternative method of apportionment under Section |
304(f).
|
Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the |
Director from making any other adjustment |
otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for |
any tax year beginning after the effective date of |
this amendment provided such adjustment is made |
pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department |
and such regulations provide methods and standards |
by which the Department will utilize its authority |
under Section 404 of this Act;
|
(D-18) An amount equal to the amount of intangible |
expenses and costs otherwise allowed as a deduction in |
computing base income, and that were paid, accrued, or |
|
incurred, directly or indirectly, (i) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2004, to a |
foreign person who would be a member of the same |
unitary business group but for the fact that the |
foreign person's business activity outside the United |
States is 80% or more of that person's total business |
activity and (ii) for taxable years ending on or after |
December 31, 2008, to a person who would be a member of |
the same unitary business group but for the fact that |
the person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) |
from being included in the unitary business group |
because he or she is ordinarily required to apportion |
business income under different subsections of Section |
304. The addition modification required by this |
subparagraph shall be reduced to the extent that |
dividends were included in base income of the unitary |
group for the same taxable year and received by the |
taxpayer or by a member of the taxpayer's unitary |
business group (including amounts included in gross |
income under Sections 951 through 964 of the Internal |
Revenue Code and amounts included in gross income under |
Section 78 of the Internal Revenue Code) with respect |
to the stock of the same person to whom the intangible |
expenses and costs were directly or indirectly paid, |
incurred, or accrued. The preceding sentence does not |
apply to the extent that the same dividends caused a |
|
reduction to the addition modification required under |
Section 203(a)(2)(D-17) of this Act. As used in this |
subparagraph, the term "intangible expenses and costs" |
includes (1) expenses, losses, and costs for, or |
related to, the direct or indirect acquisition, use, |
maintenance or management, ownership, sale, exchange, |
or any other disposition of intangible property; (2) |
losses incurred, directly or indirectly, from |
factoring transactions or discounting transactions; |
(3) royalty, patent, technical, and copyright fees; |
(4) licensing fees; and (5) other similar expenses and |
costs.
For purposes of this subparagraph, "intangible |
property" includes patents, patent applications, trade |
names, trademarks, service marks, copyrights, mask |
works, trade secrets, and similar types of intangible |
assets. |
This paragraph shall not apply to the following: |
(i) any item of intangible expenses or costs |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign |
person who is subject in a foreign country or |
state, other than a state which requires mandatory |
unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net |
income with respect to such item; or |
(ii) any item of intangible expense or cost |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
|
indirectly, if the taxpayer can establish, based |
on a preponderance of the evidence, both of the |
following: |
(a) the foreign person during the same |
taxable year paid, accrued, or incurred, the |
intangible expense or cost to a person that is |
not a related member, and |
(b) the transaction giving rise to the |
intangible expense or cost between the |
taxpayer and the foreign person did not have as |
a principal purpose the avoidance of Illinois |
income tax, and is paid pursuant to a contract |
or agreement that reflects arm's-length terms; |
or |
(iii) any item of intangible expense or cost |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign |
person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and |
convincing evidence, that the adjustments are |
unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director |
agree in writing to the application or use of an |
alternative method of apportionment under Section |
304(f);
|
Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the |
Director from making any other adjustment |
otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for |
|
any tax year beginning after the effective date of |
this amendment provided such adjustment is made |
pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department |
and such regulations provide methods and standards |
by which the Department will utilize its authority |
under Section 404 of this Act;
|
(D-19) For taxable years ending on or after |
December 31, 2008, an amount equal to the amount of |
insurance premium expenses and costs otherwise allowed |
as a deduction in computing base income, and that were |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to |
a person who would be a member of the same unitary |
business group but for the fact that the person is |
prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from being |
included in the unitary business group because he or |
she is ordinarily required to apportion business |
income under different subsections of Section 304. The |
addition modification required by this subparagraph |
shall be reduced to the extent that dividends were |
included in base income of the unitary group for the |
same taxable year and received by the taxpayer or by a |
member of the taxpayer's unitary business group |
(including amounts included in gross income under |
Sections 951 through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code |
and amounts included in gross income under Section 78 |
of the Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock |
|
of the same person to whom the premiums intangible |
expenses and costs were directly or indirectly paid, |
incurred, or accrued. The preceding sentence does not |
apply to the extent that the same dividends caused a |
reduction to the addition modification required under |
Section 203(a)(2)(D-17) or Section 203(a)(2)(D-18) of |
this Act.
|
(D-20) For taxable years beginning on or after |
January 1,
2002 and ending on or before December 31, |
2006, in
the
case of a distribution from a qualified |
tuition program under Section 529 of
the Internal |
Revenue Code, other than (i) a distribution from a |
College Savings
Pool created under Section 16.5 of the |
State Treasurer Act or (ii) a
distribution from the |
Illinois Prepaid Tuition Trust Fund, an amount equal to
|
the amount excluded from gross income under Section |
529(c)(3)(B). For taxable years beginning on or after |
January 1, 2007, in the case of a distribution from a |
qualified tuition program under Section 529 of the |
Internal Revenue Code, other than (i) a distribution |
from a College Savings Pool created under Section 16.5 |
of the State Treasurer Act, (ii) a distribution from |
the Illinois Prepaid Tuition Trust Fund, or (iii) a |
distribution from a qualified tuition program under |
Section 529 of the Internal Revenue Code that (I) |
adopts and determines that its offering materials |
|
comply with the College Savings Plans Network's |
disclosure principles and (II) has made reasonable |
efforts to inform in-state residents of the existence |
of in-state qualified tuition programs by informing |
Illinois residents directly and, where applicable, to |
inform financial intermediaries distributing the |
program to inform in-state residents of the existence |
of in-state qualified tuition programs at least |
annually, an amount equal to the amount excluded from |
gross income under Section 529(c)(3)(B). |
For the purposes of this subparagraph (D-20), a |
qualified tuition program has made reasonable efforts |
if it makes disclosures (which may use the term |
"in-state program" or "in-state plan" and need not |
specifically refer to Illinois or its qualified |
programs by name) (i) directly to prospective |
participants in its offering materials or makes a |
public disclosure, such as a website posting; and (ii) |
where applicable, to intermediaries selling the |
out-of-state program in the same manner that the |
out-of-state program distributes its offering |
materials;
|
(D-21) For taxable years beginning on or after |
January 1, 2007, in the case of transfer of moneys from |
a qualified tuition program under Section 529 of the |
Internal Revenue Code that is administered by the State |
|
to an out-of-state program, an amount equal to the |
amount of moneys previously deducted from base income |
under subsection (a)(2)(Y) of this Section.
|
and by deducting from the total so obtained the
sum of the |
following amounts:
|
(E) For taxable years ending before December 31, |
2001,
any amount included in such total in respect of |
any compensation
(including but not limited to any |
compensation paid or accrued to a
serviceman while a |
prisoner of war or missing in action) paid to a |
resident
by reason of being on active duty in the Armed |
Forces of the United States
and in respect of any |
compensation paid or accrued to a resident who as a
|
governmental employee was a prisoner of war or missing |
in action, and in
respect of any compensation paid to a |
resident in 1971 or thereafter for
annual training |
performed pursuant to Sections 502 and 503, Title 32,
|
United States Code as a member of the Illinois National |
Guard or, beginning with taxable years ending on or |
after December 31, 2007, the National Guard of any |
other state.
For taxable years ending on or after |
December 31, 2001, any amount included in
such total in |
respect of any compensation (including but not limited |
to any
compensation paid or accrued to a serviceman |
while a prisoner of war or missing
in action) paid to a |
resident by reason of being a member of any component |
|
of
the Armed Forces of the United States and in respect |
of any compensation paid
or accrued to a resident who |
as a governmental employee was a prisoner of war
or |
missing in action, and in respect of any compensation |
paid to a resident in
2001 or thereafter by reason of |
being a member of the Illinois National Guard or, |
beginning with taxable years ending on or after |
December 31, 2007, the National Guard of any other |
state.
The provisions of this amendatory Act of the |
92nd General Assembly are exempt
from the provisions of |
Section 250;
|
(F) An amount equal to all amounts included in such |
total pursuant
to the provisions of Sections 402(a), |
402(c), 403(a), 403(b), 406(a), 407(a),
and 408 of the |
Internal Revenue Code, or included in such total as
|
distributions under the provisions of any retirement |
or disability plan for
employees of any governmental |
agency or unit, or retirement payments to
retired |
partners, which payments are excluded in computing net |
earnings
from self employment by Section 1402 of the |
Internal Revenue Code and
regulations adopted pursuant |
thereto;
|
(G) The valuation limitation amount;
|
(H) An amount equal to the amount of any tax |
imposed by this Act
which was refunded to the taxpayer |
and included in such total for the
taxable year;
|
|
(I) An amount equal to all amounts included in such |
total pursuant
to the provisions of Section 111 of the |
Internal Revenue Code as a
recovery of items previously |
deducted from adjusted gross income in the
computation |
of taxable income;
|
(J) An amount equal to those dividends included in |
such total which were
paid by a corporation which |
conducts business operations in an Enterprise
Zone or |
zones created under the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act or |
a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or zones created under |
the River Edge Redevelopment Zone Act, and conducts
|
substantially all of its operations in an Enterprise |
Zone or zones or a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or |
zones. This subparagraph (J) is exempt from the |
provisions of Section 250;
|
(K) An amount equal to those dividends included in |
such total that
were paid by a corporation that |
conducts business operations in a federally
designated |
Foreign Trade Zone or Sub-Zone and that is designated a |
High Impact
Business located in Illinois; provided |
that dividends eligible for the
deduction provided in |
subparagraph (J) of paragraph (2) of this subsection
|
shall not be eligible for the deduction provided under |
this subparagraph
(K);
|
(L) For taxable years ending after December 31, |
1983, an amount equal to
all social security benefits |
|
and railroad retirement benefits included in
such |
total pursuant to Sections 72(r) and 86 of the Internal |
Revenue Code;
|
(M) With the exception of any amounts subtracted |
under subparagraph
(N), an amount equal to the sum of |
all amounts disallowed as
deductions by (i) Sections |
171(a) (2), and 265(2) of the Internal Revenue Code
of |
1954, as now or hereafter amended, and all amounts of |
expenses allocable
to interest and disallowed as |
deductions by Section 265(1) of the Internal
Revenue |
Code of 1954, as now or hereafter amended;
and (ii) for |
taxable years
ending on or after August 13, 1999, |
Sections 171(a)(2), 265,
280C, and 832(b)(5)(B)(i) of |
the Internal Revenue Code; the provisions of this
|
subparagraph are exempt from the provisions of Section |
250;
|
(N) An amount equal to all amounts included in such |
total which are
exempt from taxation by this State |
either by reason of its statutes or
Constitution
or by |
reason of the Constitution, treaties or statutes of the |
United States;
provided that, in the case of any |
statute of this State or, for taxable years ending on |
or after December 31, 2008, of the United States, any |
treaty of the United States, the Illinois |
Constitution, or the United States Constitution that |
exempts income
derived from bonds or other obligations |
|
from the tax imposed under this Act,
the amount |
exempted shall be the interest income net of bond |
premium amortization , and, for taxable years ending on |
or after December 31, 2008, interest expense incurred |
on indebtedness to carry the bond or other obligation, |
expenses incurred in producing the income to be |
deducted, and all other related expenses. The amount of |
expenses to be taken into account under this provision |
may not exceed the amount of income that is exempted ;
|
(O) An amount equal to any contribution made to a |
job training
project established pursuant to the Tax |
Increment Allocation Redevelopment Act;
|
(P) An amount equal to the amount of the deduction |
used to compute the
federal income tax credit for |
restoration of substantial amounts held under
claim of |
right for the taxable year pursuant to Section 1341 of |
the
Internal Revenue Code of 1986;
|
(Q) An amount equal to any amounts included in such |
total, received by
the taxpayer as an acceleration in |
the payment of life, endowment or annuity
benefits in |
advance of the time they would otherwise be payable as |
an indemnity
for a terminal illness;
|
(R) An amount equal to the amount of any federal or |
State bonus paid
to veterans of the Persian Gulf War;
|
(S) An amount, to the extent included in adjusted |
gross income, equal
to the amount of a contribution |
|
made in the taxable year on behalf of the
taxpayer to a |
medical care savings account established under the |
Medical Care
Savings Account Act or the Medical Care |
Savings Account Act of 2000 to the
extent the |
contribution is accepted by the account
administrator |
as provided in that Act;
|
(T) An amount, to the extent included in adjusted |
gross income, equal to
the amount of interest earned in |
the taxable year on a medical care savings
account |
established under the Medical Care Savings Account Act |
or the Medical
Care Savings Account Act of 2000 on |
behalf of the
taxpayer, other than interest added |
pursuant to item (D-5) of this paragraph
(2);
|
(U) For one taxable year beginning on or after |
January 1,
1994, an
amount equal to the total amount of |
tax imposed and paid under subsections (a)
and (b) of |
Section 201 of this Act on grant amounts received by |
the taxpayer
under the Nursing Home Grant Assistance |
Act during the taxpayer's taxable years
1992 and 1993;
|
(V) Beginning with tax years ending on or after |
December 31, 1995 and
ending with tax years ending on |
or before December 31, 2004, an amount equal to
the |
amount paid by a taxpayer who is a
self-employed |
taxpayer, a partner of a partnership, or a
shareholder |
in a Subchapter S corporation for health insurance or |
long-term
care insurance for that taxpayer or that |
|
taxpayer's spouse or dependents, to
the extent that the |
amount paid for that health insurance or long-term care
|
insurance may be deducted under Section 213 of the |
Internal Revenue Code of
1986, has not been deducted on |
the federal income tax return of the taxpayer,
and does |
not exceed the taxable income attributable to that |
taxpayer's income,
self-employment income, or |
Subchapter S corporation income; except that no
|
deduction shall be allowed under this item (V) if the |
taxpayer is eligible to
participate in any health |
insurance or long-term care insurance plan of an
|
employer of the taxpayer or the taxpayer's
spouse. The |
amount of the health insurance and long-term care |
insurance
subtracted under this item (V) shall be |
determined by multiplying total
health insurance and |
long-term care insurance premiums paid by the taxpayer
|
times a number that represents the fractional |
percentage of eligible medical
expenses under Section |
213 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 not actually
|
deducted on the taxpayer's federal income tax return;
|
(W) For taxable years beginning on or after January |
1, 1998,
all amounts included in the taxpayer's federal |
gross income
in the taxable year from amounts converted |
from a regular IRA to a Roth IRA.
This paragraph is |
exempt from the provisions of Section
250;
|
(X) For taxable year 1999 and thereafter, an amount |
|
equal to the
amount of any (i) distributions, to the |
extent includible in gross income for
federal income |
tax purposes, made to the taxpayer because of his or |
her status
as a victim of persecution for racial or |
religious reasons by Nazi Germany or
any other Axis |
regime or as an heir of the victim and (ii) items
of |
income, to the extent
includible in gross income for |
federal income tax purposes, attributable to,
derived |
from or in any way related to assets stolen from, |
hidden from, or
otherwise lost to a victim of
|
persecution for racial or religious reasons by Nazi |
Germany or any other Axis
regime immediately prior to, |
during, and immediately after World War II,
including, |
but
not limited to, interest on the proceeds receivable |
as insurance
under policies issued to a victim of |
persecution for racial or religious
reasons
by Nazi |
Germany or any other Axis regime by European insurance |
companies
immediately prior to and during World War II;
|
provided, however, this subtraction from federal |
adjusted gross income does not
apply to assets acquired |
with such assets or with the proceeds from the sale of
|
such assets; provided, further, this paragraph shall |
only apply to a taxpayer
who was the first recipient of |
such assets after their recovery and who is a
victim of |
persecution for racial or religious reasons
by Nazi |
Germany or any other Axis regime or as an heir of the |
|
victim. The
amount of and the eligibility for any |
public assistance, benefit, or
similar entitlement is |
not affected by the inclusion of items (i) and (ii) of
|
this paragraph in gross income for federal income tax |
purposes.
This paragraph is exempt from the provisions |
of Section 250;
|
(Y) For taxable years beginning on or after January |
1, 2002
and ending
on or before December 31, 2004, |
moneys contributed in the taxable year to a College |
Savings Pool account under
Section 16.5 of the State |
Treasurer Act, except that amounts excluded from
gross |
income under Section 529(c)(3)(C)(i) of the Internal |
Revenue Code
shall not be considered moneys |
contributed under this subparagraph (Y). For taxable |
years beginning on or after January 1, 2005, a maximum |
of $10,000
contributed
in the
taxable year to (i) a |
College Savings Pool account under Section 16.5 of the
|
State
Treasurer Act or (ii) the Illinois Prepaid |
Tuition Trust Fund,
except that
amounts excluded from |
gross income under Section 529(c)(3)(C)(i) of the
|
Internal
Revenue Code shall not be considered moneys |
contributed under this subparagraph
(Y). This
|
subparagraph (Y) is exempt from the provisions of |
Section 250;
|
(Z) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, for the |
taxable year in
which the bonus depreciation deduction
|
|
is taken on the taxpayer's federal income tax return |
under
subsection (k) of Section 168 of the Internal |
Revenue Code and for each
applicable taxable year |
thereafter, an amount equal to "x", where:
|
(1) "y" equals the amount of the depreciation |
deduction taken for the
taxable year
on the |
taxpayer's federal income tax return on property |
for which the bonus
depreciation deduction
was |
taken in any year under subsection (k) of Section |
168 of the Internal
Revenue Code, but not including |
the bonus depreciation deduction;
|
(2) for taxable years ending on or before |
December 31, 2005, "x" equals "y" multiplied by 30 |
and then divided by 70 (or "y"
multiplied by |
0.429); and |
(3) for taxable years ending after December |
31, 2005: |
(i) for property on which a bonus |
depreciation deduction of 30% of the adjusted |
basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by |
30 and then divided by 70 (or "y"
multiplied by |
0.429); and |
(ii) for property on which a bonus |
depreciation deduction of 50% of the adjusted |
basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by |
1.0.
|
|
The aggregate amount deducted under this |
subparagraph in all taxable
years for any one piece of |
property may not exceed the amount of the bonus
|
depreciation deduction
taken on that property on the |
taxpayer's federal income tax return under
subsection |
(k) of Section 168 of the Internal Revenue Code. This |
subparagraph (Z) is exempt from the provisions of |
Section 250;
|
(AA) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons, |
or otherwise disposes of
property for which the |
taxpayer was required in any taxable year to make an
|
addition modification under subparagraph (D-15), then |
an amount equal to that
addition modification.
|
If the taxpayer continues to own property through |
the last day of the last tax year for which the |
taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for |
federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer |
was required in any taxable year to make an addition |
modification under subparagraph (D-15), then an amount |
equal to that addition modification.
|
The taxpayer is allowed to take the deduction under |
this subparagraph
only once with respect to any one |
piece of property. |
This subparagraph (AA) is exempt from the |
provisions of Section 250;
|
(BB) Any amount included in adjusted gross income, |
|
other
than
salary,
received by a driver in a |
ridesharing arrangement using a motor vehicle;
|
(CC) The amount of (i) any interest income (net of |
the deductions allocable thereto) taken into account |
for the taxable year with respect to a transaction with |
a taxpayer that is required to make an addition |
modification with respect to such transaction under |
Section 203(a)(2)(D-17), 203(b)(2)(E-12), |
203(c)(2)(G-12), or 203(d)(2)(D-7), but not to exceed |
the amount of that addition modification, and
(ii) any |
income from intangible property (net of the deductions |
allocable thereto) taken into account for the taxable |
year with respect to a transaction with a taxpayer that |
is required to make an addition modification with |
respect to such transaction under Section |
203(a)(2)(D-18), 203(b)(2)(E-13), 203(c)(2)(G-13), or |
203(d)(2)(D-8), but not to exceed the amount of that |
addition modification . This subparagraph (CC) is |
exempt from the provisions of Section 250 ; |
(DD) An amount equal to the interest income taken |
into account for the taxable year (net of the |
deductions allocable thereto) with respect to |
transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a |
member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for |
the fact that the foreign person's business activity |
outside the United States is 80% or more of that |
|
person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person |
who would be a member of the same unitary business |
group but for the fact that the person is prohibited |
under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the |
unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily |
required to apportion business income under different |
subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the |
addition modification required to be made for the same |
taxable year under Section 203(a)(2)(D-17) for |
interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, to the same person . This subparagraph (DD) |
is exempt from the provisions of Section 250 ; and |
(EE) An amount equal to the income from intangible |
property taken into account for the taxable year (net |
of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to |
transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a |
member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for |
the fact that the foreign person's business activity |
outside the United States is 80% or more of that |
person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person |
who would be a member of the same unitary business |
group but for the fact that the person is prohibited |
under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the |
unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily |
|
required to apportion business income under different |
subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the |
addition modification required to be made for the same |
taxable year under Section 203(a)(2)(D-18) for |
intangible expenses and costs paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to the same foreign |
person . This subparagraph (EE) is exempt from the |
provisions of Section 250. ; and
|
(FF) An amount equal to the income from insurance |
premiums taken into account for the taxable year (net |
of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to |
transactions with a person who would be a member of the |
same unitary business group but for the fact that the |
person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from |
being included in the unitary business group because he |
or she is ordinarily required to apportion business |
income under different subsections of Section 304, but |
not to exceed the addition modification required to be |
made for the same taxable year under Section |
203(a)(2)(D-18) for intangible expenses and costs |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to |
the same person.
|
(b) Corporations.
|
(1) In general. In the case of a corporation, base |
income means an
amount equal to the taxpayer's taxable |
|
income for the taxable year as
modified by paragraph (2).
|
(2) Modifications. The taxable income referred to in |
paragraph (1)
shall be modified by adding thereto the sum |
of the following amounts:
|
(A) An amount equal to all amounts paid or accrued |
to the taxpayer
as interest and all distributions |
received from regulated investment
companies during |
the taxable year to the extent excluded from gross
|
income in the computation of taxable income;
|
(B) An amount equal to the amount of tax imposed by |
this Act to the
extent deducted from gross income in |
the computation of taxable income
for the taxable year;
|
(C) In the case of a regulated investment company, |
an amount equal to
the excess of (i) the net long-term |
capital gain for the taxable year, over
(ii) the amount |
of the capital gain dividends designated as such in |
accordance
with Section 852(b)(3)(C) of the Internal |
Revenue Code and any amount
designated under Section |
852(b)(3)(D) of the Internal Revenue Code,
|
attributable to the taxable year (this amendatory Act |
of 1995
(Public Act 89-89) is declarative of existing |
law and is not a new
enactment);
|
(D) The amount of any net operating loss deduction |
taken in arriving
at taxable income, other than a net |
operating loss carried forward from a
taxable year |
ending prior to December 31, 1986;
|
|
(E) For taxable years in which a net operating loss |
carryback or
carryforward from a taxable year ending |
prior to December 31, 1986 is an
element of taxable |
income under paragraph (1) of subsection (e) or
|
subparagraph (E) of paragraph (2) of subsection (e), |
the amount by which
addition modifications other than |
those provided by this subparagraph (E)
exceeded |
subtraction modifications in such earlier taxable |
year, with the
following limitations applied in the |
order that they are listed:
|
(i) the addition modification relating to the |
net operating loss
carried back or forward to the |
taxable year from any taxable year ending
prior to |
December 31, 1986 shall be reduced by the amount of |
addition
modification under this subparagraph (E) |
which related to that net operating
loss and which |
was taken into account in calculating the base |
income of an
earlier taxable year, and
|
(ii) the addition modification relating to the |
net operating loss
carried back or forward to the |
taxable year from any taxable year ending
prior to |
December 31, 1986 shall not exceed the amount of |
such carryback or
carryforward;
|
For taxable years in which there is a net operating |
loss carryback or
carryforward from more than one other |
taxable year ending prior to December
31, 1986, the |
|
addition modification provided in this subparagraph |
(E) shall
be the sum of the amounts computed |
independently under the preceding
provisions of this |
subparagraph (E) for each such taxable year;
|
(E-5) For taxable years ending after December 31, |
1997, an
amount equal to any eligible remediation costs |
that the corporation
deducted in computing adjusted |
gross income and for which the
corporation claims a |
credit under subsection (l) of Section 201;
|
(E-10) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, an |
amount equal to the
bonus depreciation deduction taken |
on the taxpayer's federal income tax return for the |
taxable
year under subsection (k) of Section 168 of the |
Internal Revenue Code; and
|
(E-11) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons, |
or otherwise disposes of property for which the |
taxpayer was required in any taxable year to
make an |
addition modification under subparagraph (E-10), then |
an amount equal
to the aggregate amount of the |
deductions taken in all taxable
years under |
subparagraph (T) with respect to that property.
|
If the taxpayer continues to own property through |
the last day of the last tax year for which the |
taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for |
federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer |
was allowed in any taxable year to make a subtraction |
|
modification under subparagraph (T), then an amount |
equal to that subtraction modification.
|
The taxpayer is required to make the addition |
modification under this
subparagraph
only once with |
respect to any one piece of property;
|
(E-12) An amount equal to the amount otherwise |
allowed as a deduction in computing base income for |
interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, (i) for taxable years ending on or after |
December 31, 2004, to a foreign person who would be a |
member of the same unitary business group but for the |
fact the foreign person's business activity outside |
the United States is 80% or more of the foreign |
person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person |
who would be a member of the same unitary business |
group but for the fact that the person is prohibited |
under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the |
unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily |
required to apportion business income under different |
subsections of Section 304. The addition modification |
required by this subparagraph shall be reduced to the |
extent that dividends were included in base income of |
the unitary group for the same taxable year and |
received by the taxpayer or by a member of the |
taxpayer's unitary business group (including amounts |
|
included in gross income pursuant to Sections 951 |
through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code and amounts |
included in gross income under Section 78 of the |
Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock of the |
same person to whom the interest was paid, accrued, or |
incurred.
|
This paragraph shall not apply to the following:
|
(i) an item of interest paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign |
person who is subject in a foreign country or |
state, other than a state which requires mandatory |
unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net |
income with respect to such interest; or |
(ii) an item of interest paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign |
person if the taxpayer can establish, based on a |
preponderance of the evidence, both of the |
following: |
(a) the foreign person, during the same |
taxable year, paid, accrued, or incurred, the |
interest to a person that is not a related |
member, and |
(b) the transaction giving rise to the |
interest expense between the taxpayer and the |
foreign person did not have as a principal |
purpose the avoidance of Illinois income tax, |
|
and is paid pursuant to a contract or agreement |
that reflects an arm's-length interest rate |
and terms; or
|
(iii) the taxpayer can establish, based on |
clear and convincing evidence, that the interest |
paid, accrued, or incurred relates to a contract or |
agreement entered into at arm's-length rates and |
terms and the principal purpose for the payment is |
not federal or Illinois tax avoidance; or
|
(iv) an item of interest paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign |
person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and |
convincing evidence that the adjustments are |
unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director |
agree in writing to the application or use of an |
alternative method of apportionment under Section |
304(f).
|
Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the |
Director from making any other adjustment |
otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for |
any tax year beginning after the effective date of |
this amendment provided such adjustment is made |
pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department |
and such regulations provide methods and standards |
by which the Department will utilize its authority |
under Section 404 of this Act;
|
|
(E-13) An amount equal to the amount of intangible |
expenses and costs otherwise allowed as a deduction in |
computing base income, and that were paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, (i) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2004, to a |
foreign person who would be a member of the same |
unitary business group but for the fact that the |
foreign person's business activity outside the United |
States is 80% or more of that person's total business |
activity and (ii) for taxable years ending on or after |
December 31, 2008, to a person who would be a member of |
the same unitary business group but for the fact that |
the person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) |
from being included in the unitary business group |
because he or she is ordinarily required to apportion |
business income under different subsections of Section |
304. The addition modification required by this |
subparagraph shall be reduced to the extent that |
dividends were included in base income of the unitary |
group for the same taxable year and received by the |
taxpayer or by a member of the taxpayer's unitary |
business group (including amounts included in gross |
income pursuant to Sections 951 through 964 of the |
Internal Revenue Code and amounts included in gross |
income under Section 78 of the Internal Revenue Code) |
with respect to the stock of the same person to whom |
|
the intangible expenses and costs were directly or |
indirectly paid, incurred, or accrued. The preceding |
sentence shall not apply to the extent that the same |
dividends caused a reduction to the addition |
modification required under Section 203(b)(2)(E-12) of |
this Act.
As used in this subparagraph, the term |
"intangible expenses and costs" includes (1) expenses, |
losses, and costs for, or related to, the direct or |
indirect acquisition, use, maintenance or management, |
ownership, sale, exchange, or any other disposition of |
intangible property; (2) losses incurred, directly or |
indirectly, from factoring transactions or discounting |
transactions; (3) royalty, patent, technical, and |
copyright fees; (4) licensing fees; and (5) other |
similar expenses and costs.
For purposes of this |
subparagraph, "intangible property" includes patents, |
patent applications, trade names, trademarks, service |
marks, copyrights, mask works, trade secrets, and |
similar types of intangible assets. |
This paragraph shall not apply to the following: |
(i) any item of intangible expenses or costs |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign |
person who is subject in a foreign country or |
state, other than a state which requires mandatory |
unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net |
|
income with respect to such item; or |
(ii) any item of intangible expense or cost |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, if the taxpayer can establish, based |
on a preponderance of the evidence, both of the |
following: |
(a) the foreign person during the same |
taxable year paid, accrued, or incurred, the |
intangible expense or cost to a person that is |
not a related member, and |
(b) the transaction giving rise to the |
intangible expense or cost between the |
taxpayer and the foreign person did not have as |
a principal purpose the avoidance of Illinois |
income tax, and is paid pursuant to a contract |
or agreement that reflects arm's-length terms; |
or |
(iii) any item of intangible expense or cost |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign |
person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and |
convincing evidence, that the adjustments are |
unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director |
agree in writing to the application or use of an |
alternative method of apportionment under Section |
304(f);
|
|
Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the |
Director from making any other adjustment |
otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for |
any tax year beginning after the effective date of |
this amendment provided such adjustment is made |
pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department |
and such regulations provide methods and standards |
by which the Department will utilize its authority |
under Section 404 of this Act;
|
(E-14) For taxable years ending on or after |
December 31, 2008, an amount equal to the amount of |
insurance premium expenses and costs otherwise allowed |
as a deduction in computing base income, and that were |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to |
a person who would be a member of the same unitary |
business group but for the fact that the person is |
prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from being |
included in the unitary business group because he or |
she is ordinarily required to apportion business |
income under different subsections of Section 304. The |
addition modification required by this subparagraph |
shall be reduced to the extent that dividends were |
included in base income of the unitary group for the |
same taxable year and received by the taxpayer or by a |
member of the taxpayer's unitary business group |
(including amounts included in gross income under |
|
Sections 951 through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code |
and amounts included in gross income under Section 78 |
of the Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock |
of the same person to whom the premiums intangible |
expenses and costs were directly or indirectly paid, |
incurred, or accrued. The preceding sentence does not |
apply to the extent that the same dividends caused a |
reduction to the addition modification required under |
Section 203(b)(2)(E-12) or Section 203(b)(2)(E-13) |
203(a)(2)(D-17) of this Act;
|
(E-15) For taxable years beginning after December |
31, 2008, any deduction for dividends paid to a |
corporation by a captive real estate investment trust |
that is allowed to a real estate investment trust under |
Section 857(b)(2)(B) of the Internal Revenue Code for |
dividends paid;
|
and by deducting from the total so obtained the sum of the |
following
amounts:
|
(F) An amount equal to the amount of any tax |
imposed by this Act
which was refunded to the taxpayer |
and included in such total for the
taxable year;
|
(G) An amount equal to any amount included in such |
total under
Section 78 of the Internal Revenue Code;
|
(H) In the case of a regulated investment company, |
an amount equal
to the amount of exempt interest |
dividends as defined in subsection (b)
(5) of Section |
|
852 of the Internal Revenue Code, paid to shareholders
|
for the taxable year;
|
(I) With the exception of any amounts subtracted |
under subparagraph
(J),
an amount equal to the sum of |
all amounts disallowed as
deductions by (i) Sections |
171(a) (2), and 265(a)(2) and amounts disallowed as
|
interest expense by Section 291(a)(3) of the Internal |
Revenue Code, as now
or hereafter amended, and all |
amounts of expenses allocable to interest and
|
disallowed as deductions by Section 265(a)(1) of the |
Internal Revenue Code,
as now or hereafter amended;
and |
(ii) for taxable years
ending on or after August 13, |
1999, Sections
171(a)(2), 265,
280C, 291(a)(3), and |
832(b)(5)(B)(i) of the Internal Revenue Code; the
|
provisions of this
subparagraph are exempt from the |
provisions of Section 250;
|
(J) An amount equal to all amounts included in such |
total which are
exempt from taxation by this State |
either by reason of its statutes or
Constitution
or by |
reason of the Constitution, treaties or statutes of the |
United States;
provided that, in the case of any |
statute of this State or, for taxable years ending on |
or after December 31, 2008, of the United States, any |
treaty of the United States, the Illinois |
Constitution, or the United States Constitution that |
exempts income
derived from bonds or other obligations |
|
from the tax imposed under this Act,
the amount |
exempted shall be the interest income net of bond |
premium amortization , and, for taxable years ending on |
or after December 31, 2008, interest expense incurred |
on indebtedness to carry the bond or other obligation, |
expenses incurred in producing the income to be |
deducted, and all other related expenses. The amount of |
expenses to be taken into account under this provision |
may not exceed the amount of income that is exempted ;
|
(K) An amount equal to those dividends included in |
such total
which were paid by a corporation which |
conducts
business operations in an Enterprise Zone or |
zones created under
the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act or |
a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or zones created under |
the River Edge Redevelopment Zone Act and conducts |
substantially all of its
operations in an Enterprise |
Zone or zones or a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or |
zones. This subparagraph (K) is exempt from the |
provisions of Section 250;
|
(L) An amount equal to those dividends included in |
such total that
were paid by a corporation that |
conducts business operations in a federally
designated |
Foreign Trade Zone or Sub-Zone and that is designated a |
High Impact
Business located in Illinois; provided |
that dividends eligible for the
deduction provided in |
subparagraph (K) of paragraph 2 of this subsection
|
|
shall not be eligible for the deduction provided under |
this subparagraph
(L);
|
(M) For any taxpayer that is a financial |
organization within the meaning
of Section 304(c) of |
this Act, an amount included in such total as interest
|
income from a loan or loans made by such taxpayer to a |
borrower, to the extent
that such a loan is secured by |
property which is eligible for the Enterprise
Zone |
Investment Credit or the River Edge Redevelopment Zone |
Investment Credit. To determine the portion of a loan |
or loans that is
secured by property eligible for a |
Section 201(f) investment
credit to the borrower, the |
entire principal amount of the loan or loans
between |
the taxpayer and the borrower should be divided into |
the basis of the
Section 201(f) investment credit |
property which secures the
loan or loans, using for |
this purpose the original basis of such property on
the |
date that it was placed in service in the
Enterprise |
Zone or the River Edge Redevelopment Zone. The |
subtraction modification available to taxpayer in any
|
year under this subsection shall be that portion of the |
total interest paid
by the borrower with respect to |
such loan attributable to the eligible
property as |
calculated under the previous sentence. This |
subparagraph (M) is exempt from the provisions of |
Section 250;
|
|
(M-1) For any taxpayer that is a financial |
organization within the
meaning of Section 304(c) of |
this Act, an amount included in such total as
interest |
income from a loan or loans made by such taxpayer to a |
borrower,
to the extent that such a loan is secured by |
property which is eligible for
the High Impact Business |
Investment Credit. To determine the portion of a
loan |
or loans that is secured by property eligible for a |
Section 201(h) investment credit to the borrower, the |
entire principal amount of
the loan or loans between |
the taxpayer and the borrower should be divided into
|
the basis of the Section 201(h) investment credit |
property which
secures the loan or loans, using for |
this purpose the original basis of such
property on the |
date that it was placed in service in a federally |
designated
Foreign Trade Zone or Sub-Zone located in |
Illinois. No taxpayer that is
eligible for the |
deduction provided in subparagraph (M) of paragraph |
(2) of
this subsection shall be eligible for the |
deduction provided under this
subparagraph (M-1). The |
subtraction modification available to taxpayers in
any |
year under this subsection shall be that portion of the |
total interest
paid by the borrower with respect to |
such loan attributable to the eligible
property as |
calculated under the previous sentence;
|
(N) Two times any contribution made during the |
|
taxable year to a
designated zone organization to the |
extent that the contribution (i)
qualifies as a |
charitable contribution under subsection (c) of |
Section 170
of the Internal Revenue Code and (ii) must, |
by its terms, be used for a
project approved by the |
Department of Commerce and Economic Opportunity under |
Section 11 of the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act or under |
Section 10-10 of the River Edge Redevelopment Zone Act. |
This subparagraph (N) is exempt from the provisions of |
Section 250;
|
(O) An amount equal to: (i) 85% for taxable years |
ending on or before
December 31, 1992, or, a percentage |
equal to the percentage allowable under
Section |
243(a)(1) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 for |
taxable years ending
after December 31, 1992, of the |
amount by which dividends included in taxable
income |
and received from a corporation that is not created or |
organized under
the laws of the United States or any |
state or political subdivision thereof,
including, for |
taxable years ending on or after December 31, 1988, |
dividends
received or deemed received or paid or deemed |
paid under Sections 951 through
964 of the Internal |
Revenue Code, exceed the amount of the modification
|
provided under subparagraph (G) of paragraph (2) of |
this subsection (b) which
is related to such dividends, |
and including, for taxable years ending on or after |
|
December 31, 2008, dividends received from a captive |
real estate investment trust; plus (ii) 100% of the |
amount by which dividends,
included in taxable income |
and received, including, for taxable years ending on
or |
after December 31, 1988, dividends received or deemed |
received or paid or
deemed paid under Sections 951 |
through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code and including, |
for taxable years ending on or after December 31, 2008, |
dividends received from a captive real estate |
investment trust, from
any such corporation specified |
in clause (i) that would but for the provisions
of |
Section 1504 (b) (3) of the Internal Revenue Code be |
treated as a member of
the affiliated group which |
includes the dividend recipient, exceed the amount
of |
the modification provided under subparagraph (G) of |
paragraph (2) of this
subsection (b) which is related |
to such dividends . This subparagraph (O) is exempt from |
the provisions of Section 250 of this Act ;
|
(P) An amount equal to any contribution made to a |
job training project
established pursuant to the Tax |
Increment Allocation Redevelopment Act;
|
(Q) An amount equal to the amount of the deduction |
used to compute the
federal income tax credit for |
restoration of substantial amounts held under
claim of |
right for the taxable year pursuant to Section 1341 of |
the
Internal Revenue Code of 1986;
|
|
(R) On and after July 20, 1999, in the case of an |
attorney-in-fact with respect to whom an
interinsurer |
or a reciprocal insurer has made the election under |
Section 835 of
the Internal Revenue Code, 26 U.S.C. |
835, an amount equal to the excess, if
any, of the |
amounts paid or incurred by that interinsurer or |
reciprocal insurer
in the taxable year to the |
attorney-in-fact over the deduction allowed to that
|
interinsurer or reciprocal insurer with respect to the |
attorney-in-fact under
Section 835(b) of the Internal |
Revenue Code for the taxable year; the provisions of |
this subparagraph are exempt from the provisions of |
Section 250;
|
(S) For taxable years ending on or after December |
31, 1997, in the
case of a Subchapter
S corporation, an |
amount equal to all amounts of income allocable to a
|
shareholder subject to the Personal Property Tax |
Replacement Income Tax imposed
by subsections (c) and |
(d) of Section 201 of this Act, including amounts
|
allocable to organizations exempt from federal income |
tax by reason of Section
501(a) of the Internal Revenue |
Code. This subparagraph (S) is exempt from
the |
provisions of Section 250;
|
(T) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, for the |
taxable year in
which the bonus depreciation deduction
|
is taken on the taxpayer's federal income tax return |
|
under
subsection (k) of Section 168 of the Internal |
Revenue Code and for each
applicable taxable year |
thereafter, an amount equal to "x", where:
|
(1) "y" equals the amount of the depreciation |
deduction taken for the
taxable year
on the |
taxpayer's federal income tax return on property |
for which the bonus
depreciation deduction
was |
taken in any year under subsection (k) of Section |
168 of the Internal
Revenue Code, but not including |
the bonus depreciation deduction;
|
(2) for taxable years ending on or before |
December 31, 2005, "x" equals "y" multiplied by 30 |
and then divided by 70 (or "y"
multiplied by |
0.429); and |
(3) for taxable years ending after December |
31, 2005: |
(i) for property on which a bonus |
depreciation deduction of 30% of the adjusted |
basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by |
30 and then divided by 70 (or "y"
multiplied by |
0.429); and |
(ii) for property on which a bonus |
depreciation deduction of 50% of the adjusted |
basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by |
1.0.
|
The aggregate amount deducted under this |
|
subparagraph in all taxable
years for any one piece of |
property may not exceed the amount of the bonus
|
depreciation deduction
taken on that property on the |
taxpayer's federal income tax return under
subsection |
(k) of Section 168 of the Internal Revenue Code. This |
subparagraph (T) is exempt from the provisions of |
Section 250;
|
(U) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons, or |
otherwise disposes of
property for which the taxpayer |
was required in any taxable year to make an
addition |
modification under subparagraph (E-10), then an amount |
equal to that
addition modification.
|
If the taxpayer continues to own property through |
the last day of the last tax year for which the |
taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for |
federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer |
was required in any taxable year to make an addition |
modification under subparagraph (E-10), then an amount |
equal to that addition modification.
|
The taxpayer is allowed to take the deduction under |
this subparagraph
only once with respect to any one |
piece of property. |
This subparagraph (U) is exempt from the |
provisions of Section 250;
|
(V) The amount of: (i) any interest income (net of |
the deductions allocable thereto) taken into account |
|
for the taxable year with respect to a transaction with |
a taxpayer that is required to make an addition |
modification with respect to such transaction under |
Section 203(a)(2)(D-17), 203(b)(2)(E-12), |
203(c)(2)(G-12), or 203(d)(2)(D-7), but not to exceed |
the amount of such addition modification , and
(ii) any |
income from intangible property (net of the deductions |
allocable thereto) taken into account for the taxable |
year with respect to a transaction with a taxpayer that |
is required to make an addition modification with |
respect to such transaction under Section |
203(a)(2)(D-18), 203(b)(2)(E-13), 203(c)(2)(G-13), or |
203(d)(2)(D-8), but not to exceed the amount of such |
addition modification , and (iii) any insurance premium |
income (net of deductions allocable thereto) taken |
into account for the taxable year with respect to a |
transaction with a taxpayer that is required to make an |
addition modification with respect to such transaction |
under Section 203(a)(2)(D-19), Section |
203(b)(2)(E-14), Section 203(c)(2)(G-14), or Section |
203(d)(2)(D-9), but not to exceed the amount of that |
addition modification. This subparagraph (V) is exempt |
from the provisions of Section 250 ;
|
(W) An amount equal to the interest income taken |
into account for the taxable year (net of the |
deductions allocable thereto) with respect to |
|
transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a |
member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for |
the fact that the foreign person's business activity |
outside the United States is 80% or more of that |
person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person |
who would be a member of the same unitary business |
group but for the fact that the person is prohibited |
under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the |
unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily |
required to apportion business income under different |
subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the |
addition modification required to be made for the same |
taxable year under Section 203(b)(2)(E-12) for |
interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, to the same person . This subparagraph (W) |
is exempt from the provisions of Section 250 ; and
|
(X) An amount equal to the income from intangible |
property taken into account for the taxable year (net |
of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to |
transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a |
member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for |
the fact that the foreign person's business activity |
outside the United States is 80% or more of that |
person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person |
|
who would be a member of the same unitary business |
group but for the fact that the person is prohibited |
under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the |
unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily |
required to apportion business income under different |
subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the |
addition modification required to be made for the same |
taxable year under Section 203(b)(2)(E-13) for |
intangible expenses and costs paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to the same foreign |
person . This subparagraph (X) is exempt from the |
provisions of Section 250. ; and
|
(FF) An amount equal to the income from insurance |
premiums taken into account for the taxable year (net |
of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to |
transactions with a person who would be a member of the |
same unitary business group but for the fact that the |
person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from |
being included in the unitary business group because he |
or she is ordinarily required to apportion business |
income under different subsections of Section 304, but |
not to exceed the addition modification required to be |
made for the same taxable year under Section |
203(a)(2)(D-18) for intangible expenses and costs |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to |
the same person.
|
|
(3) Special rule. For purposes of paragraph (2) (A), |
"gross income"
in the case of a life insurance company, for |
tax years ending on and after
December 31, 1994,
shall mean |
the gross investment income for the taxable year.
|
(c) Trusts and estates.
|
(1) In general. In the case of a trust or estate, base |
income means
an amount equal to the taxpayer's taxable |
income for the taxable year as
modified by paragraph (2).
|
(2) Modifications. Subject to the provisions of |
paragraph (3), the
taxable income referred to in paragraph |
(1) shall be modified by adding
thereto the sum of the |
following amounts:
|
(A) An amount equal to all amounts paid or accrued |
to the taxpayer
as interest or dividends during the |
taxable year to the extent excluded
from gross income |
in the computation of taxable income;
|
(B) In the case of (i) an estate, $600; (ii) a |
trust which, under
its governing instrument, is |
required to distribute all of its income
currently, |
$300; and (iii) any other trust, $100, but in each such |
case,
only to the extent such amount was deducted in |
the computation of
taxable income;
|
(C) An amount equal to the amount of tax imposed by |
this Act to the
extent deducted from gross income in |
the computation of taxable income
for the taxable year;
|
|
(D) The amount of any net operating loss deduction |
taken in arriving at
taxable income, other than a net |
operating loss carried forward from a
taxable year |
ending prior to December 31, 1986;
|
(E) For taxable years in which a net operating loss |
carryback or
carryforward from a taxable year ending |
prior to December 31, 1986 is an
element of taxable |
income under paragraph (1) of subsection (e) or |
subparagraph
(E) of paragraph (2) of subsection (e), |
the amount by which addition
modifications other than |
those provided by this subparagraph (E) exceeded
|
subtraction modifications in such taxable year, with |
the following limitations
applied in the order that |
they are listed:
|
(i) the addition modification relating to the |
net operating loss
carried back or forward to the |
taxable year from any taxable year ending
prior to |
December 31, 1986 shall be reduced by the amount of |
addition
modification under this subparagraph (E) |
which related to that net
operating loss and which |
was taken into account in calculating the base
|
income of an earlier taxable year, and
|
(ii) the addition modification relating to the |
net operating loss
carried back or forward to the |
taxable year from any taxable year ending
prior to |
December 31, 1986 shall not exceed the amount of |
|
such carryback or
carryforward;
|
For taxable years in which there is a net operating |
loss carryback or
carryforward from more than one other |
taxable year ending prior to December
31, 1986, the |
addition modification provided in this subparagraph |
(E) shall
be the sum of the amounts computed |
independently under the preceding
provisions of this |
subparagraph (E) for each such taxable year;
|
(F) For taxable years ending on or after January 1, |
1989, an amount
equal to the tax deducted pursuant to |
Section 164 of the Internal Revenue
Code if the trust |
or estate is claiming the same tax for purposes of the
|
Illinois foreign tax credit under Section 601 of this |
Act;
|
(G) An amount equal to the amount of the capital |
gain deduction
allowable under the Internal Revenue |
Code, to the extent deducted from
gross income in the |
computation of taxable income;
|
(G-5) For taxable years ending after December 31, |
1997, an
amount equal to any eligible remediation costs |
that the trust or estate
deducted in computing adjusted |
gross income and for which the trust
or estate claims a |
credit under subsection (l) of Section 201;
|
(G-10) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, an |
amount equal to the
bonus depreciation deduction taken |
on the taxpayer's federal income tax return for the |
|
taxable
year under subsection (k) of Section 168 of the |
Internal Revenue Code; and
|
(G-11) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons, |
or otherwise disposes of property for which the |
taxpayer was required in any taxable year to
make an |
addition modification under subparagraph (G-10), then |
an amount equal
to the aggregate amount of the |
deductions taken in all taxable
years under |
subparagraph (R) with respect to that property.
|
If the taxpayer continues to own property through |
the last day of the last tax year for which the |
taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for |
federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer |
was allowed in any taxable year to make a subtraction |
modification under subparagraph (R), then an amount |
equal to that subtraction modification.
|
The taxpayer is required to make the addition |
modification under this
subparagraph
only once with |
respect to any one piece of property;
|
(G-12) An amount equal to the amount otherwise |
allowed as a deduction in computing base income for |
interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, (i) for taxable years ending on or after |
December 31, 2004, to a foreign person who would be a |
member of the same unitary business group but for the |
fact that the foreign person's business activity |
|
outside the United States is 80% or more of the foreign |
person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person |
who would be a member of the same unitary business |
group but for the fact that the person is prohibited |
under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the |
unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily |
required to apportion business income under different |
subsections of Section 304. The addition modification |
required by this subparagraph shall be reduced to the |
extent that dividends were included in base income of |
the unitary group for the same taxable year and |
received by the taxpayer or by a member of the |
taxpayer's unitary business group (including amounts |
included in gross income pursuant to Sections 951 |
through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code and amounts |
included in gross income under Section 78 of the |
Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock of the |
same person to whom the interest was paid, accrued, or |
incurred.
|
This paragraph shall not apply to the following:
|
(i) an item of interest paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign |
person who is subject in a foreign country or |
state, other than a state which requires mandatory |
unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net |
|
income with respect to such interest; or |
(ii) an item of interest paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign |
person if the taxpayer can establish, based on a |
preponderance of the evidence, both of the |
following: |
(a) the foreign person, during the same |
taxable year, paid, accrued, or incurred, the |
interest to a person that is not a related |
member, and |
(b) the transaction giving rise to the |
interest expense between the taxpayer and the |
foreign person did not have as a principal |
purpose the avoidance of Illinois income tax, |
and is paid pursuant to a contract or agreement |
that reflects an arm's-length interest rate |
and terms; or
|
(iii) the taxpayer can establish, based on |
clear and convincing evidence, that the interest |
paid, accrued, or incurred relates to a contract or |
agreement entered into at arm's-length rates and |
terms and the principal purpose for the payment is |
not federal or Illinois tax avoidance; or
|
(iv) an item of interest paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign |
person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and |
|
convincing evidence that the adjustments are |
unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director |
agree in writing to the application or use of an |
alternative method of apportionment under Section |
304(f).
|
Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the |
Director from making any other adjustment |
otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for |
any tax year beginning after the effective date of |
this amendment provided such adjustment is made |
pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department |
and such regulations provide methods and standards |
by which the Department will utilize its authority |
under Section 404 of this Act;
|
(G-13) An amount equal to the amount of intangible |
expenses and costs otherwise allowed as a deduction in |
computing base income, and that were paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, (i) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2004, to a |
foreign person who would be a member of the same |
unitary business group but for the fact that the |
foreign person's business activity outside the United |
States is 80% or more of that person's total business |
activity and (ii) for taxable years ending on or after |
December 31, 2008, to a person who would be a member of |
the same unitary business group but for the fact that |
|
the person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) |
from being included in the unitary business group |
because he or she is ordinarily required to apportion |
business income under different subsections of Section |
304. The addition modification required by this |
subparagraph shall be reduced to the extent that |
dividends were included in base income of the unitary |
group for the same taxable year and received by the |
taxpayer or by a member of the taxpayer's unitary |
business group (including amounts included in gross |
income pursuant to Sections 951 through 964 of the |
Internal Revenue Code and amounts included in gross |
income under Section 78 of the Internal Revenue Code) |
with respect to the stock of the same person to whom |
the intangible expenses and costs were directly or |
indirectly paid, incurred, or accrued. The preceding |
sentence shall not apply to the extent that the same |
dividends caused a reduction to the addition |
modification required under Section 203(c)(2)(G-12) of |
this Act. As used in this subparagraph, the term |
"intangible expenses and costs" includes: (1) |
expenses, losses, and costs for or related to the |
direct or indirect acquisition, use, maintenance or |
management, ownership, sale, exchange, or any other |
disposition of intangible property; (2) losses |
incurred, directly or indirectly, from factoring |
|
transactions or discounting transactions; (3) royalty, |
patent, technical, and copyright fees; (4) licensing |
fees; and (5) other similar expenses and costs. For |
purposes of this subparagraph, "intangible property" |
includes patents, patent applications, trade names, |
trademarks, service marks, copyrights, mask works, |
trade secrets, and similar types of intangible assets. |
This paragraph shall not apply to the following: |
(i) any item of intangible expenses or costs |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign |
person who is subject in a foreign country or |
state, other than a state which requires mandatory |
unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net |
income with respect to such item; or |
(ii) any item of intangible expense or cost |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, if the taxpayer can establish, based |
on a preponderance of the evidence, both of the |
following: |
(a) the foreign person during the same |
taxable year paid, accrued, or incurred, the |
intangible expense or cost to a person that is |
not a related member, and |
(b) the transaction giving rise to the |
intangible expense or cost between the |
|
taxpayer and the foreign person did not have as |
a principal purpose the avoidance of Illinois |
income tax, and is paid pursuant to a contract |
or agreement that reflects arm's-length terms; |
or |
(iii) any item of intangible expense or cost |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign |
person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and |
convincing evidence, that the adjustments are |
unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director |
agree in writing to the application or use of an |
alternative method of apportionment under Section |
304(f);
|
Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the |
Director from making any other adjustment |
otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for |
any tax year beginning after the effective date of |
this amendment provided such adjustment is made |
pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department |
and such regulations provide methods and standards |
by which the Department will utilize its authority |
under Section 404 of this Act;
|
(G-14) For taxable years ending on or after |
December 31, 2008, an amount equal to the amount of |
insurance premium expenses and costs otherwise allowed |
|
as a deduction in computing base income, and that were |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to |
a person who would be a member of the same unitary |
business group but for the fact that the person is |
prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from being |
included in the unitary business group because he or |
she is ordinarily required to apportion business |
income under different subsections of Section 304. The |
addition modification required by this subparagraph |
shall be reduced to the extent that dividends were |
included in base income of the unitary group for the |
same taxable year and received by the taxpayer or by a |
member of the taxpayer's unitary business group |
(including amounts included in gross income under |
Sections 951 through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code |
and amounts included in gross income under Section 78 |
of the Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock |
of the same person to whom the premiums intangible |
expenses and costs were directly or indirectly paid, |
incurred, or accrued. The preceding sentence does not |
apply to the extent that the same dividends caused a |
reduction to the addition modification required under |
Section 203(c)(2)(G-12) or Section 203(c)(2)(G-13) |
203(a)(2)(D-17) of this Act.
|
and by deducting from the total so obtained the sum of the |
following
amounts:
|
|
(H) An amount equal to all amounts included in such |
total pursuant
to the provisions of Sections 402(a), |
402(c), 403(a), 403(b), 406(a), 407(a)
and 408 of the |
Internal Revenue Code or included in such total as
|
distributions under the provisions of any retirement |
or disability plan for
employees of any governmental |
agency or unit, or retirement payments to
retired |
partners, which payments are excluded in computing net |
earnings
from self employment by Section 1402 of the |
Internal Revenue Code and
regulations adopted pursuant |
thereto;
|
(I) The valuation limitation amount;
|
(J) An amount equal to the amount of any tax |
imposed by this Act
which was refunded to the taxpayer |
and included in such total for the
taxable year;
|
(K) An amount equal to all amounts included in |
taxable income as
modified by subparagraphs (A), (B), |
(C), (D), (E), (F) and (G) which
are exempt from |
taxation by this State either by reason of its statutes |
or
Constitution
or by reason of the Constitution, |
treaties or statutes of the United States;
provided |
that, in the case of any statute of this State or, for |
taxable years ending on or after December 31, 2008, of |
the United States, any treaty of the United States, the |
Illinois Constitution, or the United States |
Constitution that exempts income
derived from bonds or |
|
other obligations from the tax imposed under this Act,
|
the amount exempted shall be the interest income net of |
bond premium amortization , and, for taxable years |
ending on or after December 31, 2008, interest expense |
incurred on indebtedness to carry the bond or other |
obligation, expenses incurred in producing the income |
to be deducted, and all other related expenses. The |
amount of expenses to be taken into account under this |
provision may not exceed the amount of income that is |
exempted ;
|
(L) With the exception of any amounts subtracted |
under subparagraph
(K),
an amount equal to the sum of |
all amounts disallowed as
deductions by (i) Sections |
171(a) (2) and 265(a)(2) of the Internal Revenue
Code, |
as now or hereafter amended, and all amounts of |
expenses allocable
to interest and disallowed as |
deductions by Section 265(1) of the Internal
Revenue |
Code of 1954, as now or hereafter amended;
and (ii) for |
taxable years
ending on or after August 13, 1999, |
Sections
171(a)(2), 265,
280C, and 832(b)(5)(B)(i) of |
the Internal Revenue Code; the provisions of this
|
subparagraph are exempt from the provisions of Section |
250;
|
(M) An amount equal to those dividends included in |
such total
which were paid by a corporation which |
conducts business operations in an
Enterprise Zone or |
|
zones created under the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act or |
a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or zones created under |
the River Edge Redevelopment Zone Act and
conducts |
substantially all of its operations in an Enterprise |
Zone or Zones or a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or |
zones. This subparagraph (M) is exempt from the |
provisions of Section 250;
|
(N) An amount equal to any contribution made to a |
job training
project established pursuant to the Tax |
Increment Allocation
Redevelopment Act;
|
(O) An amount equal to those dividends included in |
such total
that were paid by a corporation that |
conducts business operations in a
federally designated |
Foreign Trade Zone or Sub-Zone and that is designated
a |
High Impact Business located in Illinois; provided |
that dividends eligible
for the deduction provided in |
subparagraph (M) of paragraph (2) of this
subsection |
shall not be eligible for the deduction provided under |
this
subparagraph (O);
|
(P) An amount equal to the amount of the deduction |
used to compute the
federal income tax credit for |
restoration of substantial amounts held under
claim of |
right for the taxable year pursuant to Section 1341 of |
the
Internal Revenue Code of 1986;
|
(Q) For taxable year 1999 and thereafter, an amount |
equal to the
amount of any
(i) distributions, to the |
|
extent includible in gross income for
federal income |
tax purposes, made to the taxpayer because of
his or |
her status as a victim of
persecution for racial or |
religious reasons by Nazi Germany or any other Axis
|
regime or as an heir of the victim and (ii) items
of |
income, to the extent
includible in gross income for |
federal income tax purposes, attributable to,
derived |
from or in any way related to assets stolen from, |
hidden from, or
otherwise lost to a victim of
|
persecution for racial or religious reasons by Nazi
|
Germany or any other Axis regime
immediately prior to, |
during, and immediately after World War II, including,
|
but
not limited to, interest on the proceeds receivable |
as insurance
under policies issued to a victim of |
persecution for racial or religious
reasons by Nazi |
Germany or any other Axis regime by European insurance
|
companies
immediately prior to and during World War II;
|
provided, however, this subtraction from federal |
adjusted gross income does not
apply to assets acquired |
with such assets or with the proceeds from the sale of
|
such assets; provided, further, this paragraph shall |
only apply to a taxpayer
who was the first recipient of |
such assets after their recovery and who is a
victim of
|
persecution for racial or religious reasons
by Nazi |
Germany or any other Axis regime or as an heir of the |
victim. The
amount of and the eligibility for any |
|
public assistance, benefit, or
similar entitlement is |
not affected by the inclusion of items (i) and (ii) of
|
this paragraph in gross income for federal income tax |
purposes.
This paragraph is exempt from the provisions |
of Section 250;
|
(R) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, for the |
taxable year in
which the bonus depreciation deduction
|
is taken on the taxpayer's federal income tax return |
under
subsection (k) of Section 168 of the Internal |
Revenue Code and for each
applicable taxable year |
thereafter, an amount equal to "x", where:
|
(1) "y" equals the amount of the depreciation |
deduction taken for the
taxable year
on the |
taxpayer's federal income tax return on property |
for which the bonus
depreciation deduction
was |
taken in any year under subsection (k) of Section |
168 of the Internal
Revenue Code, but not including |
the bonus depreciation deduction;
|
(2) for taxable years ending on or before |
December 31, 2005, "x" equals "y" multiplied by 30 |
and then divided by 70 (or "y"
multiplied by |
0.429); and |
(3) for taxable years ending after December |
31, 2005: |
(i) for property on which a bonus |
depreciation deduction of 30% of the adjusted |
|
basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by |
30 and then divided by 70 (or "y"
multiplied by |
0.429); and |
(ii) for property on which a bonus |
depreciation deduction of 50% of the adjusted |
basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by |
1.0.
|
The aggregate amount deducted under this |
subparagraph in all taxable
years for any one piece of |
property may not exceed the amount of the bonus
|
depreciation deduction
taken on that property on the |
taxpayer's federal income tax return under
subsection |
(k) of Section 168 of the Internal Revenue Code. This |
subparagraph (R) is exempt from the provisions of |
Section 250;
|
(S) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons, or |
otherwise disposes of
property for which the taxpayer |
was required in any taxable year to make an
addition |
modification under subparagraph (G-10), then an amount |
equal to that
addition modification.
|
If the taxpayer continues to own property through |
the last day of the last tax year for which the |
taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for |
federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer |
was required in any taxable year to make an addition |
modification under subparagraph (G-10), then an amount |
|
equal to that addition modification.
|
The taxpayer is allowed to take the deduction under |
this subparagraph
only once with respect to any one |
piece of property. |
This subparagraph (S) is exempt from the |
provisions of Section 250;
|
(T) The amount of (i) any interest income (net of |
the deductions allocable thereto) taken into account |
for the taxable year with respect to a transaction with |
a taxpayer that is required to make an addition |
modification with respect to such transaction under |
Section 203(a)(2)(D-17), 203(b)(2)(E-12), |
203(c)(2)(G-12), or 203(d)(2)(D-7), but not to exceed |
the amount of such addition modification and
(ii) any |
income from intangible property (net of the deductions |
allocable thereto) taken into account for the taxable |
year with respect to a transaction with a taxpayer that |
is required to make an addition modification with |
respect to such transaction under Section |
203(a)(2)(D-18), 203(b)(2)(E-13), 203(c)(2)(G-13), or |
203(d)(2)(D-8), but not to exceed the amount of such |
addition modification . This subparagraph (T) is exempt |
from the provisions of Section 250 ;
|
(U) An amount equal to the interest income taken |
into account for the taxable year (net of the |
deductions allocable thereto) with respect to |
|
transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a |
member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for |
the fact the foreign person's business activity |
outside the United States is 80% or more of that |
person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person |
who would be a member of the same unitary business |
group but for the fact that the person is prohibited |
under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the |
unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily |
required to apportion business income under different |
subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the |
addition modification required to be made for the same |
taxable year under Section 203(c)(2)(G-12) for |
interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, to the same person . This subparagraph (U) |
is exempt from the provisions of Section 250 ; and |
(V) An amount equal to the income from intangible |
property taken into account for the taxable year (net |
of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to |
transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a |
member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for |
the fact that the foreign person's business activity |
outside the United States is 80% or more of that |
person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person |
|
who would be a member of the same unitary business |
group but for the fact that the person is prohibited |
under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the |
unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily |
required to apportion business income under different |
subsections of Section 304 , but not to exceed the |
addition modification required to be made for the same |
taxable year under Section 203(c)(2)(G-13) for |
intangible expenses and costs paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to the same foreign |
person . This subparagraph (V) is exempt from the |
provisions of Section 250. ; and
|
(FF) An amount equal to the income from insurance |
premiums taken into account for the taxable year (net |
of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to |
transactions with a person who would be a member of the |
same unitary business group but for the fact that the |
person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from |
being included in the unitary business group because he |
or she is ordinarily required to apportion business |
income under different subsections of Section 304, but |
not to exceed the addition modification required to be |
made for the same taxable year under Section |
203(a)(2)(D-18) for intangible expenses and costs |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to |
the same person.
|
|
(3) Limitation. The amount of any modification |
otherwise required
under this subsection shall, under |
regulations prescribed by the
Department, be adjusted by |
any amounts included therein which were
properly paid, |
credited, or required to be distributed, or permanently set
|
aside for charitable purposes pursuant to Internal Revenue |
Code Section
642(c) during the taxable year.
|
(d) Partnerships.
|
(1) In general. In the case of a partnership, base |
income means an
amount equal to the taxpayer's taxable |
income for the taxable year as
modified by paragraph (2).
|
(2) Modifications. The taxable income referred to in |
paragraph (1)
shall be modified by adding thereto the sum |
of the following amounts:
|
(A) An amount equal to all amounts paid or accrued |
to the taxpayer as
interest or dividends during the |
taxable year to the extent excluded from
gross income |
in the computation of taxable income;
|
(B) An amount equal to the amount of tax imposed by |
this Act to the
extent deducted from gross income for |
the taxable year;
|
(C) The amount of deductions allowed to the |
partnership pursuant to
Section 707 (c) of the Internal |
Revenue Code in calculating its taxable income;
|
(D) An amount equal to the amount of the capital |
|
gain deduction
allowable under the Internal Revenue |
Code, to the extent deducted from
gross income in the |
computation of taxable income;
|
(D-5) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, an |
amount equal to the
bonus depreciation deduction taken |
on the taxpayer's federal income tax return for the |
taxable
year under subsection (k) of Section 168 of the |
Internal Revenue Code;
|
(D-6) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons, |
or otherwise disposes of
property for which the |
taxpayer was required in any taxable year to make an
|
addition modification under subparagraph (D-5), then |
an amount equal to the
aggregate amount of the |
deductions taken in all taxable years
under |
subparagraph (O) with respect to that property.
|
If the taxpayer continues to own property through |
the last day of the last tax year for which the |
taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for |
federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer |
was allowed in any taxable year to make a subtraction |
modification under subparagraph (O), then an amount |
equal to that subtraction modification.
|
The taxpayer is required to make the addition |
modification under this
subparagraph
only once with |
respect to any one piece of property;
|
(D-7) An amount equal to the amount otherwise |
|
allowed as a deduction in computing base income for |
interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, (i) for taxable years ending on or after |
December 31, 2004, to a foreign person who would be a |
member of the same unitary business group but for the |
fact the foreign person's business activity outside |
the United States is 80% or more of the foreign |
person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person |
who would be a member of the same unitary business |
group but for the fact that the person is prohibited |
under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the |
unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily |
required to apportion business income under different |
subsections of Section 304. The addition modification |
required by this subparagraph shall be reduced to the |
extent that dividends were included in base income of |
the unitary group for the same taxable year and |
received by the taxpayer or by a member of the |
taxpayer's unitary business group (including amounts |
included in gross income pursuant to Sections 951 |
through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code and amounts |
included in gross income under Section 78 of the |
Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock of the |
same person to whom the interest was paid, accrued, or |
incurred.
|
|
This paragraph shall not apply to the following:
|
(i) an item of interest paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign |
person who is subject in a foreign country or |
state, other than a state which requires mandatory |
unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net |
income with respect to such interest; or |
(ii) an item of interest paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign |
person if the taxpayer can establish, based on a |
preponderance of the evidence, both of the |
following: |
(a) the foreign person, during the same |
taxable year, paid, accrued, or incurred, the |
interest to a person that is not a related |
member, and |
(b) the transaction giving rise to the |
interest expense between the taxpayer and the |
foreign person did not have as a principal |
purpose the avoidance of Illinois income tax, |
and is paid pursuant to a contract or agreement |
that reflects an arm's-length interest rate |
and terms; or
|
(iii) the taxpayer can establish, based on |
clear and convincing evidence, that the interest |
paid, accrued, or incurred relates to a contract or |
|
agreement entered into at arm's-length rates and |
terms and the principal purpose for the payment is |
not federal or Illinois tax avoidance; or
|
(iv) an item of interest paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign |
person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and |
convincing evidence that the adjustments are |
unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director |
agree in writing to the application or use of an |
alternative method of apportionment under Section |
304(f).
|
Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the |
Director from making any other adjustment |
otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for |
any tax year beginning after the effective date of |
this amendment provided such adjustment is made |
pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department |
and such regulations provide methods and standards |
by which the Department will utilize its authority |
under Section 404 of this Act; and
|
(D-8) An amount equal to the amount of intangible |
expenses and costs otherwise allowed as a deduction in |
computing base income, and that were paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, (i) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2004, to a |
foreign person who would be a member of the same |
|
unitary business group but for the fact that the |
foreign person's business activity outside the United |
States is 80% or more of that person's total business |
activity and (ii) for taxable years ending on or after |
December 31, 2008, to a person who would be a member of |
the same unitary business group but for the fact that |
the person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) |
from being included in the unitary business group |
because he or she is ordinarily required to apportion |
business income under different subsections of Section |
304. The addition modification required by this |
subparagraph shall be reduced to the extent that |
dividends were included in base income of the unitary |
group for the same taxable year and received by the |
taxpayer or by a member of the taxpayer's unitary |
business group (including amounts included in gross |
income pursuant to Sections 951 through 964 of the |
Internal Revenue Code and amounts included in gross |
income under Section 78 of the Internal Revenue Code) |
with respect to the stock of the same person to whom |
the intangible expenses and costs were directly or |
indirectly paid, incurred or accrued. The preceding |
sentence shall not apply to the extent that the same |
dividends caused a reduction to the addition |
modification required under Section 203(d)(2)(D-7) of |
this Act. As used in this subparagraph, the term |
|
"intangible expenses and costs" includes (1) expenses, |
losses, and costs for, or related to, the direct or |
indirect acquisition, use, maintenance or management, |
ownership, sale, exchange, or any other disposition of |
intangible property; (2) losses incurred, directly or |
indirectly, from factoring transactions or discounting |
transactions; (3) royalty, patent, technical, and |
copyright fees; (4) licensing fees; and (5) other |
similar expenses and costs. For purposes of this |
subparagraph, "intangible property" includes patents, |
patent applications, trade names, trademarks, service |
marks, copyrights, mask works, trade secrets, and |
similar types of intangible assets; |
This paragraph shall not apply to the following: |
(i) any item of intangible expenses or costs |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign |
person who is subject in a foreign country or |
state, other than a state which requires mandatory |
unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net |
income with respect to such item; or |
(ii) any item of intangible expense or cost |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, if the taxpayer can establish, based |
on a preponderance of the evidence, both of the |
following: |
|
(a) the foreign person during the same |
taxable year paid, accrued, or incurred, the |
intangible expense or cost to a person that is |
not a related member, and |
(b) the transaction giving rise to the |
intangible expense or cost between the |
taxpayer and the foreign person did not have as |
a principal purpose the avoidance of Illinois |
income tax, and is paid pursuant to a contract |
or agreement that reflects arm's-length terms; |
or |
(iii) any item of intangible expense or cost |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or |
indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign |
person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and |
convincing evidence, that the adjustments are |
unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director |
agree in writing to the application or use of an |
alternative method of apportionment under Section |
304(f);
|
Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the |
Director from making any other adjustment |
otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for |
any tax year beginning after the effective date of |
this amendment provided such adjustment is made |
pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department |
|
and such regulations provide methods and standards |
by which the Department will utilize its authority |
under Section 404 of this Act;
|
(D-9) For taxable years ending on or after December |
31, 2008, an amount equal to the amount of insurance |
premium expenses and costs otherwise allowed as a |
deduction in computing base income, and that were paid, |
accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to a |
person who would be a member of the same unitary |
business group but for the fact that the person is |
prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from being |
included in the unitary business group because he or |
she is ordinarily required to apportion business |
income under different subsections of Section 304. The |
addition modification required by this subparagraph |
shall be reduced to the extent that dividends were |
included in base income of the unitary group for the |
same taxable year and received by the taxpayer or by a |
member of the taxpayer's unitary business group |
(including amounts included in gross income under |
Sections 951 through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code |
and amounts included in gross income under Section 78 |
of the Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock |
of the same person to whom the premiums intangible |
expenses and costs were directly or indirectly paid, |
incurred, or accrued. The preceding sentence does not |
|
apply to the extent that the same dividends caused a |
reduction to the addition modification required under |
Section 203(d)(2)(D-7) or Section 203(d)(2)(D-8) |
203(a)(2)(D-17) of this Act.
|
and by deducting from the total so obtained the following |
amounts:
|
(E) The valuation limitation amount;
|
(F) An amount equal to the amount of any tax |
imposed by this Act which
was refunded to the taxpayer |
and included in such total for the taxable year;
|
(G) An amount equal to all amounts included in |
taxable income as
modified by subparagraphs (A), (B), |
(C) and (D) which are exempt from
taxation by this |
State either by reason of its statutes or Constitution |
or
by reason of
the Constitution, treaties or statutes |
of the United States;
provided that, in the case of any |
statute of this State or, for taxable years ending on |
or after December 31, 2008, of the United States, any |
treaty of the United States, the Illinois |
Constitution, or the United States Constitution that |
exempts income
derived from bonds or other obligations |
from the tax imposed under this Act,
the amount |
exempted shall be the interest income net of bond |
premium amortization , and, for taxable years ending on |
or after December 31, 2008, interest expense incurred |
on indebtedness to carry the bond or other obligation, |
|
expenses incurred in producing the income to be |
deducted, and all other related expenses. The amount of |
expenses to be taken into account under this provision |
may not exceed the amount of income that is exempted ;
|
(H) Any income of the partnership which |
constitutes personal service
income as defined in |
Section 1348 (b) (1) of the Internal Revenue Code (as
|
in effect December 31, 1981) or a reasonable allowance |
for compensation
paid or accrued for services rendered |
by partners to the partnership,
whichever is greater;
|
(I) An amount equal to all amounts of income |
distributable to an entity
subject to the Personal |
Property Tax Replacement Income Tax imposed by
|
subsections (c) and (d) of Section 201 of this Act |
including amounts
distributable to organizations |
exempt from federal income tax by reason of
Section |
501(a) of the Internal Revenue Code;
|
(J) With the exception of any amounts subtracted |
under subparagraph
(G),
an amount equal to the sum of |
all amounts disallowed as deductions
by (i) Sections |
171(a) (2), and 265(2) of the Internal Revenue Code of |
1954,
as now or hereafter amended, and all amounts of |
expenses allocable to
interest and disallowed as |
deductions by Section 265(1) of the Internal
Revenue |
Code, as now or hereafter amended;
and (ii) for taxable |
years
ending on or after August 13, 1999, Sections
|
|
171(a)(2), 265,
280C, and 832(b)(5)(B)(i) of the |
Internal Revenue Code; the provisions of this
|
subparagraph are exempt from the provisions of Section |
250;
|
(K) An amount equal to those dividends included in |
such total which were
paid by a corporation which |
conducts business operations in an Enterprise
Zone or |
zones created under the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act, |
enacted by
the 82nd General Assembly, or a River Edge |
Redevelopment Zone or zones created under the River |
Edge Redevelopment Zone Act and
conducts substantially |
all of its operations
in an Enterprise Zone or Zones or |
from a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or zones. This |
subparagraph (K) is exempt from the provisions of |
Section 250;
|
(L) An amount equal to any contribution made to a |
job training project
established pursuant to the Real |
Property Tax Increment Allocation
Redevelopment Act;
|
(M) An amount equal to those dividends included in |
such total
that were paid by a corporation that |
conducts business operations in a
federally designated |
Foreign Trade Zone or Sub-Zone and that is designated a
|
High Impact Business located in Illinois; provided |
that dividends eligible
for the deduction provided in |
subparagraph (K) of paragraph (2) of this
subsection |
shall not be eligible for the deduction provided under |
|
this
subparagraph (M);
|
(N) An amount equal to the amount of the deduction |
used to compute the
federal income tax credit for |
restoration of substantial amounts held under
claim of |
right for the taxable year pursuant to Section 1341 of |
the
Internal Revenue Code of 1986;
|
(O) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, for the |
taxable year in
which the bonus depreciation deduction
|
is taken on the taxpayer's federal income tax return |
under
subsection (k) of Section 168 of the Internal |
Revenue Code and for each
applicable taxable year |
thereafter, an amount equal to "x", where:
|
(1) "y" equals the amount of the depreciation |
deduction taken for the
taxable year
on the |
taxpayer's federal income tax return on property |
for which the bonus
depreciation deduction
was |
taken in any year under subsection (k) of Section |
168 of the Internal
Revenue Code, but not including |
the bonus depreciation deduction;
|
(2) for taxable years ending on or before |
December 31, 2005, "x" equals "y" multiplied by 30 |
and then divided by 70 (or "y"
multiplied by |
0.429); and |
(3) for taxable years ending after December |
31, 2005: |
(i) for property on which a bonus |
|
depreciation deduction of 30% of the adjusted |
basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by |
30 and then divided by 70 (or "y"
multiplied by |
0.429); and |
(ii) for property on which a bonus |
depreciation deduction of 50% of the adjusted |
basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by |
1.0.
|
The aggregate amount deducted under this |
subparagraph in all taxable
years for any one piece of |
property may not exceed the amount of the bonus
|
depreciation deduction
taken on that property on the |
taxpayer's federal income tax return under
subsection |
(k) of Section 168 of the Internal Revenue Code. This |
subparagraph (O) is exempt from the provisions of |
Section 250;
|
(P) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons, or |
otherwise disposes of
property for which the taxpayer |
was required in any taxable year to make an
addition |
modification under subparagraph (D-5), then an amount |
equal to that
addition modification.
|
If the taxpayer continues to own property through |
the last day of the last tax year for which the |
taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for |
federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer |
was required in any taxable year to make an addition |
|
modification under subparagraph (D-5), then an amount |
equal to that addition modification.
|
The taxpayer is allowed to take the deduction under |
this subparagraph
only once with respect to any one |
piece of property. |
This subparagraph (P) is exempt from the |
provisions of Section 250;
|
(Q) The amount of (i) any interest income (net of |
the deductions allocable thereto) taken into account |
for the taxable year with respect to a transaction with |
a taxpayer that is required to make an addition |
modification with respect to such transaction under |
Section 203(a)(2)(D-17), 203(b)(2)(E-12), |
203(c)(2)(G-12), or 203(d)(2)(D-7), but not to exceed |
the amount of such addition modification and
(ii) any |
income from intangible property (net of the deductions |
allocable thereto) taken into account for the taxable |
year with respect to a transaction with a taxpayer that |
is required to make an addition modification with |
respect to such transaction under Section |
203(a)(2)(D-18), 203(b)(2)(E-13), 203(c)(2)(G-13), or |
203(d)(2)(D-8), but not to exceed the amount of such |
addition modification . This subparagraph (Q) is exempt |
from Section 250 ;
|
(R) An amount equal to the interest income taken |
into account for the taxable year (net of the |
|
deductions allocable thereto) with respect to |
transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a |
member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for |
the fact that the foreign person's business activity |
outside the United States is 80% or more of that |
person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable |
years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person |
who would be a member of the same unitary business |
group but for the fact that the person is prohibited |
under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the |
unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily |
required to apportion business income under different |
subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the |
addition modification required to be made for the same |
taxable year under Section 203(d)(2)(D-7) for interest |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to |
the same person . This subparagraph (R) is exempt from |
Section 250 ; and |
(S) An amount equal to the income from intangible |
property taken into account for the taxable year (net |
of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to |
transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a |
member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for |
the fact that the foreign person's business activity |
outside the United States is 80% or more of that |
person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable |
|
years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person |
who would be a member of the same unitary business |
group but for the fact that the person is prohibited |
under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the |
unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily |
required to apportion business income under different |
subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the |
addition modification required to be made for the same |
taxable year under Section 203(d)(2)(D-8) for |
intangible expenses and costs paid, accrued, or |
incurred, directly or indirectly, to the same foreign |
person . This subparagraph (S) is exempt from Section |
250. ; and
|
(FF) An amount equal to the income from insurance |
premiums taken into account for the taxable year (net |
of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to |
transactions with a person who would be a member of the |
same unitary business group but for the fact that the |
person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from |
being included in the unitary business group because he |
or she is ordinarily required to apportion business |
income under different subsections of Section 304, but |
not to exceed the addition modification required to be |
made for the same taxable year under Section |
203(a)(2)(D-18) for intangible expenses and costs |
paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to |
|
the same person.
|
(e) Gross income; adjusted gross income; taxable income.
|
(1) In general. Subject to the provisions of paragraph |
(2) and
subsection (b) (3), for purposes of this Section |
and Section 803(e), a
taxpayer's gross income, adjusted |
gross income, or taxable income for
the taxable year shall |
mean the amount of gross income, adjusted gross
income or |
taxable income properly reportable for federal income tax
|
purposes for the taxable year under the provisions of the |
Internal
Revenue Code. Taxable income may be less than |
zero. However, for taxable
years ending on or after |
December 31, 1986, net operating loss
carryforwards from |
taxable years ending prior to December 31, 1986, may not
|
exceed the sum of federal taxable income for the taxable |
year before net
operating loss deduction, plus the excess |
of addition modifications over
subtraction modifications |
for the taxable year. For taxable years ending
prior to |
December 31, 1986, taxable income may never be an amount in |
excess
of the net operating loss for the taxable year as |
defined in subsections
(c) and (d) of Section 172 of the |
Internal Revenue Code, provided that when
taxable income of |
a corporation (other than a Subchapter S corporation),
|
trust, or estate is less than zero and addition |
modifications, other than
those provided by subparagraph |
(E) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b) for
corporations or |
|
subparagraph (E) of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) for
|
trusts and estates, exceed subtraction modifications, an |
addition
modification must be made under those |
subparagraphs for any other taxable
year to which the |
taxable income less than zero (net operating loss) is
|
applied under Section 172 of the Internal Revenue Code or |
under
subparagraph (E) of paragraph (2) of this subsection |
(e) applied in
conjunction with Section 172 of the Internal |
Revenue Code.
|
(2) Special rule. For purposes of paragraph (1) of this |
subsection,
the taxable income properly reportable for |
federal income tax purposes
shall mean:
|
(A) Certain life insurance companies. In the case |
of a life
insurance company subject to the tax imposed |
by Section 801 of the
Internal Revenue Code, life |
insurance company taxable income, plus the
amount of |
distribution from pre-1984 policyholder surplus |
accounts as
calculated under Section 815a of the |
Internal Revenue Code;
|
(B) Certain other insurance companies. In the case |
of mutual
insurance companies subject to the tax |
imposed by Section 831 of the
Internal Revenue Code, |
insurance company taxable income;
|
(C) Regulated investment companies. In the case of |
a regulated
investment company subject to the tax |
imposed by Section 852 of the
Internal Revenue Code, |
|
investment company taxable income;
|
(D) Real estate investment trusts. In the case of a |
real estate
investment trust subject to the tax imposed |
by Section 857 of the
Internal Revenue Code, real |
estate investment trust taxable income;
|
(E) Consolidated corporations. In the case of a |
corporation which
is a member of an affiliated group of |
corporations filing a consolidated
income tax return |
for the taxable year for federal income tax purposes,
|
taxable income determined as if such corporation had |
filed a separate
return for federal income tax purposes |
for the taxable year and each
preceding taxable year |
for which it was a member of an affiliated group.
For |
purposes of this subparagraph, the taxpayer's separate |
taxable
income shall be determined as if the election |
provided by Section
243(b) (2) of the Internal Revenue |
Code had been in effect for all such years;
|
(F) Cooperatives. In the case of a cooperative |
corporation or
association, the taxable income of such |
organization determined in
accordance with the |
provisions of Section 1381 through 1388 of the
Internal |
Revenue Code;
|
(G) Subchapter S corporations. In the case of: (i) |
a Subchapter S
corporation for which there is in effect |
an election for the taxable year
under Section 1362 of |
the Internal Revenue Code, the taxable income of such
|
|
corporation determined in accordance with Section |
1363(b) of the Internal
Revenue Code, except that |
taxable income shall take into
account those items |
which are required by Section 1363(b)(1) of the
|
Internal Revenue Code to be separately stated; and (ii) |
a Subchapter
S corporation for which there is in effect |
a federal election to opt out of
the provisions of the |
Subchapter S Revision Act of 1982 and have applied
|
instead the prior federal Subchapter S rules as in |
effect on July 1, 1982,
the taxable income of such |
corporation determined in accordance with the
federal |
Subchapter S rules as in effect on July 1, 1982; and
|
(H) Partnerships. In the case of a partnership, |
taxable income
determined in accordance with Section |
703 of the Internal Revenue Code,
except that taxable |
income shall take into account those items which are
|
required by Section 703(a)(1) to be separately stated |
but which would be
taken into account by an individual |
in calculating his taxable income.
|
(3) Recapture of business expenses on disposition of |
asset or business. Notwithstanding any other law to the |
contrary, if in prior years income from an asset or |
business has been classified as business income and in a |
later year is demonstrated to be non-business income, then |
all expenses, without limitation, deducted in such later |
year and in the 2 immediately preceding taxable years |
|
related to that asset or business that generated the |
non-business income shall be added back and recaptured as |
business income in the year of the disposition of the asset |
or business. Such amount shall be apportioned to Illinois |
using the greater of the apportionment fraction computed |
for the business under Section 304 of this Act for the |
taxable year or the average of the apportionment fractions |
computed for the business under Section 304 of this Act for |
the taxable year and for the 2 immediately preceding |
taxable years.
|
(f) Valuation limitation amount.
|
(1) In general. The valuation limitation amount |
referred to in
subsections (a) (2) (G), (c) (2) (I) and |
(d)(2) (E) is an amount equal to:
|
(A) The sum of the pre-August 1, 1969 appreciation |
amounts (to the
extent consisting of gain reportable |
under the provisions of Section
1245 or 1250 of the |
Internal Revenue Code) for all property in respect
of |
which such gain was reported for the taxable year; plus
|
(B) The lesser of (i) the sum of the pre-August 1, |
1969 appreciation
amounts (to the extent consisting of |
capital gain) for all property in
respect of which such |
gain was reported for federal income tax purposes
for |
the taxable year, or (ii) the net capital gain for the |
taxable year,
reduced in either case by any amount of |
such gain included in the amount
determined under |
|
subsection (a) (2) (F) or (c) (2) (H).
|
(2) Pre-August 1, 1969 appreciation amount.
|
(A) If the fair market value of property referred |
to in paragraph
(1) was readily ascertainable on August |
1, 1969, the pre-August 1, 1969
appreciation amount for |
such property is the lesser of (i) the excess of
such |
fair market value over the taxpayer's basis (for |
determining gain)
for such property on that date |
(determined under the Internal Revenue
Code as in |
effect on that date), or (ii) the total gain realized |
and
reportable for federal income tax purposes in |
respect of the sale,
exchange or other disposition of |
such property.
|
(B) If the fair market value of property referred |
to in paragraph
(1) was not readily ascertainable on |
August 1, 1969, the pre-August 1,
1969 appreciation |
amount for such property is that amount which bears
the |
same ratio to the total gain reported in respect of the |
property for
federal income tax purposes for the |
taxable year, as the number of full
calendar months in |
that part of the taxpayer's holding period for the
|
property ending July 31, 1969 bears to the number of |
full calendar
months in the taxpayer's entire holding |
period for the
property.
|
(C) The Department shall prescribe such |
regulations as may be
necessary to carry out the |
|
purposes of this paragraph.
|
(g) Double deductions. Unless specifically provided |
otherwise, nothing
in this Section shall permit the same item |
to be deducted more than once.
|
(h) Legislative intention. Except as expressly provided by |
this
Section there shall be no modifications or limitations on |
the amounts
of income, gain, loss or deduction taken into |
account in determining
gross income, adjusted gross income or |
taxable income for federal income
tax purposes for the taxable |
year, or in the amount of such items
entering into the |
computation of base income and net income under this
Act for |
such taxable year, whether in respect of property values as of
|
August 1, 1969 or otherwise.
|
(Source: P.A. 94-776, eff. 5-19-06; 94-789, eff. 5-19-06; |
94-1021, eff. 7-12-06; 94-1074, eff. 12-26-06; 95-23, eff. |
8-3-07; 95-233, eff. 8-16-07; 95-286, eff. 8-20-07; 95-331, |
eff. 8-21-07; revised 10-31-07.)
|
(35 ILCS 5/304) (from Ch. 120, par. 3-304)
|
Sec. 304. Business income of persons other than residents.
|
(a) In general. The business income of a person other than |
a
resident shall be allocated to this State if such person's |
business
income is derived solely from this State. If a person |
other than a
resident derives business income from this State |
|
and one or more other
states, then, for tax years ending on or |
before December 30, 1998, and
except as otherwise provided by |
this Section, such
person's business income shall be |
apportioned to this State by
multiplying the income by a |
fraction, the numerator of which is the sum
of the property |
factor (if any), the payroll factor (if any) and 200% of the
|
sales factor (if any), and the denominator of which is 4 |
reduced by the
number of factors other than the sales factor |
which have a denominator
of zero and by an additional 2 if the |
sales factor has a denominator of zero.
For tax years ending on |
or after December 31, 1998, and except as otherwise
provided by |
this Section, persons other than
residents who derive business |
income from this State and one or more other
states shall |
compute their apportionment factor by weighting their |
property,
payroll, and sales factors as provided in
subsection |
(h) of this Section.
|
(1) Property factor.
|
(A) The property factor is a fraction, the numerator of |
which is the
average value of the person's real and |
tangible personal property owned
or rented and used in the |
trade or business in this State during the
taxable year and |
the denominator of which is the average value of all
the |
person's real and tangible personal property owned or |
rented and
used in the trade or business during the taxable |
year.
|
(B) Property owned by the person is valued at its |
|
original cost.
Property rented by the person is valued at 8 |
times the net annual rental
rate. Net annual rental rate is |
the annual rental rate paid by the
person less any annual |
rental rate received by the person from
sub-rentals.
|
(C) The average value of property shall be determined |
by averaging
the values at the beginning and ending of the |
taxable year but the
Director may require the averaging of |
monthly values during the taxable
year if reasonably |
required to reflect properly the average value of the
|
person's property.
|
(2) Payroll factor.
|
(A) The payroll factor is a fraction, the numerator of |
which is the
total amount paid in this State during the |
taxable year by the person
for compensation, and the |
denominator of which is the total compensation
paid |
everywhere during the taxable year.
|
(B) Compensation is paid in this State if:
|
(i) The individual's service is performed entirely |
within this
State;
|
(ii) The individual's service is performed both |
within and without
this State, but the service |
performed without this State is incidental
to the |
individual's service performed within this State; or
|
(iii) Some of the service is performed within this |
State and either
the base of operations, or if there is |
no base of operations, the place
from which the service |
|
is directed or controlled is within this State,
or the |
base of operations or the place from which the service |
is
directed or controlled is not in any state in which |
some part of the
service is performed, but the |
individual's residence is in this State.
|
(iv) Compensation paid to nonresident professional |
athletes. |
(a) General. The Illinois source income of a |
nonresident individual who is a member of a |
professional athletic team includes the portion of the |
individual's total compensation for services performed |
as a member of a professional athletic team during the |
taxable year which the number of duty days spent within |
this State performing services for the team in any |
manner during the taxable year bears to the total |
number of duty days spent both within and without this |
State during the taxable year. |
(b) Travel days. Travel days that do not involve |
either a game, practice, team meeting, or other similar |
team event are not considered duty days spent in this |
State. However, such travel days are considered in the |
total duty days spent both within and without this |
State. |
(c) Definitions. For purposes of this subpart |
(iv): |
(1) The term "professional athletic team" |
|
includes, but is not limited to, any professional |
baseball, basketball, football, soccer, or hockey |
team. |
(2) The term "member of a professional |
athletic team" includes those employees who are |
active players, players on the disabled list, and |
any other persons required to travel and who travel |
with and perform services on behalf of a |
professional athletic team on a regular basis. |
This includes, but is not limited to, coaches, |
managers, and trainers. |
(3) Except as provided in items (C) and (D) of |
this subpart (3), the term "duty days" means all |
days during the taxable year from the beginning of |
the professional athletic team's official |
pre-season training period through the last game |
in which the team competes or is scheduled to |
compete. Duty days shall be counted for the year in |
which they occur, including where a team's |
official pre-season training period through the |
last game in which the team competes or is |
scheduled to compete, occurs during more than one |
tax year. |
(A) Duty days shall also include days on |
which a member of a professional athletic team |
performs service for a team on a date that does |
|
not fall within the foregoing period (e.g., |
participation in instructional leagues, the |
"All Star Game", or promotional "caravans"). |
Performing a service for a professional |
athletic team includes conducting training and |
rehabilitation activities, when such |
activities are conducted at team facilities. |
(B) Also included in duty days are game |
days, practice days, days spent at team |
meetings, promotional caravans, preseason |
training camps, and days served with the team |
through all post-season games in which the team |
competes or is scheduled to compete. |
(C) Duty days for any person who joins a |
team during the period from the beginning of |
the professional athletic team's official |
pre-season training period through the last |
game in which the team competes, or is |
scheduled to compete, shall begin on the day |
that person joins the team. Conversely, duty |
days for any person who leaves a team during |
this period shall end on the day that person |
leaves the team. Where a person switches teams |
during a taxable year, a separate duty-day |
calculation shall be made for the period the |
person was with each team. |
|
(D) Days for which a member of a |
professional athletic team is not compensated |
and is not performing services for the team in |
any manner, including days when such member of |
a professional athletic team has been |
suspended without pay and prohibited from |
performing any services for the team, shall not |
be treated as duty days. |
(E) Days for which a member of a |
professional athletic team is on the disabled |
list and does not conduct rehabilitation |
activities at facilities of the team, and is |
not otherwise performing services for the team |
in Illinois, shall not be considered duty days |
spent in this State. All days on the disabled |
list, however, are considered to be included in |
total duty days spent both within and without |
this State. |
(4) The term "total compensation for services |
performed as a member of a professional athletic |
team" means the total compensation received during |
the taxable year for services performed: |
(A) from the beginning of the official |
pre-season training period through the last |
game in which the team competes or is scheduled |
to compete during that taxable year; and |
|
(B) during the taxable year on a date which |
does not fall within the foregoing period |
(e.g., participation in instructional leagues, |
the "All Star Game", or promotional caravans). |
This compensation shall include, but is not |
limited to, salaries, wages, bonuses as described |
in this subpart, and any other type of compensation |
paid during the taxable year to a member of a |
professional athletic team for services performed |
in that year. This compensation does not include |
strike benefits, severance pay, termination pay, |
contract or option year buy-out payments, |
expansion or relocation payments, or any other |
payments not related to services performed for the |
team. |
For purposes of this subparagraph, "bonuses" |
included in "total compensation for services |
performed as a member of a professional athletic |
team" subject to the allocation described in |
Section 302(c)(1) are: bonuses earned as a result |
of play (i.e., performance bonuses) during the |
season, including bonuses paid for championship, |
playoff or "bowl" games played by a team, or for |
selection to all-star league or other honorary |
positions; and bonuses paid for signing a |
contract, unless the payment of the signing bonus |
|
is not conditional upon the signee playing any |
games for the team or performing any subsequent |
services for the team or even making the team, the |
signing bonus is payable separately from the |
salary and any other compensation, and the signing |
bonus is nonrefundable.
|
(3) Sales factor.
|
(A) The sales factor is a fraction, the numerator of |
which is the
total sales of the person in this State during |
the taxable year, and the
denominator of which is the total |
sales of the person everywhere during
the taxable year.
|
(B) Sales of tangible personal property are in this |
State if:
|
(i) The property is delivered or shipped to a |
purchaser, other than
the United States government, |
within this State regardless of the f. o.
b. point or |
other conditions of the sale; or
|
(ii) The property is shipped from an office, store, |
warehouse,
factory or other place of storage in this |
State and either the purchaser
is the United States |
government or the person is not taxable in the
state of |
the purchaser; provided, however, that premises owned |
or leased
by a person who has independently contracted |
with the seller for the printing
of newspapers, |
periodicals or books shall not be deemed to be an |
office,
store, warehouse, factory or other place of |
|
storage for purposes of this
Section.
Sales of tangible |
personal property are not in this State if the
seller |
and purchaser would be members of the same unitary |
business group
but for the fact that either the seller |
or purchaser is a person with 80%
or more of total |
business activity outside of the United States and the
|
property is purchased for resale.
|
(B-1) Patents, copyrights, trademarks, and similar |
items of intangible
personal property.
|
(i) Gross receipts from the licensing, sale, or |
other disposition of a
patent, copyright, trademark, |
or similar item of intangible personal property
are in |
this State to the extent the item is utilized in this |
State during the
year the gross receipts are included |
in gross income.
|
(ii) Place of utilization.
|
(I) A patent is utilized in a state to the |
extent that it is employed
in production, |
fabrication, manufacturing, or other processing in |
the state or
to the extent that a patented product |
is produced in the state. If a patent is
utilized |
in
more than one state, the extent to which it is |
utilized in any one state shall
be a fraction equal |
to the gross receipts of the licensee or purchaser |
from
sales or leases of items produced, |
fabricated, manufactured, or processed
within that |
|
state using the patent and of patented items |
produced within that
state, divided by the total of |
such gross receipts for all states in which the
|
patent is utilized.
|
(II) A copyright is utilized in a state to the |
extent that printing or
other publication |
originates in the state. If a copyright is utilized |
in more
than one state, the extent to which it is |
utilized in any one state shall be a
fraction equal |
to the gross receipts from sales or licenses of |
materials
printed or published in that state |
divided by the total of such gross receipts
for all |
states in which the copyright is utilized.
|
(III) Trademarks and other items of intangible |
personal property
governed by this paragraph (B-1) |
are utilized in the state in which the
commercial |
domicile of the licensee or purchaser is located.
|
(iii) If the state of utilization of an item of |
property governed by
this paragraph (B-1) cannot be |
determined from the taxpayer's books and
records or |
from the books and records of any person related to the |
taxpayer
within the meaning of Section 267(b) of the |
Internal Revenue Code, 26 U.S.C.
267, the gross
|
receipts attributable to that item shall be excluded |
from both the numerator
and the denominator of the |
sales factor.
|
|
(B-2) Gross receipts from the license, sale, or other |
disposition of
patents, copyrights, trademarks, and |
similar items of intangible personal
property may be |
included in the numerator or denominator of the sales |
factor
only if gross receipts from licenses, sales, or |
other disposition of such items
comprise more than 50% of |
the taxpayer's total gross receipts included in gross
|
income during the tax year and during each of the 2 |
immediately preceding tax
years; provided that, when a |
taxpayer is a member of a unitary business group,
such |
determination shall be made on the basis of the gross |
receipts of the
entire unitary business group.
|
(B-5) For taxable years ending on or after December 31, |
2008, except as provided in subsections (ii) through (vii), |
receipts from the sale of telecommunications service or |
mobile telecommunications service are in this State if the |
customer's service address is in this State. |
(i) For purposes of this subparagraph (B-5), the |
follow terms have the following meanings: |
"Ancillary services" means services that are |
associated with or incidental to the provision of |
"telecommunications services", including but not |
limited to "detailed telecommunications billing", |
"directory assistance", "vertical service", and "voice |
mail services". |
"Air-to-Ground Radiotelephone service" means a |
|
radio service, as that term is defined in 47 CFR 22.99, |
in which common carriers are authorized to offer and |
provide radio telecommunications service for hire to |
subscribers in aircraft. |
"Call-by-call Basis" means any method of charging |
for telecommunications services where the price is |
measured by individual calls. |
"Communications Channel" means a physical or |
virtual path of communications over which signals are |
transmitted between or among customer channel |
termination points. |
"Conference bridging service" means an "ancillary |
service" that links two or more participants of an |
audio or video conference call and may include the |
provision of a telephone number. "Conference bridging |
service" does not include the "telecommunications |
services" used to reach the conference bridge. |
"Customer Channel Termination Point" means the |
location where the customer either inputs or receives |
the communications. |
"Detailed telecommunications billing service" |
means an "ancillary service" of separately stating |
information pertaining to individual calls on a |
customer's billing statement. |
"Directory assistance" means an "ancillary |
service" of providing telephone number information, |
|
and/or address information. |
"Home service provider" means the facilities based |
carrier or reseller with which the customer contracts |
for the provision of mobile telecommunications |
services. |
"Mobile telecommunications service" means |
commercial mobile radio service, as defined in Section |
20.3 of Title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations as |
in effect on June 1, 1999. |
"Place of primary use" means the street address |
representative of where the customer's use of the |
telecommunications service primarily occurs, which |
must be the residential street address or the primary |
business street address of the customer. In the case of |
mobile telecommunications services, "place of primary |
use" must be within the licensed service area of the |
home service provider. |
"Post-paid telecommunication service" means the |
telecommunications service obtained by making a |
payment on a call-by-call basis either through the use |
of a credit card or payment mechanism such as a bank |
card, travel card, credit card, or debit card, or by |
charge made to a telephone number which is not |
associated with the origination or termination of the |
telecommunications service. A post-paid calling |
service includes telecommunications service, except a |
|
prepaid wireless calling service, that would be a |
prepaid calling service except it is not exclusively a |
telecommunication service. |
"Prepaid telecommunication service" means the |
right to access exclusively telecommunications |
services, which must be paid for in advance and which |
enables the origination of calls using an access number |
or authorization code, whether manually or |
electronically dialed, and that is sold in |
predetermined units or dollars of which the number |
declines with use in a known amount. |
"Prepaid Mobile telecommunication service" means a |
telecommunications service that provides the right to |
utilize mobile wireless service as well as other |
non-telecommunication services, including but not |
limited to ancillary services, which must be paid for |
in advance that is sold in predetermined units or |
dollars of which the number declines with use in a |
known amount. |
"Private communication service" means a |
telecommunication service that entitles the customer |
to exclusive or priority use of a communications |
channel or group of channels between or among |
termination points, regardless of the manner in which |
such channel or channels are connected, and includes |
switching capacity, extension lines, stations, and any |
|
other associated services that are provided in |
connection with the use of such channel or channels. |
"Service address" means: |
(a) The location of the telecommunications |
equipment to which a customer's call is charged and |
from which the call originates or terminates, |
regardless of where the call is billed or paid; |
(b) If the location in line (a) is not known, |
service address means the origination point of the |
signal of the telecommunications services first |
identified by either the seller's |
telecommunications system or in information |
received by the seller from its service provider |
where the system used to transport such signals is |
not that of the seller; and |
(c) If the locations in line (a) and line (b) |
are not known, the service address means the |
location of the customer's place of primary use. |
"Telecommunications service" means the electronic |
transmission, conveyance, or routing of voice, data, |
audio, video, or any other information or signals to a |
point, or between or among points. The term |
"telecommunications service" includes such |
transmission, conveyance, or routing in which computer |
processing applications are used to act on the form, |
code or protocol of the content for purposes of |
|
transmission, conveyance or routing without regard to |
whether such service is referred to as voice over |
Internet protocol services or is classified by the |
Federal Communications Commission as enhanced or value |
added. "Telecommunications service" does not include: |
(a) Data processing and information services |
that allow data to be generated, acquired, stored, |
processed, or retrieved and delivered by an |
electronic transmission to a purchaser when such |
purchaser's primary purpose for the underlying |
transaction is the processed data or information; |
(b) Installation or maintenance of wiring or |
equipment on a customer's premises; |
(c) Tangible personal property; |
(d) Advertising, including but not limited to |
directory advertising. |
(e) Billing and collection services provided |
to third parties; |
(f) Internet access service; |
(g) Radio and television audio and video |
programming services, regardless of the medium, |
including the furnishing of transmission, |
conveyance and routing of such services by the |
programming service provider. Radio and television |
audio and video programming services shall include |
but not be limited to cable service as defined in |
|
47 USC 522(6) and audio and video programming |
services delivered by commercial mobile radio |
service providers, as defined in 47 CFR 20.3; |
(h) "Ancillary services"; or |
(i) Digital products "delivered |
electronically", including but not limited to |
software, music, video, reading materials or ring |
tones. |
"Vertical service" means an "ancillary service" |
that is offered in connection with one or more |
"telecommunications services", which offers advanced |
calling features that allow customers to identify |
callers and to manage multiple calls and call |
connections, including "conference bridging services". |
"Voice mail service" means an "ancillary service" |
that enables the customer to store, send or receive |
recorded messages. "Voice mail service" does not |
include any "vertical services" that the customer may |
be required to have in order to utilize the "voice mail |
service". |
(ii) Receipts from the sale of telecommunications |
service sold on an individual call-by-call basis are in |
this State if either of the following applies: |
(a) The call both originates and terminates in |
this State. |
(b) The call either originates or terminates |
|
in this State and the service address is located in |
this State. |
(iii) Receipts from the sale of postpaid |
telecommunications service at retail are in this State |
if the origination point of the telecommunication |
signal, as first identified by the service provider's |
telecommunication system or as identified by |
information received by the seller from its service |
provider if the system used to transport |
telecommunication signals is not the seller's, is |
located in this State. |
(iv) Receipts from the sale of prepaid |
telecommunications service or prepaid mobile |
telecommunications service at retail are in this State |
if the purchaser obtains the prepaid card or similar |
means of conveyance at a location in this State. |
Receipts from recharging a prepaid telecommunications |
service or mobile telecommunications service is in |
this State if the purchaser's billing information |
indicates a location in this State. |
(v) Receipts from the sale of private |
communication services are in this State as follows: |
(a) 100% of receipts from charges imposed at |
each channel termination point in this State. |
(b) 100% of receipts from charges for the total |
channel mileage between each channel termination |
|
point in this State. |
(c) 50% of the total receipts from charges for |
service segments when those segments are between 2 |
customer channel termination points, 1 of which is |
located in this State and the other is located |
outside of this State, which segments are |
separately charged. |
(d) The receipts from charges for service |
segments with a channel termination point located |
in this State and in two or more other states, and |
which segments are not separately billed, are in |
this State based on a percentage determined by |
dividing the number of customer channel |
termination points in this State by the total |
number of customer channel termination points. |
(vi) Receipts from charges for ancillary services |
for telecommunications service sold to customers at |
retail are in this State if the customer's primary |
place of use of telecommunications services associated |
with those ancillary services is in this State. If the |
seller of those ancillary services cannot determine |
where the associated telecommunications are located, |
then the ancillary services shall be based on the |
location of the purchaser. |
(vii) Receipts to access a carrier's network or |
from the sale of telecommunication services or |
|
ancillary services for resale are in this State as |
follows: |
(a) 100% of the receipts from access fees |
attributable to intrastate telecommunications |
service that both originates and terminates in |
this State. |
(b) 50% of the receipts from access fees |
attributable to interstate telecommunications |
service if the interstate call either originates |
or terminates in this State. |
(c) 100% of the receipts from interstate end |
user access line charges, if the customer's |
service address is in this State. As used in this |
subdivision, "interstate end user access line |
charges" includes, but is not limited to, the |
surcharge approved by the federal communications |
commission and levied pursuant to 47 CFR 69. |
(d) Gross receipts from sales of |
telecommunication services or from ancillary |
services for telecommunications services sold to |
other telecommunication service providers for |
resale shall be sourced to this State using the |
apportionment concepts used for non-resale |
receipts of telecommunications services if the |
information is readily available to make that |
determination. If the information is not readily |
|
available, then the taxpayer may use any other |
reasonable and consistent method.
|
(C) For taxable years ending before December 31, 2008, |
sales, other than sales governed by paragraphs (B), (B-1), |
and (B-2), are in
this State if:
|
(i) The income-producing activity is performed in |
this State; or
|
(ii) The income-producing activity is performed |
both within and
without this State and a greater |
proportion of the income-producing
activity is |
performed within this State than without this State, |
based
on performance costs.
|
(C-5) For taxable years ending on or after December 31, |
2008, sales, other than sales governed by paragraphs (B), |
(B-1), and (B-2) , and (B-5) , are in this State if any of |
the following criteria are met the purchaser is in this |
State or the sale is otherwise attributable to this State's |
marketplace. The following examples are illustrative : |
(i) Sales from the sale or lease of real property |
are in this State if the property is located in this |
State. |
(ii) Sales from the lease or rental of tangible |
personal property are in this State if the property is |
located in this State during the rental period. Sales |
from the lease or rental of tangible personal property |
that is characteristically moving property, including, |
|
but not limited to, motor vehicles, rolling stock, |
aircraft, vessels, or mobile equipment are in this |
State to the extent that the property is used in this |
State. |
(iii) In the case of interest, net gains (but not |
less than zero) and other items of income from |
intangible personal property, the sale is in this State |
if: |
(a) in the case of a taxpayer who is a dealer |
in the item of intangible personal property within |
the meaning of Section 475 of the Internal Revenue |
Code, the income or gain is received from a |
customer in this State. For purposes of this |
subparagraph, a customer is in this State if the |
customer is an individual, trust or estate who is a |
resident of this State and, for all other |
customers, if the customer's commercial domicile |
is in this State. Unless the dealer has actual |
knowledge of the residence or commercial domicile |
of a customer during a taxable year, the customer |
shall be deemed to be a customer in this State if |
the billing address of the customer, as shown in |
the records of the dealer, is in this State; or |
(b) in all other cases, if the |
income-producing activity of the taxpayer is |
performed in this State or, if the |
|
income-producing activity of the taxpayer is |
performed both within and without this State, if a |
greater proportion of the income-producing |
activity of the taxpayer is performed within this |
State than in any other state, based on performance |
costs. Sales of intangible personal property are |
in this State if the purchaser realizes benefit |
from the property in this State. If the purchaser |
realizes benefit from the property both within and |
without this State, the gross receipts from the |
sale shall be divided among those states in which |
the taxpayer is taxable in proportion to the |
benefit in each state. If the proportionate |
benefit in this State cannot be determined, the |
sale shall be excluded from both the numerator and |
the denominator of the sales factor. |
(iv) Sales of services are in this State if the |
services are received in this State. For the purposes |
of this section, gross receipts from the performance of |
services provided to a corporation, partnership, or |
trust may only be attributed to a state where that |
corporation, partnership, or trust has a fixed place of |
business. If the state where the services are received |
is not readily determinable or is a state where the |
corporation, partnership, or trust receiving the |
service does not have a fixed place of business, the |
|
services shall be deemed to be received at the location |
of the office of the customer from which the services |
were ordered in the regular course of the customer's |
trade or business. If the ordering office cannot be |
determined, the services shall be deemed to be received |
at the office of the customer to which the services are |
billed. If the taxpayer is not taxable in the state in |
which the services are received, the sale must be |
excluded from both the numerator and the denominator of |
the sales factor. the benefit of the service is |
realized in this State. If the benefit of the service |
is realized both within and without this State, the |
gross receipts from the sale shall be divided among |
those states in which the taxpayer is taxable in |
proportion to the benefit of service realized in each |
state. If the proportionate benefit in this State |
cannot be determined, the sale shall be excluded from |
both the numerator and the denominator of the sales |
factor. The Department shall may adopt rules |
prescribing where the benefit of specific types of |
service are received , including, but not limited to, |
telecommunications, broadcast, cable, advertising, |
publishing, and utility service , is realized .
|
(D) For taxable years ending on or after December 31, |
1995, the following
items of income shall not be included |
in the numerator or denominator of the
sales factor: |
|
dividends; amounts included under Section 78 of the |
Internal
Revenue Code; and Subpart F income as defined in |
Section 952 of the Internal
Revenue Code.
No inference |
shall be drawn from the enactment of this paragraph (D) in
|
construing this Section for taxable years ending before |
December 31, 1995.
|
(E) Paragraphs (B-1) and (B-2) shall apply to tax years |
ending on or
after December 31, 1999, provided that a |
taxpayer may elect to apply the
provisions of these |
paragraphs to prior tax years. Such election shall be made
|
in the form and manner prescribed by the Department, shall |
be irrevocable, and
shall apply to all tax years; provided |
that, if a taxpayer's Illinois income
tax liability for any |
tax year, as assessed under Section 903 prior to January
1, |
1999, was computed in a manner contrary to the provisions |
of paragraphs
(B-1) or (B-2), no refund shall be payable to |
the taxpayer for that tax year to
the extent such refund is |
the result of applying the provisions of paragraph
(B-1) or |
(B-2) retroactively. In the case of a unitary business |
group, such
election shall apply to all members of such |
group for every tax year such group
is in existence, but |
shall not apply to any taxpayer for any period during
which |
that taxpayer is not a member of such group.
|
(b) Insurance companies.
|
(1) In general. Except as otherwise
provided by |
paragraph (2), business income of an insurance company for |
|
a
taxable year shall be apportioned to this State by |
multiplying such
income by a fraction, the numerator of |
which is the direct premiums
written for insurance upon |
property or risk in this State, and the
denominator of |
which is the direct premiums written for insurance upon
|
property or risk everywhere. For purposes of this |
subsection, the term
"direct premiums written" means the |
total amount of direct premiums
written, assessments and |
annuity considerations as reported for the
taxable year on |
the annual statement filed by the company with the
Illinois |
Director of Insurance in the form approved by the National
|
Convention of Insurance Commissioners
or such other form as |
may be
prescribed in lieu thereof.
|
(2) Reinsurance. If the principal source of premiums |
written by an
insurance company consists of premiums for |
reinsurance accepted by it,
the business income of such |
company shall be apportioned to this State
by multiplying |
such income by a fraction, the numerator of which is the
|
sum of (i) direct premiums written for insurance upon |
property or risk
in this State, plus (ii) premiums written |
for reinsurance accepted in
respect of property or risk in |
this State, and the denominator of which
is the sum of |
(iii) direct premiums written for insurance upon property
|
or risk everywhere, plus (iv) premiums written for |
reinsurance accepted
in respect of property or risk |
everywhere. For taxable years ending before December 31, |
|
2008, for purposes of this
paragraph, premiums written for |
reinsurance accepted in respect of
property or risk in this |
State, whether or not otherwise determinable,
may, at the |
election of the company, be determined on the basis of the
|
proportion which premiums written for reinsurance accepted |
from
companies commercially domiciled in Illinois bears to |
premiums written
for reinsurance accepted from all |
sources, or, alternatively, in the
proportion which the sum |
of the direct premiums written for insurance
upon property |
or risk in this State by each ceding company from which
|
reinsurance is accepted bears to the sum of the total |
direct premiums
written by each such ceding company for the |
taxable year.
|
(c) Financial organizations.
|
(1) In general. For taxable years ending before |
December 31, 2008, business income of a financial
|
organization shall be apportioned to this State by |
multiplying such
income by a fraction, the numerator of |
which is its business income from
sources within this |
State, and the denominator of which is its business
income |
from all sources. For the purposes of this subsection, the
|
business income of a financial organization from sources |
within this
State is the sum of the amounts referred to in |
subparagraphs (A) through
(E) following, but excluding the |
adjusted income of an international banking
facility as |
determined in paragraph (2):
|
|
(A) Fees, commissions or other compensation for |
financial services
rendered within this State;
|
(B) Gross profits from trading in stocks, bonds or |
other securities
managed within this State;
|
(C) Dividends, and interest from Illinois |
customers, which are received
within this State;
|
(D) Interest charged to customers at places of |
business maintained
within this State for carrying |
debit balances of margin accounts,
without deduction |
of any costs incurred in carrying such accounts; and
|
(E) Any other gross income resulting from the |
operation as a
financial organization within this |
State. In computing the amounts
referred to in |
paragraphs (A) through (E) of this subsection, any |
amount
received by a member of an affiliated group |
(determined under Section
1504(a) of the Internal |
Revenue Code but without reference to whether
any such |
corporation is an "includible corporation" under |
Section
1504(b) of the Internal Revenue Code) from |
another member of such group
shall be included only to |
the extent such amount exceeds expenses of the
|
recipient directly related thereto.
|
(2) International Banking Facility. For taxable years |
ending before December 31, 2008:
|
(A) Adjusted Income. The adjusted income of an |
international banking
facility is its income reduced |
|
by the amount of the floor amount.
|
(B) Floor Amount. The floor amount shall be the |
amount, if any,
determined
by multiplying the income of |
the international banking facility by a fraction,
not |
greater than one, which is determined as follows:
|
(i) The numerator shall be:
|
The average aggregate, determined on a |
quarterly basis, of the
financial
organization's |
loans to banks in foreign countries, to foreign |
domiciled
borrowers (except where secured |
primarily by real estate) and to foreign
|
governments and other foreign official |
institutions, as reported for its
branches, |
agencies and offices within the state on its |
"Consolidated Report
of Condition", Schedule A, |
Lines 2.c., 5.b., and 7.a., which was filed with
|
the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and |
other regulatory authorities,
for the year 1980, |
minus
|
The average aggregate, determined on a |
quarterly basis, of such loans
(other
than loans of |
an international banking facility), as reported by |
the financial
institution for its branches, |
agencies and offices within the state, on
the |
corresponding Schedule and lines of the |
Consolidated Report of Condition
for the current |
|
taxable year, provided, however, that in no case |
shall the
amount determined in this clause (the |
subtrahend) exceed the amount determined
in the |
preceding clause (the minuend); and
|
(ii) the denominator shall be the average |
aggregate, determined on a
quarterly basis, of the |
international banking facility's loans to banks in
|
foreign countries, to foreign domiciled borrowers |
(except where secured
primarily by real estate) |
and to foreign governments and other foreign
|
official institutions, which were recorded in its |
financial accounts for
the current taxable year.
|
(C) Change to Consolidated Report of Condition and |
in Qualification.
In the event the Consolidated Report |
of Condition which is filed with the
Federal Deposit |
Insurance Corporation and other regulatory authorities |
is
altered so that the information required for |
determining the floor amount
is not found on Schedule |
A, lines 2.c., 5.b. and 7.a., the financial
institution |
shall notify the Department and the Department may, by
|
regulations or otherwise, prescribe or authorize the |
use of an alternative
source for such information. The |
financial institution shall also notify
the Department |
should its international banking facility fail to |
qualify as
such, in whole or in part, or should there |
be any amendment or change to
the Consolidated Report |
|
of Condition, as originally filed, to the extent
such |
amendment or change alters the information used in |
determining the floor
amount.
|
(3) For taxable years ending on or after December 31, |
2008, the business income of a financial organization shall |
be apportioned to this State by multiplying such income by |
a fraction, the numerator of which is its gross receipts |
from sources in this State or otherwise attributable to |
this State's marketplace and the denominator of which is |
its gross receipts everywhere during the taxable year. |
"Gross receipts" for purposes of this subparagraph (3) |
means gross income, including net taxable gain on |
disposition of assets, including securities and money |
market instruments, when derived from transactions and |
activities in the regular course of the financial |
organization's trade or business. If a person derives |
business income from activities in addition to the |
provision of financial services, this subparagraph (3) |
shall apply only to its business income from financial |
services, and its other business income shall be |
apportioned to this State under the applicable provisions |
of this Section. The following examples are illustrative:
|
(i) Receipts from the lease or rental of real or |
tangible personal property are in this State if the |
property is located in this State during the rental |
period. Receipts from the lease or rental of tangible |
|
personal property that is characteristically moving |
property, including, but not limited to, motor |
vehicles, rolling stock, aircraft, vessels, or mobile |
equipment are from sources in this State to the extent |
that the property is used in this State. |
(ii) Interest income, commissions, fees, gains on |
disposition, and other receipts from assets in the |
nature of loans that are secured primarily by real |
estate or tangible personal property are from sources |
in this State if the security is located in this State. |
(iii) Interest income, commissions, fees, gains on |
disposition, and other receipts from consumer loans |
that are not secured by real or tangible personal |
property are from sources in this State if the debtor |
is a resident of this State. |
(iv) Interest income, commissions, fees, gains on |
disposition, and other receipts from commercial loans |
and installment obligations that are not secured by |
real or tangible personal property are from sources in |
this State if the proceeds of the loan are to be |
applied in this State. If it cannot be determined where |
the funds are to be applied, the income and receipts |
are from sources in this State if the office of the |
borrower from which the loan was negotiated in the |
regular course of business is located in this State. If |
the location of this office cannot be determined, the |
|
income and receipts shall be excluded from the |
numerator and denominator of the sales factor.
|
(v) Interest income, fees, gains on disposition, |
service charges, merchant discount income, and other |
receipts from credit card receivables are from sources |
in this State if the card charges are regularly billed |
to a customer in this State. |
(vi) Receipts from the performance of services, |
including, but not limited to, fiduciary, advisory, |
and brokerage services, are in this State if the |
services are received in this State within the meaning |
of subparagraph (a)(3)(C-5)(iv) of this Section. the |
benefit of the service is realized in this State. If |
the benefit of the service is realized both within and |
without this State, the gross receipts from the sale |
shall be divided among those states in which the |
taxpayer is taxable in proportion to the benefit of |
service realized in each state. If the proportionate |
benefit in this State cannot be determined, the sale |
shall be excluded from both the numerator and the |
denominator of the gross receipts factor. |
(vii) Receipts from the issuance of travelers |
checks and money orders are from sources in this State |
if the checks and money orders are issued from a |
location within this State. |
(viii) Receipts from investment assets and |
|
activities and trading assets and activities are |
included in the receipts factor as follows: |
(1) Interest, dividends, net gains (but not |
less than zero) and other income from investment |
assets and activities from trading assets and |
activities shall be included in the receipts |
factor. Investment assets and activities and |
trading assets and activities include but are not |
limited to: investment securities; trading account |
assets; federal funds; securities purchased and |
sold under agreements to resell or repurchase; |
options; futures contracts; forward contracts; |
notional principal contracts such as swaps; |
equities; and foreign currency transactions. With |
respect to the investment and trading assets and |
activities described in subparagraphs (A) and (B) |
of this paragraph, the receipts factor shall |
include the amounts described in such |
subparagraphs. |
(A) The receipts factor shall include the |
amount by which interest from federal funds |
sold and securities purchased under resale |
agreements exceeds interest expense on federal |
funds purchased and securities sold under |
repurchase agreements. |
(B) The receipts factor shall include the |
|
amount by which interest, dividends, gains and |
other income from trading assets and |
activities, including but not limited to |
assets and activities in the matched book, in |
the arbitrage book, and foreign currency |
transactions, exceed amounts paid in lieu of |
interest, amounts paid in lieu of dividends, |
and losses from such assets and activities. |
(2) The numerator of the receipts factor |
includes interest, dividends, net gains (but not |
less than zero), and other income from investment |
assets and activities and from trading assets and |
activities described in paragraph (1) of this |
subsection that are attributable to this State. |
(A) The amount of interest, dividends, net |
gains (but not less than zero), and other |
income from investment assets and activities |
in the investment account to be attributed to |
this State and included in the numerator is |
determined by multiplying all such income from |
such assets and activities by a fraction, the |
numerator of which is the gross income from |
such assets and activities which are properly |
assigned to a fixed place of business of the |
taxpayer within this State and the denominator |
of which is the gross income from all such |
|
assets and activities. |
(B) The amount of interest from federal |
funds sold and purchased and from securities |
purchased under resale agreements and |
securities sold under repurchase agreements |
attributable to this State and included in the |
numerator is determined by multiplying the |
amount described in subparagraph (A) of |
paragraph (1) of this subsection from such |
funds and such securities by a fraction, the |
numerator of which is the gross income from |
such funds and such securities which are |
properly assigned to a fixed place of business |
of the taxpayer within this State and the |
denominator of which is the gross income from |
all such funds and such securities. |
(C) The amount of interest, dividends, |
gains, and other income from trading assets and |
activities, including but not limited to |
assets and activities in the matched book, in |
the arbitrage book and foreign currency |
transactions (but excluding amounts described |
in subparagraphs (A) or (B) of this paragraph), |
attributable to this State and included in the |
numerator is determined by multiplying the |
amount described in subparagraph (B) of |
|
paragraph (1) of this subsection by a fraction, |
the numerator of which is the gross income from |
such trading assets and activities which are |
properly assigned to a fixed place of business |
of the taxpayer within this State and the |
denominator of which is the gross income from |
all such assets and activities. |
(D) Properly assigned, for purposes of |
this paragraph (2) of this subsection, means |
the investment or trading asset or activity is |
assigned to the fixed place of business with |
which it has a preponderance of substantive |
contacts. An investment or trading asset or |
activity assigned by the taxpayer to a fixed |
place of business without the State shall be |
presumed to have been properly assigned if: |
(i) the taxpayer has assigned, in the |
regular course of its business, such asset |
or activity on its records to a fixed place |
of business consistent with federal or |
state regulatory requirements; |
(ii) such assignment on its records is |
based upon substantive contacts of the |
asset or activity to such fixed place of |
business; and |
(iii) the taxpayer uses such records |
|
reflecting assignment of such assets or |
activities for the filing of all state and |
local tax returns for which an assignment |
of such assets or activities to a fixed |
place of business is required. |
(E) The presumption of proper assignment |
of an investment or trading asset or activity |
provided in subparagraph (D) of paragraph (2) |
of this subsection may be rebutted upon a |
showing by the Department, supported by a |
preponderance of the evidence, that the |
preponderance of substantive contacts |
regarding such asset or activity did not occur |
at the fixed place of business to which it was |
assigned on the taxpayer's records. If the |
fixed place of business that has a |
preponderance of substantive contacts cannot |
be determined for an investment or trading |
asset or activity to which the presumption in |
subparagraph (D) of paragraph (2) of this |
subsection does not apply or with respect to |
which that presumption has been rebutted, that |
asset or activity is properly assigned to the |
state in which the taxpayer's commercial |
domicile is located. For purposes of this |
subparagraph (E), it shall be presumed, |
|
subject to rebuttal, that taxpayer's |
commercial domicile is in the state of the |
United States or the District of Columbia to |
which the greatest number of employees are |
regularly connected with the management of the |
investment or trading income or out of which |
they are working, irrespective of where the |
services of such employees are performed, as of |
the last day of the taxable year. In the case |
of a financial organization that accepts |
deposits, receipts from investments and from |
money market instruments are apportioned to |
this State based on the ratio that the total |
deposits of the financial organization |
(including all members of the financial |
organization's unitary group) from this State, |
its residents, (including businesses with an |
office or other place of business in this |
State), and its political subdivisions, |
agencies, and instrumentalities bear to total |
deposits everywhere. For purposes of this |
subdivision, deposits must be attributed to |
this State under the preceding sentence, |
whether or not the deposits are accepted or |
maintained by the financial organization at |
locations within this State. In the case of a |
|
financial organization that does not accept |
deposits, receipts from investments in |
securities and from money market instruments |
shall be excluded from the numerator and the |
denominator of the gross receipts factor.
|
(4) (Blank). As used in subparagraph (3), "deposit" |
includes but is not limited to: |
(i) the unpaid balance of money or its equivalent |
received or held by a financial institution in the |
usual course of business and for which it has given or |
is obligated to give credit, either conditionally or |
unconditionally, to a commercial, checking, savings, |
time, or thrift account whether or not advance notice |
is required to withdraw the credited funds, or which is |
evidenced by its certificate of deposit, thrift |
certificate, investment certificate, or certificate of |
indebtedness, or other similar name, or a check or |
draft drawn against a deposit account and certified by |
the financial organization, or a letter of credit or a |
traveler's check on which the financial organization |
is primarily liable. However, without limiting the |
generality of the term "money or its equivalent", any |
such account or instrument must be regarded as |
evidencing the receipt of the equivalent of money when |
credited or issued in exchange for checks or drafts or |
for a promissory note upon which the person obtaining |
|
the credit or instrument is primarily or secondarily |
liable, or for a charge against a deposit account, or |
in settlement of checks, drafts, or other instruments |
forwarded to the bank for collection; |
(ii) trust funds received or held by the financial |
organization, whether held in the trust department or |
held or deposited in any other department of the |
financial organization; |
(iii) money received or held by a financial |
organization, or the credit given for money or its |
equivalent received or held by a financial |
organization, in the usual course of business for a |
special or specific purpose, regardless of the legal |
relationship so established. Under this paragraph, |
"deposit" includes, but is not limited to, escrow |
funds, funds held as security for an obligation due to |
the financial organization or others, including funds |
held as dealers reserves, or for securities loaned by |
the financial organization, funds deposited by a |
debtor to meet maturing obligations, funds deposited |
as advance payment on subscriptions to United States |
government securities, funds held for distribution or |
purchase of securities, funds held to meet its |
acceptances or letters of credit, and withheld taxes. |
It does not include funds received by the financial |
organization for immediate application to the |
|
reduction of an indebtedness to the receiving |
financial organization, or under condition that the |
receipt of the funds immediately reduces or |
extinguishes the indebtedness; |
(iv) outstanding drafts, including advice of |
another financial organization, cashier's checks, |
money orders, or other officer's checks issued in the |
usual course of business for any purpose, but not |
including those issued in payment for services, |
dividends, or purchases or other costs or expenses of |
the financial organization itself; and |
(v) money or its equivalent held as a credit |
balance by a financial organization on behalf of its |
customer if the entity is engaged in soliciting and |
holding such balances in the regular course of its |
business.
|
(5) (Blank). As used in subparagraph (3), "money market |
instruments" includes but is not limited to: |
(i) Interest-bearing deposits, federal funds sold |
and securities purchased under agreements to resell, |
commercial paper, banker's acceptances, and purchased |
certificates of deposit and similar instruments to the |
extent that the instruments are reflected as assets |
under generally accepted accounting principles. |
"Securities" means corporate stock, bonds, and |
other securities (including, for purposes of taxation |
|
of gains on securities and for purchases under |
agreements to resell, United States Treasury |
securities, obligations of United States government |
agencies and corporations, obligations of state and |
political subdivisions, the interest on which is |
exempt from Illinois income tax), participations in |
securities backed by mortgages held by United States or |
state government agencies, loan-backed securities, and |
similar investments to the extent the investments are |
reflected as assets under generally accepted |
accounting principles. |
(ii) For purposes of subparagraph (3), "money |
market instruments" shall include investments in |
investment partnerships, trusts, pools, funds, |
investment companies, or any similar entity in |
proportion to the investment of the entity in money |
market instruments, and "securities" shall include |
investments in investment partnerships, trusts, pools, |
funds, investment companies, or any similar entity in |
proportion to the investment of the entity in |
securities.
|
(d) Transportation services. For taxable years ending |
before December 31, 2008, business income derived from |
furnishing
transportation services shall be apportioned to |
this State in accordance
with paragraphs (1) and (2):
|
(1) Such business income (other than that derived from
|
|
transportation by pipeline) shall be apportioned to this |
State by
multiplying such income by a fraction, the |
numerator of which is the
revenue miles of the person in |
this State, and the denominator of which
is the revenue |
miles of the person everywhere. For purposes of this
|
paragraph, a revenue mile is the transportation of 1 |
passenger or 1 net
ton of freight the distance of 1 mile |
for a consideration. Where a
person is engaged in the |
transportation of both passengers and freight,
the |
fraction above referred to shall be determined by means of |
an
average of the passenger revenue mile fraction and the |
freight revenue
mile fraction, weighted to reflect the |
person's
|
(A) relative railway operating income from total |
passenger and total
freight service, as reported to the |
Interstate Commerce Commission, in
the case of |
transportation by railroad, and
|
(B) relative gross receipts from passenger and |
freight
transportation, in case of transportation |
other than by railroad.
|
(2) Such business income derived from transportation |
by pipeline
shall be apportioned to this State by |
multiplying such income by a
fraction, the numerator of |
which is the revenue miles of the person in
this State, and |
the denominator of which is the revenue miles of the
person |
everywhere. For the purposes of this paragraph, a revenue |
|
mile is
the transportation by pipeline of 1 barrel of oil, |
1,000 cubic feet of
gas, or of any specified quantity of |
any other substance, the distance
of 1 mile for a |
consideration.
|
(3) For taxable years ending on or after December 31, |
2008, business income derived from providing |
transportation services other than airline services shall |
be apportioned to this State by using a fraction, (a) the |
numerator of which shall be (i) all receipts from any |
movement or shipment of people, goods, mail, oil, gas, or |
any other substance (other than by airline) that both |
originates and terminates in this State, plus (ii) that |
portion of the person's gross receipts from movements or |
shipments of people, goods, mail, oil, gas, or any other |
substance (other than by airline) that originates in one |
state or jurisdiction and terminates in another state or |
jurisdiction passing through, into, or out of this State , |
that is determined by the ratio that the miles traveled in |
this State bears to total miles everywhere from point of |
origin to point of destination and (b) the denominator of |
which shall be all revenue derived from the movement or |
shipment of people, goods, mail, oil, gas, or any other |
substance (other than by airline). Where a taxpayer is |
engaged in the transportation of both passengers and |
freight, the fraction above referred to shall first be |
determined separately for passenger miles and freight |
|
miles. Then an average of the passenger miles fraction and |
the freight miles fraction shall be weighted to reflect the |
taxpayer's: |
(A) relative railway operating income from total |
passenger and total freight service, as reported to the |
Surface Transportation Board, in the case of |
transportation by railroad; and |
(B) relative gross receipts from passenger and |
freight transportation, in case of transportation |
other than by railroad. If a person derives business |
income from activities in addition to the provision of |
transportation services (other than by airline), this |
subsection shall apply only to its business income from |
transportation services and its other business income |
shall be apportioned to this State according to the |
applicable provisions of this Section.
|
(4) For taxable years ending on or after December 31, |
2008, business income derived from furnishing airline
|
transportation services shall be apportioned to this State |
by
multiplying such income by a fraction, the numerator of |
which is the
revenue miles of the person in this State, and |
the denominator of which
is the revenue miles of the person |
everywhere. For purposes of this
paragraph, a revenue mile |
is the transportation of one passenger or one net
ton of |
freight the distance of one mile for a consideration. If a
|
person is engaged in the transportation of both passengers |
|
and freight,
the fraction above referred to shall be |
determined by means of an
average of the passenger revenue |
mile fraction and the freight revenue
mile fraction, |
weighted to reflect the person's relative gross receipts |
from passenger and freight
airline transportation. For |
taxable years ending on or after December 31, 2008, |
business income derived from providing airline services |
shall be apportioned to this State by using a fraction, (a) |
the numerator of which shall be arrivals of aircraft to and |
departures from this State weighted as to cost of aircraft |
by type and (b) the denominator of which shall be total |
arrivals and departures of aircraft weighted as to cost of |
aircraft by type. If a person derives business income from |
activities in addition to the provision of airline |
services, this subsection shall apply only to its business |
income from airline services and its other business income |
shall be apportioned to this State under the applicable |
provisions of this Section.
|
(e) Combined apportionment. Where 2 or more persons are |
engaged in
a unitary business as described in subsection |
(a)(27) of
Section 1501,
a part of which is conducted in this |
State by one or more members of the
group, the business income |
attributable to this State by any such member
or members shall |
be apportioned by means of the combined apportionment method.
|
(f) Alternative allocation. If the allocation and |
apportionment
provisions of subsections (a) through (e) and of |
|
subsection (h) do not
fairly represent the
extent of a person's |
business activity in this State, the person may
petition for, |
or the Director may, without a petition, permit or require, in |
respect of all or any part
of the person's business activity, |
if reasonable:
|
(1) Separate accounting;
|
(2) The exclusion of any one or more factors;
|
(3) The inclusion of one or more additional factors |
which will
fairly represent the person's business |
activities in this State; or
|
(4) The employment of any other method to effectuate an |
equitable
allocation and apportionment of the person's |
business income.
|
(g) Cross reference. For allocation of business income by |
residents,
see Section 301(a).
|
(h) For tax years ending on or after December 31, 1998, the |
apportionment
factor of persons who apportion their business |
income to this State under
subsection (a) shall be equal to:
|
(1) for tax years ending on or after December 31, 1998 |
and before December
31, 1999, 16 2/3% of the property |
factor plus 16 2/3% of the payroll factor
plus
66 2/3% of |
the sales factor;
|
(2) for tax years ending on or after December 31, 1999 |
and before December
31,
2000, 8 1/3% of the property factor |
plus 8 1/3% of the payroll factor plus 83
1/3%
of the sales |
factor;
|
|
(3) for tax years ending on or after December 31, 2000, |
the sales factor.
|
If, in any tax year ending on or after December 31, 1998 and |
before December
31, 2000, the denominator of the payroll, |
property, or sales factor is zero,
the apportionment
factor |
computed in paragraph (1) or (2) of this subsection for that |
year shall
be divided by an amount equal to 100% minus the |
percentage weight given to each
factor whose denominator is |
equal to zero.
|
(Source: P.A. 94-247, eff. 1-1-06; 95-233, eff. 8-16-07.)
|
(35 ILCS 5/704A) |
Sec. 704A. Employer's return and payment of tax withheld. |
(a) In general, every employer who deducts and withholds or |
is required to deduct and withhold tax under this Act on or |
after January 1, 2008 shall make those payments and returns as |
provided in this Section. |
(b) Returns. Every employer shall, in the form and manner |
required by the Department, make returns with respect to taxes |
withheld or required to be withheld under this Article 7 for |
each quarter beginning on or after January 1, 2008, on or |
before the last day of the first month following the close of |
that quarter. |
(c) Payments. With respect to amounts withheld or required |
to be withheld on or after January 1, 2008: |
(1) Semi-weekly payments. For each calendar year, each |
|
employer who withheld or was required to withhold more than |
$12,000 during the one-year period ending on June 30 of the |
immediately preceding calendar year, payment must be made: |
(A) on or before each Friday of the calendar year, |
for taxes withheld or required to be withheld on the |
immediately preceding Saturday, Sunday, Monday, or |
Tuesday; |
(B) on or before each Wednesday of the calendar |
year, for taxes withheld or required to be withheld on |
the immediately preceding Wednesday, Thursday, or |
Friday. |
(2) Semi-weekly payments. Any employer who withholds |
or is required to withhold more than $12,000 in any quarter |
of a calendar year is required to make payments on the |
dates set forth under item (1) of this subsection (c) for |
each remaining quarter of that calendar year and for the |
subsequent calendar year.
|
(3) Monthly payments. Each employer, other than an |
employer described in items (1) or (2) of this subsection, |
shall pay to the Department, on or before the 15th day of |
each month the taxes withheld or required to be withheld |
during the immediately preceding month. |
(4) Payments with returns. Each employer shall pay to |
the Department, on or before the due date for each return |
required to be filed under this Section, any tax withheld |
or required to be withheld during the period for which the |
|
return is due and not previously paid to the Department. |
(d) Regulatory authority. The Department may, by rule: |
(1) If the aggregate amounts required to be withheld |
under this Article 7 do not exceed $1,000 for the calendar |
year, permit employers, in lieu of the requirements of |
subsections (b) and (c), to file annual returns due on or |
before January 31 of the following year for taxes withheld |
or required to be withheld during that calendar year and to |
pay the taxes required to be shown on each such return no |
later than the due date for such return. |
(2) Provide that any payment required to be made under |
subsection (c)(1) or (c)(2) is deemed to be timely to the |
extent paid by electronic funds transfer on or before the |
due date for deposit of federal income taxes withheld from, |
or federal employment taxes due with respect to, the wages |
from which the Illinois taxes were withheld. |
(3) Designate one or more depositories to which payment |
of taxes required to be withheld under this Article 7 must |
be paid by some or all employers. |
(4) Increase the threshold dollar amounts at which |
employers are required to make semi-weekly payments under |
subsection (c)(1) or (c)(2). |
(e) Annual return and payment. Every employer who deducts |
and withholds or is required to deduct and withhold tax from a |
person engaged in domestic service employment, as that term is |
defined in Section 3510 of the Internal Revenue Code, may |
|
comply with the requirements of this Section with respect to |
such employees by filing an annual return and paying the taxes |
required to be deducted and withheld on or before the 15th day |
of the fourth month following the close of the employer's |
taxable year. The Department may allow the employer's return to |
be submitted with the employer's individual income tax return |
or to be submitted with a return due from the employer under |
Section 1400.2 of the Unemployment Insurance Act. |
(f) Magnetic media and electronic filing. Any W-2 Form |
that, under the Internal Revenue Code and regulations |
promulgated thereunder, is required to be submitted to the |
Internal Revenue Service on magnetic media or electronically |
must also be submitted to the Department on magnetic media or |
electronically for Illinois purposes, if required by the |
Department.
|
(Source: P.A. 95-8, eff. 6-29-07.) |
(35 ILCS 5/709.5)
|
Sec. 709.5. Withholding by partnerships, Subchapter S |
corporations, and trusts. |
(a) In general. For each taxable year ending on or after |
December 31, 2008, every partnership (other than a publicly |
traded partnership under Section 7704 of the Internal Revenue |
Code or investment partnership ), Subchapter S corporation, and |
trust must withhold from each nonresident partner, |
shareholder, or beneficiary (other than a partner, |
|
shareholder, or beneficiary who is exempt from tax under |
Section 501(a) of the Internal Revenue Code or under Section |
205 of this Act or who is included on a composite return filed |
by the partnership or Subchapter S corporation for the taxable |
year under subsection (f) of Section 502 of this Act) an amount |
equal to the distributable share of the business income of the |
partnership, Subchapter S corporation, or trust apportionable |
to Illinois of that partner, shareholder, or beneficiary under |
Sections 702 and 704 and Subchapter S of the Internal Revenue |
Code, whether or not distributed, multiplied by the applicable |
rates of tax for that partner or shareholder under subsections |
(a) through (d) of Section 201 of this Act. |
(b) Credit for taxes withheld. Any amount withheld under |
subsection (a) of this Section and paid to the Department shall |
be treated as a payment of the estimated tax liability or of |
the liability for withholding under this Section of the |
partner, shareholder, or beneficiary to whom the income is |
distributable for the taxable year in which that person |
incurred a liability under this Act with respect to that |
income.
The Department shall adopt rules pursuant to which a |
partner, shareholder, or beneficiary may claim a credit against |
its obligation for withholding under this Section for amounts |
withheld under this Section with respect to income |
distributable to it by a partnership, Subchapter S corporation, |
or trust and allowing its partners, shareholders, or |
beneficiaries to claim a credit under this subsection (b) for |
|
those withheld amounts.
|
(c) Exemption from withholding. |
(1) A partnership, Subchapter S corporation, or trust |
shall not be required to withhold tax under subsection (a) |
of this Section with respect to any nonresident partner, |
shareholder, or beneficiary (other than an individual) |
from whom the partnership, S corporation, or trust has |
received a certificate, completed in the form and manner |
prescribed by the Department, stating that such |
nonresident partner, shareholder, or beneficiary shall: |
(A) file all returns that the partner, |
shareholder, or beneficiary is required to file under |
Section 502 of this Act and make timely payment of all |
taxes imposed under Section 201 of this Act or under |
this Section on the partner, shareholder, or |
beneficiary with respect to income of the partnership, |
S corporation, or trust; and |
(B) be subject to personal jurisdiction in this |
State for purposes of the collection of income taxes, |
together with related interest and penalties, imposed |
on the partner, shareholder, or beneficiary with |
respect to the income of the partnership, S |
corporation, or trust. |
(2) The Department may revoke the exemption provided by |
this subsection (c) at any time that it determines that the |
nonresident partner, shareholder, or beneficiary is not |
|
abiding by the terms of the certificate. The Department |
shall notify the partnership, S corporation, or trust that |
it has revoked a certificate by notice left at the usual |
place of business of the partnership, S corporation, or |
trust or by mail to the last known address of the |
partnership, S corporation, or trust. |
(3) A partnership, S corporation, or trust that |
receives a certificate under this subsection (c) properly |
completed by a nonresident partner, shareholder, or |
beneficiary shall not be required to withhold any amount |
from that partner, shareholder, or beneficiary, the |
payment of which would be due under Section 711(a-5) of |
this Act after the receipt of the certificate and no |
earlier than 60 days after the Department has notified the |
partnership, S corporation, or trust that the certificate |
has been revoked. |
(4) Certificates received by a the partnership, S |
corporation, or trust under this subsection (c) must be |
retained by the partnership, S corporation, or trust and a |
record of such certificates must be provided to the |
Department, in a format in which the record is available |
for review by the Department, upon request by the |
Department. The Department may, by rule, require the record |
of certificates to be maintained and provided to the |
Department electronically.
|
(Source: P.A. 95-233, eff. 8-16-07.)
|
|
(35 ILCS 5/901) (from Ch. 120, par. 9-901)
|
Sec. 901. Collection Authority.
|
(a) In general.
|
The Department shall collect the taxes imposed by this Act. |
The Department
shall collect certified past due child support |
amounts under Section 2505-650
of the Department of Revenue Law |
(20 ILCS 2505/2505-650). Except as
provided in subsections (c) |
and (e) of this Section, money collected
pursuant to |
subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of this Act shall be
|
paid into the General Revenue Fund in the State treasury; money
|
collected pursuant to subsections (c) and (d) of Section 201 of |
this Act
shall be paid into the Personal Property Tax |
Replacement Fund, a special
fund in the State Treasury; and |
money collected under Section 2505-650 of the
Department of |
Revenue Law (20 ILCS 2505/2505-650) shall be paid
into the
|
Child Support Enforcement Trust Fund, a special fund outside |
the State
Treasury, or
to the State
Disbursement Unit |
established under Section 10-26 of the Illinois Public Aid
|
Code, as directed by the Department of Healthcare and Family |
Services.
|
(b) Local Governmental Distributive Fund.
|
Beginning August 1, 1969, and continuing through June 30, |
1994, the Treasurer
shall transfer each month from the General |
Revenue Fund to a special fund in
the State treasury, to be |
known as the "Local Government Distributive Fund", an
amount |
|
equal to 1/12 of the net revenue realized from the tax imposed |
by
subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of this Act during |
the preceding month.
Beginning July 1, 1994, and continuing |
through June 30, 1995, the Treasurer
shall transfer each month |
from the General Revenue Fund to the Local Government
|
Distributive Fund an amount equal to 1/11 of the net revenue |
realized from the
tax imposed by subsections (a) and (b) of |
Section 201 of this Act during the
preceding month. Beginning |
July 1, 1995, the Treasurer shall transfer each
month from the |
General Revenue Fund to the Local Government Distributive Fund
|
an amount equal to the net of (i) 1/10 of the net revenue |
realized from the
tax imposed by
subsections (a) and (b) of |
Section 201 of the Illinois Income Tax Act during
the preceding |
month
(ii) minus, beginning July 1, 2003 and ending June 30, |
2004, $6,666,666, and
beginning July 1,
2004,
zero. Net revenue |
realized for a month shall be defined as the
revenue from the |
tax imposed by subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of this
|
Act which is deposited in the General Revenue Fund, the |
Educational Assistance
Fund and the Income Tax Surcharge Local |
Government Distributive Fund during the
month minus the amount |
paid out of the General Revenue Fund in State warrants
during |
that same month as refunds to taxpayers for overpayment of |
liability
under the tax imposed by subsections (a) and (b) of |
Section 201 of this Act.
|
(c) Deposits Into Income Tax Refund Fund.
|
(1) Beginning on January 1, 1989 and thereafter, the |
|
Department shall
deposit a percentage of the amounts |
collected pursuant to subsections (a)
and (b)(1), (2), and |
(3), of Section 201 of this Act into a fund in the State
|
treasury known as the Income Tax Refund Fund. The |
Department shall deposit 6%
of such amounts during the |
period beginning January 1, 1989 and ending on June
30, |
1989. Beginning with State fiscal year 1990 and for each |
fiscal year
thereafter, the percentage deposited into the |
Income Tax Refund Fund during a
fiscal year shall be the |
Annual Percentage. For fiscal years 1999 through
2001, the |
Annual Percentage shall be 7.1%.
For fiscal year 2003, the |
Annual Percentage shall be 8%.
For fiscal year 2004, the |
Annual Percentage shall be 11.7%. Upon the effective date |
of this amendatory Act of the 93rd General Assembly, the |
Annual Percentage shall be 10% for fiscal year 2005. For |
fiscal year 2006, the Annual Percentage shall be 9.75%. For |
fiscal
year 2007, the Annual Percentage shall be 9.75%. For |
fiscal year 2008, the Annual Percentage shall be 7.75%. For |
all other
fiscal years, the
Annual Percentage shall be |
calculated as a fraction, the numerator of which
shall be |
the amount of refunds approved for payment by the |
Department during
the preceding fiscal year as a result of |
overpayment of tax liability under
subsections (a) and |
(b)(1), (2), and (3) of Section 201 of this Act plus the
|
amount of such refunds remaining approved but unpaid at the |
end of the
preceding fiscal year, minus the amounts |
|
transferred into the Income Tax
Refund Fund from the |
Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund, and
the denominator of |
which shall be the amounts which will be collected pursuant
|
to subsections (a) and (b)(1), (2), and (3) of Section 201 |
of this Act during
the preceding fiscal year; except that |
in State fiscal year 2002, the Annual
Percentage shall in |
no event exceed 7.6%. The Director of Revenue shall
certify |
the Annual Percentage to the Comptroller on the last |
business day of
the fiscal year immediately preceding the |
fiscal year for which it is to be
effective.
|
(2) Beginning on January 1, 1989 and thereafter, the |
Department shall
deposit a percentage of the amounts |
collected pursuant to subsections (a)
and (b)(6), (7), and |
(8), (c) and (d) of Section 201
of this Act into a fund in |
the State treasury known as the Income Tax
Refund Fund. The |
Department shall deposit 18% of such amounts during the
|
period beginning January 1, 1989 and ending on June 30, |
1989. Beginning
with State fiscal year 1990 and for each |
fiscal year thereafter, the
percentage deposited into the |
Income Tax Refund Fund during a fiscal year
shall be the |
Annual Percentage. For fiscal years 1999, 2000, and 2001, |
the
Annual Percentage shall be 19%.
For fiscal year 2003, |
the Annual Percentage shall be 27%. For fiscal year
2004, |
the Annual Percentage shall be 32%.
Upon the effective date |
of this amendatory Act of the 93rd General Assembly, the |
Annual Percentage shall be 24% for fiscal year 2005.
For |
|
fiscal year 2006, the Annual Percentage shall be 20%. For |
fiscal
year 2007, the Annual Percentage shall be 17.5%. For |
fiscal year 2008, the Annual Percentage shall be 15.5%. For |
all other fiscal years, the Annual
Percentage shall be |
calculated
as a fraction, the numerator of which shall be |
the amount of refunds
approved for payment by the |
Department during the preceding fiscal year as
a result of |
overpayment of tax liability under subsections (a) and |
(b)(6),
(7), and (8), (c) and (d) of Section 201 of this |
Act plus the
amount of such refunds remaining approved but |
unpaid at the end of the
preceding fiscal year, and the |
denominator of
which shall be the amounts which will be |
collected pursuant to subsections (a)
and (b)(6), (7), and |
(8), (c) and (d) of Section 201 of this Act during the
|
preceding fiscal year; except that in State fiscal year |
2002, the Annual
Percentage shall in no event exceed 23%. |
The Director of Revenue shall
certify the Annual Percentage |
to the Comptroller on the last business day of
the fiscal |
year immediately preceding the fiscal year for which it is |
to be
effective.
|
(3) The Comptroller shall order transferred and the |
Treasurer shall
transfer from the Tobacco Settlement |
Recovery Fund to the Income Tax Refund
Fund (i) $35,000,000 |
in January, 2001, (ii) $35,000,000 in January, 2002, and
|
(iii) $35,000,000 in January, 2003.
|
(d) Expenditures from Income Tax Refund Fund.
|
|
(1) Beginning January 1, 1989, money in the Income Tax |
Refund Fund
shall be expended exclusively for the purpose |
of paying refunds resulting
from overpayment of tax |
liability under Section 201 of this Act, for paying
rebates |
under Section 208.1 in the event that the amounts in the |
Homeowners'
Tax Relief Fund are insufficient for that |
purpose,
and for
making transfers pursuant to this |
subsection (d).
|
(2) The Director shall order payment of refunds |
resulting from
overpayment of tax liability under Section |
201 of this Act from the
Income Tax Refund Fund only to the |
extent that amounts collected pursuant
to Section 201 of |
this Act and transfers pursuant to this subsection (d)
and |
item (3) of subsection (c) have been deposited and retained |
in the
Fund.
|
(3) As soon as possible after the end of each fiscal |
year, the Director
shall
order transferred and the State |
Treasurer and State Comptroller shall
transfer from the |
Income Tax Refund Fund to the Personal Property Tax
|
Replacement Fund an amount, certified by the Director to |
the Comptroller,
equal to the excess of the amount |
collected pursuant to subsections (c) and
(d) of Section |
201 of this Act deposited into the Income Tax Refund Fund
|
during the fiscal year over the amount of refunds resulting |
from
overpayment of tax liability under subsections (c) and |
(d) of Section 201
of this Act paid from the Income Tax |
|
Refund Fund during the fiscal year.
|
(4) As soon as possible after the end of each fiscal |
year, the Director shall
order transferred and the State |
Treasurer and State Comptroller shall
transfer from the |
Personal Property Tax Replacement Fund to the Income Tax
|
Refund Fund an amount, certified by the Director to the |
Comptroller, equal
to the excess of the amount of refunds |
resulting from overpayment of tax
liability under |
subsections (c) and (d) of Section 201 of this Act paid
|
from the Income Tax Refund Fund during the fiscal year over |
the amount
collected pursuant to subsections (c) and (d) of |
Section 201 of this Act
deposited into the Income Tax |
Refund Fund during the fiscal year.
|
(4.5) As soon as possible after the end of fiscal year |
1999 and of each
fiscal year
thereafter, the Director shall |
order transferred and the State Treasurer and
State |
Comptroller shall transfer from the Income Tax Refund Fund |
to the General
Revenue Fund any surplus remaining in the |
Income Tax Refund Fund as of the end
of such fiscal year; |
excluding for fiscal years 2000, 2001, and 2002
amounts |
attributable to transfers under item (3) of subsection (c) |
less refunds
resulting from the earned income tax credit.
|
(5) This Act shall constitute an irrevocable and |
continuing
appropriation from the Income Tax Refund Fund |
for the purpose of paying
refunds upon the order of the |
Director in accordance with the provisions of
this Section.
|
|
(e) Deposits into the Education Assistance Fund and the |
Income Tax
Surcharge Local Government Distributive Fund.
|
On July 1, 1991, and thereafter, of the amounts collected |
pursuant to
subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of this Act, |
minus deposits into the
Income Tax Refund Fund, the Department |
shall deposit 7.3% into the
Education Assistance Fund in the |
State Treasury. Beginning July 1, 1991,
and continuing through |
January 31, 1993, of the amounts collected pursuant to
|
subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of the Illinois Income |
Tax Act, minus
deposits into the Income Tax Refund Fund, the |
Department shall deposit 3.0%
into the Income Tax Surcharge |
Local Government Distributive Fund in the State
Treasury. |
Beginning February 1, 1993 and continuing through June 30, |
1993, of
the amounts collected pursuant to subsections (a) and |
(b) of Section 201 of the
Illinois Income Tax Act, minus |
deposits into the Income Tax Refund Fund, the
Department shall |
deposit 4.4% into the Income Tax Surcharge Local Government
|
Distributive Fund in the State Treasury. Beginning July 1, |
1993, and
continuing through June 30, 1994, of the amounts |
collected under subsections
(a) and (b) of Section 201 of this |
Act, minus deposits into the Income Tax
Refund Fund, the |
Department shall deposit 1.475% into the Income Tax Surcharge
|
Local Government Distributive Fund in the State Treasury.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-32, eff. 6-20-03; 93-839, eff. 7-30-04; 94-91, |
eff. 7-1-05; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
|
|
(35 ILCS 5/1001) (from Ch. 120, par. 10-1001)
|
Sec. 1001. Failure to File Tax Returns.
|
(a) Failure to file tax return. In case of failure to file |
any
tax return required under this Act on the date prescribed |
therefor,
(determined with regard to any extensions of time for |
filing) there shall
be added as a penalty the amount prescribed |
by Section 3-3 of the Uniform
Penalty and Interest Act.
|
(b) Failure to disclose reportable transaction. Any |
taxpayer who fails to include on any return or statement any |
information with respect to a reportable transaction that is |
required under Section 501(b) of this Act to be included with |
such return or statement shall pay a penalty in the amount |
determined under this subsection who fails to comply with the |
requirements of Section 501(b) of this Act shall pay a penalty |
in the amount determined under this subsection . Such penalty |
shall be deemed assessed upon the date of filing of the return |
for the taxable year in which the taxpayer participates in the |
reportable transaction. A taxpayer shall not be considered to |
have complied with the requirements of Section 501(b) of this |
Act unless the disclosure statement filed with the Department |
includes all of the information required to be disclosed with |
respect to a reportable transaction pursuant to Section 6011 of |
the Internal Revenue Code, the regulations promulgated under |
that statute, Treasury Regulations Section 1.6011-4 (26 CFR |
1.6011-4) and regulations promulgated by the Department under |
Section 501(b) of this Act. |
|
(1) Amount of penalty. Except as provided in paragraph |
(2), the amount of the penalty under this subsection shall |
be $15,000 for each failure to comply with the requirements |
of Section 501(b). |
(2) Increase in penalty for listed transactions. In the |
case of a failure to comply with the requirements of |
Section 501(b) with respect to a "listed transaction", the |
penalty under this subsection shall be $30,000 for each |
failure. |
(3) Authority to rescind penalty. The Department may |
rescind all or any portion of any penalty imposed by this |
subsection with respect to any violation, if any of the |
following apply : |
(A) the violation is with respect to a reportable |
transaction other than a listed transaction, and |
(B) rescinding the penalty would promote |
compliance with the requirements of this Act and |
effective tax administration. |
(A) It is determined that failure to comply did not |
jeopardize the best interests of the State and is not |
due to any willful neglect or any intent not to comply; |
(B) The person on whom the penalty is imposed has a |
history of complying with the requirements of this Act; |
(C) It is shown that the violation is due to an |
unintentional mistake of fact; |
(D) Imposing the penalty would be against equity |
|
and good conscience; |
(E) Rescinding the penalty would promote |
compliance with the requirements of this Act and |
effective tax administration; or |
(F) The taxpayer can show that there was a |
reasonable cause for the failure to disclose and that |
the taxpayer acted in good faith. |
A determination made under this subparagraph (3) may be |
reviewed in any administrative or judicial proceeding. |
(4) Coordination with other penalties. The penalty |
imposed by this subsection is in addition to any penalty |
imposed by this Act or the Uniform Penalty and Interest |
Act. The doubling of penalties and interest authorized by |
the Illinois Tax Delinquency Amnesty Act (P.A. 93-26) are |
not applicable to the reportable penalties under |
subsection (b). |
(c) The total penalty imposed under subsection (b) of this |
Section with respect to any taxable year shall not exceed 10% |
of the increase in net income (or reduction in Illinois net |
loss under Section 207 of this Act) that would result had the |
taxpayer not participated in any reportable transaction |
affecting its net income for such taxable year. |
(Source: P.A. 93-840, eff. 7-30-04.)
|
(35 ILCS 5/1007) |
Sec. 1007. Failure to register tax shelter or maintain |
|
list.
|
(a) Penalty Imposed. Any person that fails to comply with |
the requirements of Section 1405.5 or Section 1405.6 shall |
incur a penalty as provided in subsection (b) this Section . A |
person shall not be in compliance with the requirements of |
Section 1405.5 unless and until the required return |
registration has been filed and that return contains all of the |
information required to be included by the Secretary under |
federal law. with such registration under Section 6111 of the |
Internal Revenue Code or such Section 1405.5. A person shall |
not be in compliance with the requirements of Section 1405.6 |
unless, at the time the required list is made available to the |
Department, such list contains all of the information required |
to be maintained under Section 6112 of the Internal Revenue |
Code or such Section 1405.6. |
(b) Amount of Penalty. The following penalties apply: |
(1) Except as provided in paragraph (2), the penalty |
imposed under subsection (a) with respect to any failure is |
$15,000. In the case of each failure to comply with the |
requirements of subsection (a), subsection (b), or |
subsection (e) of Section 1405.5, the penalty shall be |
$15,000. |
(2) If the failure is with respect to a listed |
transaction under subsection (c) of Section 1405.5, the |
penalty shall be $100,000. |
(3) In the case of each failure to comply with the |
|
requirements of subsection (a) or subsection (b) of Section |
1405.6, the penalty shall be $15,000. |
(4) If the failure is with respect to a listed |
transaction under subsection (c) of Section 1405.6, the |
penalty shall be $100,000. |
(c) Authority to rescind penalty. The Department may |
rescind all or any portion of any penalty imposed by this |
subsection with respect to any violation, if |
(1) the violation is with respect to a reportable |
transaction other than a listed transaction, and |
(2) rescinding the penalty would promote compliance |
with the requirements of this Act and effective tax |
administration. The Director of the Board of Appeals may |
rescind all or any portion of any penalty imposed by this |
Section with respect to any violation, if any of the |
following apply: |
(1) It is determined that failure to comply did not |
jeopardize the best interests of the State and is not due |
to any willful neglect or any intent not to comply; |
(2) The person on whom the penalty is imposed has a |
history of complying with the requirements of this Act; |
(3) It is shown that the violation is due to an |
unintentional mistake of fact; |
(4) Imposing the penalty would be against equity and |
good conscience; |
(5) Rescinding the penalty would promote compliance |
|
with the requirements of this Act and effective tax |
administration; or |
(6) The taxpayer can show that there was reasonable |
cause for the failure to disclose and that the taxpayer |
acted in good faith.
|
(d) Coordination with other penalties. The penalty imposed |
by this Section is in addition to any penalty imposed by this |
Act or the Uniform Penalty and Interest Act.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-840, eff. 7-30-04.) |
(35 ILCS 5/1405.5)
|
Sec. 1405.5. Registration of tax shelters. |
(a) Federal tax shelter. Any material advisor tax shelter |
organizer required to make a return register a tax shelter |
under Section 6111 of the Internal Revenue Code with respect to |
a reportable transaction shall send a duplicate of the return |
federal registration information to the Department not later |
than the day on which the return registration is required to be |
filed under federal law. Any person required to register under |
Section 6111 of the Internal Revenue Code who receives a tax |
registration number from the Secretary of the Treasury shall, |
within 30 days after request by the Department, file a |
statement of that registration number. |
(b) (Blank). Additional requirements for listed |
transactions. In addition to the requirements of subsection |
(a), for any transactions entered into on or after February 28, |
|
2000 that become listed transactions (as defined under Treasury |
Regulations Section 1.6011-4) at any time, those transactions |
shall be registered with the Department (in the form and manner |
prescribed by the Department) by the later of (i) 60 days after |
entering into the transaction, (ii) 60 days after the |
transaction becomes a listed transaction, or (iii) December 31, |
2004. |
(c) Transactions Tax shelters subject to this Section. The |
provisions of this Section apply to any reportable transaction |
having a nexus with this State. For returns that must be filed |
under this Section on or after January 1, 2008, a reportable |
transaction has nexus with this State if, at the time the |
transaction is entered into, the transaction has one or more |
investors that is an Illinois taxpayer. For returns that must |
be filed under this Section prior to January 1, 2008, a tax |
shelter has a nexus with this State if it herein described that |
additionally satisfies any of the following conditions: (1) is |
organized in this State; (2) is doing business in this State; |
or (3) is deriving income from sources in this State. |
(d) (Blank). Tax shelter identification number.
Any person |
required to file a return under this Act and required to |
include on the person's federal tax return a tax shelter |
identification number pursuant to Section 6111 of the Internal |
Revenue Code shall furnish such number upon filing of the |
person's Illinois return.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-840, eff. 7-30-04.) |
|
(35 ILCS 5/1405.6)
|
Sec. 1405.6. Investor lists. |
(a) Federal abusive tax shelter. Any person required to |
maintain a list under Section 6112 of the Internal Revenue Code |
and Treasury Regulations Section 301.6112-1 with respect to a |
potentially abusive tax shelter shall furnish a duplicate of |
such list to the Department not later than the earlier of the |
time such list is required to be furnished to the Internal |
Revenue Service for inspection under Section 6112 of the |
Internal Revenue Code or the date of written request by the |
Department under federal income tax law . |
The list required under this Section shall include the same |
information required with respect to a potentially abusive tax |
shelter under Treasury Regulations Section 301.6112-1 and any |
other information as the Department may require. |
(b) (Blank). Additional requirements for listed |
transactions. For transactions entered into on or after |
February 28, 2000 that become listed transactions (as defined |
under Treasury Regulations Section 1.6011-4) at any time, the |
list shall be furnished to the Department by the later of (i) |
60 days after entering into the transaction, (ii) 60 days after |
the transaction becomes a listed transaction, or (iii) December |
31, 2004. |
(c) Transactions subject to this Section. The provisions of |
this Section apply to any reportable transaction having a nexus |
|
with this State. For lists that must be filed with the |
Department on or after January 1, 2008, a reportable |
transaction has nexus with this State if, at the time the |
transaction is entered into, the transaction has one or more |
investors that is an Illinois taxpayer. For lists that must be |
filed with the Department prior to January 1, 2008, a |
reportable transaction has nexus with this State if, at the |
time the transaction is: (d) Tax Shelters subject to this |
Section. The provisions of this Section apply to any tax |
shelter herein described that additionally satisfies any of the |
following conditions: |
(1) Organized in this State; |
(2) Doing Business in this State; or |
(3) Deriving income from sources in this State.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-840, eff. 7-30-04.)
|
(35 ILCS 5/1501) (from Ch. 120, par. 15-1501)
|
Sec. 1501. Definitions.
|
(a) In general. When used in this Act, where not
otherwise |
distinctly expressed or manifestly incompatible with the |
intent
thereof:
|
(1) Business income. The term "business income" means |
all income that may be treated as apportionable business |
income under the Constitution of the United States. |
Business income is net of the deductions allocable thereto. |
Such term does not include compensation
or the deductions |
|
allocable thereto.
For each taxable year beginning on or |
after January 1, 2003, a taxpayer may
elect to treat all |
income other than compensation as business income. This
|
election shall be made in accordance with rules adopted by |
the Department and,
once made, shall be irrevocable.
|
(1.5) Captive real estate investment trust:
|
(A) The term "captive real estate investment trust" |
means a corporation, trust, or association:
|
(i) that is considered a real estate investment |
trust for the taxable year under Section 856 of the |
Internal Revenue Code;
|
(ii) the certificates of beneficial interest or |
shares of which are that is not regularly traded on an |
established securities market; and |
(iii) of which more than 50% of the voting power or |
value of the beneficial interest or shares, at any time |
during the last half of the taxable year, is owned or |
controlled, directly , or indirectly, or |
constructively, by a single person entity that is |
subject to the provisions of Subchapter C of Chapter 1 |
of the Internal Revenue Code . |
(B) The term "captive real estate investment trust" |
does not include: |
(i) a real estate investment trust corporation, |
trust, or association of which more than 50% of the |
voting power or value of the beneficial interest or |
|
shares is owned or controlled, directly, indirectly, |
or constructively, at any time during which the |
corporation, trust, or association satisfies item |
(A)(iii) of this subsection (1.5), by: |
(a) a real estate investment trust, other than |
a captive real estate investment trust described |
in item (A) of this subsection ; |
(b) a person who is exempt from taxation under |
Section 501 of the Internal Revenue Code , and who |
is not required to treat income received from the |
real estate investment trust as unrelated business |
taxable income under Section 512 of the Internal |
Revenue Code ; |
(c) a listed Australian property trust, if no |
more than 50% of the voting power or value of the |
beneficial interest or shares of that trust, at any |
time during the last half of the taxable year, is |
owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by a |
single person; or |
(d) an entity organized as a trust, provided a |
listed Australian property trust described in |
subparagraph (c) owns or controls, directly or |
indirectly, or constructively, 75% or more of the |
voting power or value of the beneficial interests |
or shares of such entity; or |
(ii) during its first taxable year for which it |
|
elects to be treated as a real estate investment trust |
under Section 856(c)(1) of the Internal Revenue Code, a |
real estate investment trust the certificates of |
beneficial interest or shares of which are not |
regularly traded on an established securities market, |
but only if the certificates of beneficial interest or |
shares of the real estate investment trust are |
regularly traded on an established securities market |
prior to the earlier of the due date (including |
extensions) for filing its return under this Act for |
that first taxable year or the date it actually files |
that return. |
(c) a listed Australian property trust; or |
(d) a real estate investment trust that, |
subject to rules of the Secretary of State, is |
intended to become regularly traded on an |
established securities market and that satisfies |
the requirements of Sections 856(A)(5) and |
856(A)(6) of the Internal Revenue Code by reason of |
Section 856(H)(2) of the Internal Revenue Code. |
(C) For the purposes of this subsection (1.5), the |
constructive ownership rules prescribed under Section |
318(a) 318(A) of the Internal Revenue Code, as modified by |
Section 856(d)(5) 856(D)(5) of the Internal Revenue Code, |
apply in determining the ownership of stock, assets, or net |
profits of any person.
|
|
(2) Commercial domicile. The term "commercial |
domicile" means the
principal
place from which the trade or |
business of the taxpayer is directed or managed.
|
(3) Compensation. The term "compensation" means wages, |
salaries,
commissions
and any other form of remuneration |
paid to employees for personal services.
|
(4) Corporation. The term "corporation" includes |
associations, joint-stock
companies, insurance companies |
and cooperatives. Any entity, including a
limited |
liability company formed under the Illinois Limited |
Liability Company
Act, shall be treated as a corporation if |
it is so classified for federal
income tax purposes.
|
(5) Department. The term "Department" means the |
Department of Revenue of
this State.
|
(6) Director. The term "Director" means the Director of |
Revenue of this
State.
|
(7) Fiduciary. The term "fiduciary" means a guardian, |
trustee, executor,
administrator, receiver, or any person |
acting in any fiduciary capacity for any
person.
|
(8) Financial organization.
|
(A) The term "financial organization" means
any
|
bank, bank holding company, trust company, savings |
bank, industrial bank,
land bank, safe deposit |
company, private banker, savings and loan association,
|
building and loan association, credit union, currency |
exchange, cooperative
bank, small loan company, sales |
|
finance company, investment company, or any
person |
which is owned by a bank or bank holding company. For |
the purpose of
this Section a "person" will include |
only those persons which a bank holding
company may |
acquire and hold an interest in, directly or |
indirectly, under the
provisions of the Bank Holding |
Company Act of 1956 (12 U.S.C. 1841, et seq.),
except |
where interests in any person must be disposed of |
within certain
required time limits under the Bank |
Holding Company Act of 1956.
|
(B) For purposes of subparagraph (A) of this |
paragraph, the term
"bank" includes (i) any entity that |
is regulated by the Comptroller of the
Currency under |
the National Bank Act, or by the Federal Reserve Board, |
or by
the
Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and |
(ii) any federally or State chartered
bank
operating as |
a credit card bank.
|
(C) For purposes of subparagraph (A) of this |
paragraph, the term
"sales finance company" has the |
meaning provided in the following item (i) or
(ii):
|
(i) A person primarily engaged in one or more |
of the following
businesses: the business of |
purchasing customer receivables, the business
of |
making loans upon the security of customer |
receivables, the
business of making loans for the |
express purpose of funding purchases of
tangible |
|
personal property or services by the borrower, or |
the business of
finance leasing. For purposes of |
this item (i), "customer receivable"
means:
|
(a) a retail installment contract or |
retail charge agreement within
the
meaning
of |
the Sales Finance Agency Act, the Retail |
Installment Sales Act, or the
Motor Vehicle |
Retail Installment Sales Act;
|
(b) an installment, charge, credit, or |
similar contract or agreement
arising from
the |
sale of tangible personal property or services |
in a transaction involving
a deferred payment |
price payable in one or more installments |
subsequent
to the sale; or
|
(c) the outstanding balance of a contract |
or agreement described in
provisions
(a) or (b) |
of this item (i).
|
A customer receivable need not provide for |
payment of interest on
deferred
payments. A sales |
finance company may purchase a customer receivable |
from, or
make a loan secured by a customer |
receivable to, the seller in the original
|
transaction or to a person who purchased the |
customer receivable directly or
indirectly from |
that seller.
|
(ii) A corporation meeting each of the |
|
following criteria:
|
(a) the corporation must be a member of an |
"affiliated group" within
the
meaning of |
Section 1504(a) of the Internal Revenue Code, |
determined
without regard to Section 1504(b) |
of the Internal Revenue Code;
|
(b) more than 50% of the gross income of |
the corporation for the
taxable
year
must be |
interest income derived from qualifying loans. |
A "qualifying
loan" is a loan made to a member |
of the corporation's affiliated group that
|
originates customer receivables (within the |
meaning of item (i)) or to whom
customer |
receivables originated by a member of the |
affiliated group have been
transferred, to
the |
extent the average outstanding balance of |
loans from that corporation
to members of its |
affiliated group during the taxable year do not |
exceed
the limitation amount for that |
corporation. The "limitation amount" for a
|
corporation is the average outstanding |
balances during the taxable year of
customer |
receivables (within the meaning of item (i)) |
originated by
all members of the affiliated |
group.
If the average outstanding balances of |
the
loans made by a corporation to members of |
|
its affiliated group exceed the
limitation |
amount, the interest income of that |
corporation from qualifying
loans shall be |
equal to its interest income from loans to |
members of its
affiliated groups times a |
fraction equal to the limitation amount |
divided by
the average outstanding balances of |
the loans made by that corporation to
members |
of its affiliated group;
|
(c) the total of all shareholder's equity |
(including, without
limitation,
paid-in
|
capital on common and preferred stock and |
retained earnings) of the
corporation plus the |
total of all of its loans, advances, and other
|
obligations payable or owed to members of its |
affiliated group may not
exceed 20% of the |
total assets of the corporation at any time |
during the tax
year; and
|
(d) more than 50% of all interest-bearing |
obligations of the
affiliated group payable to |
persons outside the group determined in |
accordance
with generally accepted accounting |
principles must be obligations of the
|
corporation.
|
This amendatory Act of the 91st General Assembly is |
declaratory of
existing
law.
|
|
(D) Subparagraphs
(B) and (C) of this paragraph are |
declaratory of
existing law and apply retroactively, |
for all tax years beginning on or before
December 31, |
1996,
to all original returns, to all amended returns |
filed no later than 30
days after the effective date of |
this amendatory Act of 1996, and to all
notices issued |
on or before the effective date of this amendatory Act |
of 1996
under subsection (a) of Section 903, subsection |
(a) of Section 904,
subsection (e) of Section 909, or |
Section 912.
A taxpayer that is a "financial |
organization" that engages in any transaction
with an |
affiliate shall be a "financial organization" for all |
purposes of this
Act.
|
(E) For all tax years beginning on or
before |
December 31, 1996, a taxpayer that falls within the |
definition
of a
"financial organization" under |
subparagraphs (B) or (C) of this paragraph, but
who |
does
not fall within the definition of a "financial |
organization" under the Proposed
Regulations issued by |
the Department of Revenue on July 19, 1996, may
|
irrevocably elect to apply the Proposed Regulations |
for all of those years as
though the Proposed |
Regulations had been lawfully promulgated, adopted, |
and in
effect for all of those years. For purposes of |
applying subparagraphs (B) or
(C) of
this
paragraph to |
all of those years, the election allowed by this |
|
subparagraph
applies only to the taxpayer making the |
election and to those members of the
taxpayer's unitary |
business group who are ordinarily required to |
apportion
business income under the same subsection of |
Section 304 of this Act as the
taxpayer making the |
election. No election allowed by this subparagraph |
shall
be made under a claim
filed under subsection (d) |
of Section 909 more than 30 days after the
effective |
date of this amendatory Act of 1996.
|
(F) Finance Leases. For purposes of this |
subsection, a finance lease
shall be treated as a loan |
or other extension of credit, rather than as a
lease,
|
regardless of how the transaction is characterized for |
any other purpose,
including the purposes of any |
regulatory agency to which the lessor is subject.
A |
finance lease is any transaction in the form of a lease |
in which the lessee
is treated as the owner of the |
leased asset entitled to any deduction for
|
depreciation allowed under Section 167 of the Internal |
Revenue Code.
|
(9) Fiscal year. The term "fiscal year" means an |
accounting period of
12 months ending on the last day of |
any month other than December.
|
(9.5) Fixed place of business. The term "fixed place of |
business" has the same meaning as that term is given in |
Section 864 of the Internal Revenue Code and the related |
|
Treasury regulations.
|
(10) Includes and including. The terms "includes" and |
"including" when
used in a definition contained in this Act |
shall not be deemed to exclude
other things otherwise |
within the meaning of the term defined.
|
(11) Internal Revenue Code. The term "Internal Revenue |
Code" means the
United States Internal Revenue Code of 1954 |
or any successor law or laws
relating to federal income |
taxes in effect for the taxable year.
|
(11.5) Investment partnership. |
(A) The term "investment partnership" means any |
entity that is treated as a partnership for federal |
income tax purposes that meets the following |
requirements: |
(i) no less than 90% of the partnership's cost |
of its total assets consists of qualifying |
investment securities, deposits at banks or other |
financial institutions, and office space and |
equipment reasonably necessary to carry on its |
activities as an investment partnership; |
(ii) no less than 90% of its gross income |
consists of interest, dividends, and gains from |
the sale or exchange of qualifying investment |
securities; and
|
(iii) the partnership is not a dealer in |
qualifying investment securities. |
|
(B) For purposes of this paragraph (11.5), the term |
"qualifying investment securities" includes all of the |
following:
|
(i) common stock, including preferred or debt |
securities convertible into common stock, and |
preferred stock; |
(ii) bonds, debentures, and other debt |
securities; |
(iii) foreign and domestic currency deposits |
secured by federal, state, or local governmental |
agencies; |
(iv) mortgage or asset-backed securities |
secured by federal, state, or local governmental |
agencies; |
(v) repurchase agreements and loan |
participations; |
(vi) foreign currency exchange contracts and |
forward and futures contracts on foreign |
currencies; |
(vii) stock and bond index securities and |
futures contracts and other similar financial |
securities and futures contracts on those |
securities;
|
(viii) options for the purchase or sale of any |
of the securities, currencies, contracts, or |
financial instruments described in items (i) to |
|
(vii), inclusive;
|
(ix) regulated futures contracts;
|
(x) commodities (not described in Section |
1221(a)(1) of the Internal Revenue Code) or |
futures, forwards, and options with respect to |
such commodities, provided, however, that any item |
of a physical commodity to which title is actually |
acquired in the partnership's capacity as a dealer |
in such commodity shall not be a qualifying |
investment security;
|
(xi) derivatives; and
|
(xii) a partnership interest in another |
partnership that is an investment partnership.
|
(12) Mathematical error. The term "mathematical error" |
includes the
following types of errors, omissions, or |
defects in a return filed by a
taxpayer which prevents |
acceptance of the return as filed for processing:
|
(A) arithmetic errors or incorrect computations on |
the return or
supporting schedules;
|
(B) entries on the wrong lines;
|
(C) omission of required supporting forms or |
schedules or the omission
of the information in whole |
or in part called for thereon; and
|
(D) an attempt to claim, exclude, deduct, or |
improperly report, in a
manner
directly contrary to the |
provisions of the Act and regulations thereunder
any |
|
item of income, exemption, deduction, or credit.
|
(13) Nonbusiness income. The term "nonbusiness income" |
means all income
other than business income or |
compensation.
|
(14) Nonresident. The term "nonresident" means a |
person who is not a
resident.
|
(15) Paid, incurred and accrued. The terms "paid", |
"incurred" and
"accrued"
shall be construed according to |
the method of accounting upon the basis
of which the |
person's base income is computed under this Act.
|
(16) Partnership and partner. The term "partnership" |
includes a syndicate,
group, pool, joint venture or other |
unincorporated organization, through
or by means of which |
any business, financial operation, or venture is carried
|
on, and which is not, within the meaning of this Act, a |
trust or estate
or a corporation; and the term "partner" |
includes a member in such syndicate,
group, pool, joint |
venture or organization.
|
The term "partnership" includes any entity, including |
a limited
liability company formed under the Illinois
|
Limited Liability Company Act, classified as a partnership |
for federal income tax purposes.
|
The term "partnership" does not include a syndicate, |
group, pool,
joint venture, or other unincorporated |
organization established for the
sole purpose of playing |
the Illinois State Lottery.
|
|
(17) Part-year resident. The term "part-year resident" |
means an individual
who became a resident during the |
taxable year or ceased to be a resident
during the taxable |
year. Under Section 1501(a)(20)(A)(i) residence
commences |
with presence in this State for other than a temporary or |
transitory
purpose and ceases with absence from this State |
for other than a temporary or
transitory purpose. Under |
Section 1501(a)(20)(A)(ii) residence commences
with the |
establishment of domicile in this State and ceases with the
|
establishment of domicile in another State.
|
(18) Person. The term "person" shall be construed to |
mean and include
an individual, a trust, estate, |
partnership, association, firm, company,
corporation, |
limited liability company, or fiduciary. For purposes of |
Section
1301 and 1302 of this Act, a "person" means (i) an |
individual, (ii) a
corporation, (iii) an officer, agent, or |
employee of a
corporation, (iv) a member, agent or employee |
of a partnership, or (v)
a member,
manager, employee, |
officer, director, or agent of a limited liability company
|
who in such capacity commits an offense specified in |
Section 1301 and 1302.
|
(18A) Records. The term "records" includes all data |
maintained by the
taxpayer, whether on paper, microfilm, |
microfiche, or any type of
machine-sensible data |
compilation.
|
(19) Regulations. The term "regulations" includes |
|
rules promulgated and
forms prescribed by the Department.
|
(20) Resident. The term "resident" means:
|
(A) an individual (i) who is
in this State for |
other than a temporary or transitory purpose during the
|
taxable year; or (ii) who is domiciled in this State |
but is absent from
the State for a temporary or |
transitory purpose during the taxable year;
|
(B) The estate of a decedent who at his or her |
death was domiciled in
this
State;
|
(C) A trust created by a will of a decedent who at |
his death was
domiciled
in this State; and
|
(D) An irrevocable trust, the grantor of which was |
domiciled in this
State
at the time such trust became |
irrevocable. For purpose of this subparagraph,
a trust |
shall be considered irrevocable to the extent that the |
grantor is
not treated as the owner thereof under |
Sections 671 through 678 of the Internal
Revenue Code.
|
(21) Sales. The term "sales" means all gross receipts |
of the taxpayer
not allocated under Sections 301, 302 and |
303.
|
(22) State. The term "state" when applied to a |
jurisdiction other than
this State means any state of the |
United States, the District of Columbia,
the Commonwealth |
of Puerto Rico, any Territory or Possession of the United
|
States, and any foreign country, or any political |
subdivision of any of the
foregoing. For purposes of the |
|
foreign tax credit under Section 601, the
term "state" |
means any state of the United States, the District of |
Columbia,
the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico, and any |
territory or possession of the
United States, or any |
political subdivision of any of the foregoing,
effective |
for tax years ending on or after December 31, 1989.
|
(23) Taxable year. The term "taxable year" means the |
calendar year, or
the fiscal year ending during such |
calendar year, upon the basis of which
the base income is |
computed under this Act. "Taxable year" means, in the
case |
of a return made for a fractional part of a year under the |
provisions
of this Act, the period for which such return is |
made.
|
(24) Taxpayer. The term "taxpayer" means any person |
subject to the tax
imposed by this Act.
|
(25) International banking facility. The term |
international banking
facility shall have the same meaning |
as is set forth in the Illinois Banking
Act or as is set |
forth in the laws of the United States or regulations of
|
the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System.
|
(26) Income Tax Return Preparer.
|
(A) The term "income tax return preparer"
means any |
person who prepares for compensation, or who employs |
one or more
persons to prepare for compensation, any |
return of tax imposed by this Act
or any claim for |
refund of tax imposed by this Act. The preparation of a
|
|
substantial portion of a return or claim for refund |
shall be treated as
the preparation of that return or |
claim for refund.
|
(B) A person is not an income tax return preparer |
if all he or she does
is
|
(i) furnish typing, reproducing, or other |
mechanical assistance;
|
(ii) prepare returns or claims for refunds for |
the employer by whom he
or she is regularly and |
continuously employed;
|
(iii) prepare as a fiduciary returns or claims |
for refunds for any
person; or
|
(iv) prepare claims for refunds for a taxpayer |
in response to any
notice
of deficiency issued to |
that taxpayer or in response to any waiver of
|
restriction after the commencement of an audit of |
that taxpayer or of another
taxpayer if a |
determination in the audit of the other taxpayer |
directly or
indirectly affects the tax liability |
of the taxpayer whose claims he or she is
|
preparing.
|
(27) Unitary business group. The term "unitary |
business group" means
a group of persons related through |
common ownership whose business activities
are integrated |
with, dependent upon and contribute to each other. The |
group
will not include those members whose business |
|
activity outside the United
States is 80% or more of any |
such member's total business activity; for
purposes of this |
paragraph and clause (a)(3)(B)(ii) of Section 304,
|
business
activity within the United States shall be |
measured by means of the factors
ordinarily applicable |
under subsections (a), (b), (c), (d), or (h)
of Section
304 |
except that, in the case of members ordinarily required to |
apportion
business income by means of the 3 factor formula |
of property, payroll and sales
specified in subsection (a) |
of Section 304, including the
formula as weighted in |
subsection (h) of Section 304, such members shall
not use |
the sales factor in the computation and the results of the |
property
and payroll factor computations of subsection (a) |
of Section 304 shall be
divided by 2 (by one if either
the |
property or payroll factor has a denominator of zero). The |
computation
required by the preceding sentence shall, in |
each case, involve the division of
the member's property, |
payroll, or revenue miles in the United States,
insurance |
premiums on property or risk in the United States, or |
financial
organization business income from sources within |
the United States, as the
case may be, by the respective |
worldwide figures for such items. Common
ownership in the |
case of corporations is the direct or indirect control or
|
ownership of more than 50% of the outstanding voting stock |
of the persons
carrying on unitary business activity. |
Unitary business activity can
ordinarily be illustrated |
|
where the activities of the members are: (1) in the
same |
general line (such as manufacturing, wholesaling, |
retailing of tangible
personal property, insurance, |
transportation or finance); or (2) are steps in a
|
vertically structured enterprise or process (such as the |
steps involved in the
production of natural resources, |
which might include exploration, mining,
refining, and |
marketing); and, in either instance, the members are |
functionally
integrated through the exercise of strong |
centralized management (where, for
example, authority over |
such matters as purchasing, financing, tax compliance,
|
product line, personnel, marketing and capital investment |
is not left to each
member).
In no event, however, will any
|
unitary business group include members
which are |
ordinarily required to apportion business income under |
different
subsections of Section 304 except that for tax |
years ending on or after
December 31, 1987 this prohibition |
shall not apply to a unitary business group
composed of one |
or more taxpayers all of which apportion business income
|
pursuant to subsection (b) of Section 304, or all of which |
apportion business
income pursuant to subsection (d) of |
Section 304, and a holding company of such
single-factor |
taxpayers (see definition of "financial organization" for |
rule
regarding holding companies of financial |
organizations). If a unitary business
group would, but for |
the preceding sentence, include members that are
|
|
ordinarily required to apportion business income under |
different subsections of
Section 304, then for each |
subsection of Section 304 for which there are two or
more |
members, there shall be a separate unitary business group |
composed of such
members. For purposes of the preceding two |
sentences, a member is "ordinarily
required to apportion |
business income" under a particular subsection of Section
|
304 if it would be required to use the apportionment method |
prescribed by such
subsection except for the fact that it |
derives business income solely from
Illinois. As used in |
this paragraph, the phrase "United States" means only the |
50 states and the District of Columbia, but does not |
include any territory or possession of the United States or |
any area over which the United States has asserted |
jurisdiction or claimed exclusive rights with respect to |
the exploration for or exploitation of natural resources.
|
If the unitary business group members' accounting |
periods differ,
the common parent's accounting period or, |
if there is no common parent, the
accounting period of the |
member that is expected to have, on a recurring basis,
the |
greatest Illinois income tax liability must be used to |
determine whether to
use the apportionment method provided |
in subsection (a) or subsection (h) of
Section 304. The
|
prohibition against membership in a unitary business group |
for taxpayers
ordinarily required to apportion income |
under different subsections of Section
304 does not apply |
|
to taxpayers required to apportion income under subsection
|
(a) and subsection (h) of Section
304. The provisions of |
this amendatory Act of 1998 apply to tax
years ending on or |
after December 31, 1998.
|
(28) Subchapter S corporation. The term "Subchapter S |
corporation"
means a corporation for which there is in |
effect an election under Section
1362 of the Internal |
Revenue Code, or for which there is a federal election
to |
opt out of the provisions of the Subchapter S Revision Act |
of 1982 and
have applied instead the prior federal |
Subchapter S rules as in effect on July
1, 1982.
|
(30) Foreign person. The term "foreign person" means |
any person who is a nonresident alien individual and any |
nonindividual entity, regardless of where created or |
organized, whose business activity outside the United |
States is 80% or more of the entity's total business |
activity.
|
(b) Other definitions.
|
(1) Words denoting number, gender, and so forth,
when |
used in this Act, where not otherwise distinctly expressed |
or manifestly
incompatible with the intent thereof:
|
(A) Words importing the singular include and apply |
to several persons,
parties or things;
|
(B) Words importing the plural include the |
singular; and
|
|
(C) Words importing the masculine gender include |
the feminine as well.
|
(2) "Company" or "association" as including successors |
and assigns. The
word "company" or "association", when used |
in reference to a corporation,
shall be deemed to embrace |
the words "successors and assigns of such company
or |
association", and in like manner as if these last-named |
words, or words
of similar import, were expressed.
|
(3) Other terms. Any term used in any Section of this |
Act with respect
to the application of, or in connection |
with, the provisions of any other
Section of this Act shall |
have the same meaning as in such other Section.
|
(Source: P.A. 95-233, eff. 8-16-07.)
|
Section 5-16. The Use Tax Act is amended by changing |
Section 3-50 as follows:
|
(35 ILCS 105/3-50) (from Ch. 120, par. 439.3-50)
|
Sec. 3-50. Manufacturing and assembly exemption. The |
manufacturing
and assembling machinery and equipment exemption |
includes
machinery and equipment that replaces machinery and |
equipment in an
existing manufacturing facility as well as |
machinery and equipment that
are for use in an expanded or new |
manufacturing facility. The machinery and
equipment exemption |
also includes machinery and equipment used in the
general |
maintenance or repair of exempt machinery and equipment or for
|
|
in-house manufacture of exempt machinery and equipment. For the
|
purposes of this exemption, terms have the following
meanings:
|
(1) "Manufacturing process" means the production of
an |
article of tangible personal property, whether the article
|
is a finished product or an article for use in the process |
of manufacturing
or assembling a different article of |
tangible personal property, by
a procedure commonly |
regarded as manufacturing, processing, fabricating, or
|
refining that changes some existing material into a |
material
with a different form, use, or name. In relation |
to a recognized integrated
business composed of a series of |
operations that collectively constitute
manufacturing, or |
individually constitute
manufacturing operations, the |
manufacturing process commences with the
first operation |
or stage of production in the series
and does not end until |
the completion of the final product
in the last operation |
or stage of production in the series. For purposes
of this |
exemption, photoprocessing is a
manufacturing process of |
tangible personal property for wholesale or retail
sale.
|
(2) "Assembling process" means the production of
an |
article of tangible personal property, whether the article
|
is a finished product or an article for use in the process |
of manufacturing
or assembling a different article of |
tangible personal property, by the
combination of existing |
materials in a manner commonly regarded as
assembling that |
results in an article or material of a different
form, use, |
|
or name.
|
(3) "Machinery" means major
mechanical machines or |
major components of those machines contributing to a
|
manufacturing or assembling process.
|
(4) "Equipment" includes an independent device
or tool |
separate from machinery but essential to an integrated
|
manufacturing or assembly process; including computers |
used primarily in
a manufacturer's computer assisted |
design,
computer assisted manufacturing (CAD/CAM) system; |
any
subunit or assembly comprising a component of any |
machinery or auxiliary,
adjunct, or attachment parts of |
machinery, such as tools, dies, jigs,
fixtures, patterns, |
and molds; and any parts that require
periodic replacement |
in the course of normal operation; but does not
include |
hand tools. Equipment includes chemicals or chemicals |
acting as
catalysts but only if
the chemicals or chemicals |
acting as catalysts effect a direct and
immediate change |
upon a
product being manufactured or assembled for |
wholesale or retail sale or
lease. |
(5) "Production related tangible personal property" |
means all tangible personal property that is used or |
consumed by the purchaser in a manufacturing facility in |
which a manufacturing process takes place and includes, |
without limitation, tangible personal property that is |
purchased for incorporation into real estate within a |
manufacturing facility and tangible personal property that |
|
is used or consumed in activities such as research and |
development, preproduction material handling, receiving, |
quality control, inventory control, storage, staging, and |
packaging for shipping and transportation purposes. |
"Production related tangible personal property" does not |
include (i) tangible personal property that is used, within |
or without a manufacturing facility, in sales, purchasing, |
accounting, fiscal management, marketing, personnel |
recruitment or selection, or landscaping or (ii) tangible |
personal property that is required to be titled or |
registered with a department, agency, or unit of federal, |
State, or local government.
|
The manufacturing and assembling machinery and equipment |
exemption includes production related tangible personal |
property that is purchased on or after July 1, 2007 and on or |
before June 30, 2008. The exemption for production related |
tangible personal property is subject to both of the following |
limitations: |
(1) The maximum amount of the exemption for any one |
taxpayer may not exceed 5% of the purchase price of |
production related tangible personal property that is |
purchased on or after July 1, 2007 and on or before June |
30, 2008. A credit under Section 3-85 of this Act may not |
be earned by the purchase of production related tangible |
personal property for which an exemption is received under |
this Section. |
|
(2) The maximum aggregate amount of the exemptions for |
production related tangible personal property awarded |
under this Act and the Retailers' Occupation Tax Act to all |
taxpayers may not exceed $10,000,000. If the claims for the |
exemption exceed $10,000,000, then the Department shall |
reduce the amount of the exemption to each taxpayer on a |
pro rata basis. |
The Department may adopt rules to implement and administer the |
exemption for production related tangible personal property. |
The manufacturing and assembling machinery and equipment
|
exemption includes the sale of materials to a purchaser who
|
produces exempted types of machinery, equipment, or tools and |
who rents or
leases that machinery, equipment, or tools to a
|
manufacturer of tangible
personal property. This exemption |
also includes the sale of materials to a
purchaser who |
manufactures those materials into an exempted type of
|
machinery, equipment, or tools that the purchaser uses
himself |
or herself in the
manufacturing of tangible personal property. |
This exemption includes the
sale of exempted types of machinery |
or equipment to a
purchaser who is not the manufacturer, but |
who rents or leases the use of
the property to a manufacturer. |
The purchaser of the machinery and
equipment who has an active |
resale registration number shall
furnish that number to the |
seller at the time of purchase.
A user of the machinery, |
equipment, or tools without an
active resale registration |
number shall prepare a certificate of exemption
for each |
|
transaction stating facts establishing the exemption for that
|
transaction, and that certificate shall be
available to the |
Department for inspection or audit. The Department shall
|
prescribe the form of the certificate. Informal rulings, |
opinions, or
letters issued by the Department in
response to an |
inquiry or request for an opinion from any person
regarding the |
coverage and applicability of this exemption to specific
|
devices shall be published, maintained as a public record, and |
made
available for public inspection and copying. If the |
informal ruling,
opinion, or letter contains trade secrets or |
other confidential
information, where possible, the Department |
shall delete that information
before publication. Whenever |
informal rulings, opinions, or
letters contain a policy of |
general applicability, the Department
shall formulate and |
adopt that policy as a rule in accordance with the
Illinois |
Administrative Procedure Act.
|
(Source: P.A. 91-51, eff. 6-30-99; 92-484, eff. 8-23-01.)
|
Section 5-17. The Retailers' Occupation Tax Act is amended |
by changing Sections 2-5 and 2-45 as follows:
|
(35 ILCS 120/2-5) (from Ch. 120, par. 441-5)
|
Sec. 2-5. Exemptions. Gross receipts from proceeds from the |
sale of
the following tangible personal property are exempt |
from the tax imposed
by this Act:
|
(1) Farm chemicals.
|
|
(2) Farm machinery and equipment, both new and used, |
including that
manufactured on special order, certified by the |
purchaser to be used
primarily for production agriculture or |
State or federal agricultural
programs, including individual |
replacement parts for the machinery and
equipment, including |
machinery and equipment purchased for lease,
and including |
implements of husbandry defined in Section 1-130 of
the |
Illinois Vehicle Code, farm machinery and agricultural |
chemical and
fertilizer spreaders, and nurse wagons required to |
be registered
under Section 3-809 of the Illinois Vehicle Code,
|
but
excluding other motor vehicles required to be registered |
under the Illinois
Vehicle Code.
Horticultural polyhouses or |
hoop houses used for propagating, growing, or
overwintering |
plants shall be considered farm machinery and equipment under
|
this item (2).
Agricultural chemical tender tanks and dry boxes |
shall include units sold
separately from a motor vehicle |
required to be licensed and units sold mounted
on a motor |
vehicle required to be licensed, if the selling price of the |
tender
is separately stated.
|
Farm machinery and equipment shall include precision |
farming equipment
that is
installed or purchased to be |
installed on farm machinery and equipment
including, but not |
limited to, tractors, harvesters, sprayers, planters,
seeders, |
or spreaders.
Precision farming equipment includes, but is not |
limited to,
soil testing sensors, computers, monitors, |
software, global positioning
and mapping systems, and other |
|
such equipment.
|
Farm machinery and equipment also includes computers, |
sensors, software, and
related equipment used primarily in the
|
computer-assisted operation of production agriculture |
facilities, equipment,
and activities such as, but
not limited |
to,
the collection, monitoring, and correlation of
animal and |
crop data for the purpose of
formulating animal diets and |
agricultural chemicals. This item (7) is exempt
from the |
provisions of
Section 2-70.
|
(3) Until July 1, 2003, distillation machinery and |
equipment, sold as a
unit or kit,
assembled or installed by the |
retailer, certified by the user to be used
only for the |
production of ethyl alcohol that will be used for consumption
|
as motor fuel or as a component of motor fuel for the personal |
use of the
user, and not subject to sale or resale.
|
(4) Until July 1, 2003 and beginning again September 1, |
2004, graphic arts machinery and equipment, including
repair |
and
replacement parts, both new and used, and including that |
manufactured on
special order or purchased for lease, certified |
by the purchaser to be used
primarily for graphic arts |
production.
Equipment includes chemicals or
chemicals acting |
as catalysts but only if
the chemicals or chemicals acting as |
catalysts effect a direct and immediate
change upon a
graphic |
arts product.
|
(5) A motor vehicle of the first division, a motor vehicle |
of the second division that is a self contained motor vehicle |
|
designed or permanently converted to provide living quarters |
for recreational, camping, or travel use, with direct walk |
through access to the living quarters from the driver's seat, |
or a motor vehicle of the second division that is of the van |
configuration designed for the transportation of not less than |
7 nor more than 16 passengers, as defined in Section 1-146 of |
the Illinois Vehicle Code, that is used for automobile renting, |
as defined in the Automobile Renting Occupation and Use Tax |
Act. This paragraph is exempt from
the provisions of Section |
2-70. (Blank).
|
(6) Personal property sold by a teacher-sponsored student |
organization
affiliated with an elementary or secondary school |
located in Illinois.
|
(7) Until July 1, 2003, proceeds of that portion of the |
selling price of
a passenger car the
sale of which is subject |
to the Replacement Vehicle Tax.
|
(8) Personal property sold to an Illinois county fair |
association for
use in conducting, operating, or promoting the |
county fair.
|
(9) Personal property sold to a not-for-profit arts
or |
cultural organization that establishes, by proof required by |
the Department
by
rule, that it has received an exemption under |
Section 501(c)(3) of the
Internal Revenue Code and that is |
organized and operated primarily for the
presentation
or |
support of arts or cultural programming, activities, or |
services. These
organizations include, but are not limited to, |
|
music and dramatic arts
organizations such as symphony |
orchestras and theatrical groups, arts and
cultural service |
organizations, local arts councils, visual arts organizations,
|
and media arts organizations.
On and after the effective date |
of this amendatory Act of the 92nd General
Assembly, however, |
an entity otherwise eligible for this exemption shall not
make |
tax-free purchases unless it has an active identification |
number issued by
the Department.
|
(10) Personal property sold by a corporation, society, |
association,
foundation, institution, or organization, other |
than a limited liability
company, that is organized and |
operated as a not-for-profit service enterprise
for the benefit |
of persons 65 years of age or older if the personal property
|
was not purchased by the enterprise for the purpose of resale |
by the
enterprise.
|
(11) Personal property sold to a governmental body, to a |
corporation,
society, association, foundation, or institution |
organized and operated
exclusively for charitable, religious, |
or educational purposes, or to a
not-for-profit corporation, |
society, association, foundation, institution,
or organization |
that has no compensated officers or employees and that is
|
organized and operated primarily for the recreation of persons |
55 years of
age or older. A limited liability company may |
qualify for the exemption under
this paragraph only if the |
limited liability company is organized and operated
|
exclusively for educational purposes. On and after July 1, |
|
1987, however, no
entity otherwise eligible for this exemption |
shall make tax-free purchases
unless it has an active |
identification number issued by the Department.
|
(12) Tangible personal property sold to
interstate |
carriers
for hire for use as
rolling stock moving in interstate |
commerce or to lessors under leases of
one year or longer |
executed or in effect at the time of purchase by
interstate |
carriers for hire for use as rolling stock moving in interstate
|
commerce and equipment operated by a telecommunications |
provider, licensed as a
common carrier by the Federal |
Communications Commission, which is permanently
installed in |
or affixed to aircraft moving in interstate commerce.
|
(12-5) On and after July 1, 2003 and through June 30, 2004, |
motor vehicles of the second division
with a gross vehicle |
weight in excess of 8,000 pounds
that
are
subject to the |
commercial distribution fee imposed under Section 3-815.1 of
|
the Illinois
Vehicle Code. Beginning on July 1, 2004 and |
through June 30, 2005, the use in this State of motor vehicles |
of the second division: (i) with a gross vehicle weight rating |
in excess of 8,000 pounds; (ii) that are subject to the |
commercial distribution fee imposed under Section 3-815.1 of |
the Illinois Vehicle Code; and (iii) that are primarily used |
for commercial purposes. Through June 30, 2005, this
exemption |
applies to repair and replacement parts added
after the
initial |
purchase of such a motor vehicle if that motor vehicle is used |
in a
manner that
would qualify for the rolling stock exemption |
|
otherwise provided for in this
Act. For purposes of this |
paragraph, "used for commercial purposes" means the |
transportation of persons or property in furtherance of any |
commercial or industrial enterprise whether for-hire or not.
|
(13) Proceeds from sales to owners, lessors, or
shippers of
|
tangible personal property that is utilized by interstate |
carriers for
hire for use as rolling stock moving in interstate |
commerce
and equipment operated by a telecommunications |
provider, licensed as a
common carrier by the Federal |
Communications Commission, which is
permanently installed in |
or affixed to aircraft moving in interstate commerce.
|
(14) Machinery and equipment that will be used by the |
purchaser, or a
lessee of the purchaser, primarily in the |
process of manufacturing or
assembling tangible personal |
property for wholesale or retail sale or
lease, whether the |
sale or lease is made directly by the manufacturer or by
some |
other person, whether the materials used in the process are |
owned by
the manufacturer or some other person, or whether the |
sale or lease is made
apart from or as an incident to the |
seller's engaging in the service
occupation of producing |
machines, tools, dies, jigs, patterns, gauges, or
other similar |
items of no commercial value on special order for a particular
|
purchaser.
|
(15) Proceeds of mandatory service charges separately |
stated on
customers' bills for purchase and consumption of food |
and beverages, to the
extent that the proceeds of the service |
|
charge are in fact turned over as
tips or as a substitute for |
tips to the employees who participate directly
in preparing, |
serving, hosting or cleaning up the food or beverage function
|
with respect to which the service charge is imposed.
|
(16) Petroleum products sold to a purchaser if the seller
|
is prohibited by federal law from charging tax to the |
purchaser.
|
(17) Tangible personal property sold to a common carrier by |
rail or
motor that
receives the physical possession of the |
property in Illinois and that
transports the property, or |
shares with another common carrier in the
transportation of the |
property, out of Illinois on a standard uniform bill
of lading |
showing the seller of the property as the shipper or consignor |
of
the property to a destination outside Illinois, for use |
outside Illinois.
|
(18) Legal tender, currency, medallions, or gold or silver |
coinage
issued by the State of Illinois, the government of the |
United States of
America, or the government of any foreign |
country, and bullion.
|
(19) Until July 1 2003, oil field exploration, drilling, |
and production
equipment, including
(i) rigs and parts of rigs, |
rotary rigs, cable tool
rigs, and workover rigs, (ii) pipe and |
tubular goods, including casing and
drill strings, (iii) pumps |
and pump-jack units, (iv) storage tanks and flow
lines, (v) any |
individual replacement part for oil field exploration,
|
drilling, and production equipment, and (vi) machinery and |
|
equipment purchased
for lease; but
excluding motor vehicles |
required to be registered under the Illinois
Vehicle Code.
|
(20) Photoprocessing machinery and equipment, including |
repair and
replacement parts, both new and used, including that |
manufactured on
special order, certified by the purchaser to be |
used primarily for
photoprocessing, and including |
photoprocessing machinery and equipment
purchased for lease.
|
(21) Until July 1, 2003, coal exploration, mining, |
offhighway hauling,
processing,
maintenance, and reclamation |
equipment, including
replacement parts and equipment, and |
including
equipment purchased for lease, but excluding motor |
vehicles required to be
registered under the Illinois Vehicle |
Code.
|
(22) Fuel and petroleum products sold to or used by an air |
carrier,
certified by the carrier to be used for consumption, |
shipment, or storage
in the conduct of its business as an air |
common carrier, for a flight
destined for or returning from a |
location or locations
outside the United States without regard |
to previous or subsequent domestic
stopovers.
|
(23) A transaction in which the purchase order is received |
by a florist
who is located outside Illinois, but who has a |
florist located in Illinois
deliver the property to the |
purchaser or the purchaser's donee in Illinois.
|
(24) Fuel consumed or used in the operation of ships, |
barges, or vessels
that are used primarily in or for the |
transportation of property or the
conveyance of persons for |
|
hire on rivers bordering on this State if the
fuel is delivered |
by the seller to the purchaser's barge, ship, or vessel
while |
it is afloat upon that bordering river.
|
(25) Except as provided in item (25-5) of this Section, a
|
motor vehicle sold in this State to a nonresident even though |
the
motor vehicle is delivered to the nonresident in this |
State, if the motor
vehicle is not to be titled in this State, |
and if a drive-away permit
is issued to the motor vehicle as |
provided in Section 3-603 of the Illinois
Vehicle Code or if |
the nonresident purchaser has vehicle registration
plates to |
transfer to the motor vehicle upon returning to his or her home
|
state. The issuance of the drive-away permit or having
the
|
out-of-state registration plates to be transferred is prima |
facie evidence
that the motor vehicle will not be titled in |
this State.
|
(25-5) The exemption under item (25) does not apply if the |
state in which the motor vehicle will be titled does not allow |
a reciprocal exemption for a motor vehicle sold and delivered |
in that state to an Illinois resident but titled in Illinois. |
The tax collected under this Act on the sale of a motor vehicle |
in this State to a resident of another state that does not |
allow a reciprocal exemption shall be imposed at a rate equal |
to the state's rate of tax on taxable property in the state in |
which the purchaser is a resident, except that the tax shall |
not exceed the tax that would otherwise be imposed under this |
Act. At the time of the sale, the purchaser shall execute a |
|
statement, signed under penalty of perjury, of his or her |
intent to title the vehicle in the state in which the purchaser |
is a resident within 30 days after the sale and of the fact of |
the payment to the State of Illinois of tax in an amount |
equivalent to the state's rate of tax on taxable property in |
his or her state of residence and shall submit the statement to |
the appropriate tax collection agency in his or her state of |
residence. In addition, the retailer must retain a signed copy |
of the statement in his or her records. Nothing in this item |
shall be construed to require the removal of the vehicle from |
this state following the filing of an intent to title the |
vehicle in the purchaser's state of residence if the purchaser |
titles the vehicle in his or her state of residence within 30 |
days after the date of sale. The tax collected under this Act |
in accordance with this item (25-5) shall be proportionately |
distributed as if the tax were collected at the 6.25% general |
rate imposed under this Act.
|
(25-7) Beginning on July 1, 2007, no tax is imposed under |
this Act on the sale of an aircraft, as defined in Section 3 of |
the Illinois Aeronautics Act, if all of the following |
conditions are met: |
(1) the aircraft leaves this State within 15 days after |
the later of either the issuance of the final billing for |
the sale of the aircraft, or the authorized approval for |
return to service, completion of the maintenance record |
entry, and completion of the test flight and ground test |
|
for inspection, as required by 14 C.F.R. 91.407; |
(2) the aircraft is not based or registered in this |
State after the sale of the aircraft; and |
(3) the seller retains in his or her books and records |
and provides to the Department a signed and dated |
certification from the purchaser, on a form prescribed by |
the Department, certifying that the requirements of this |
item (25-7) are met. The certificate must also include the |
name and address of the purchaser, the address of the |
location where the aircraft is to be titled or registered, |
the address of the primary physical location of the |
aircraft, and other information that the Department may |
reasonably require. |
For purposes of this item (25-7): |
"Based in this State" means hangared, stored, or otherwise |
used, excluding post-sale customizations as defined in this |
Section, for 10 or more days in each 12-month period |
immediately following the date of the sale of the aircraft. |
"Registered in this State" means an aircraft registered |
with the Department of Transportation, Aeronautics Division, |
or titled or registered with the Federal Aviation |
Administration to an address located in this State. |
This paragraph (25-7) is exempt from the provisions
of
|
Section 2-70.
|
(26) Semen used for artificial insemination of livestock |
for direct
agricultural production.
|
|
(27) Horses, or interests in horses, registered with and |
meeting the
requirements of any of the
Arabian Horse Club |
Registry of America, Appaloosa Horse Club, American Quarter
|
Horse Association, United States
Trotting Association, or |
Jockey Club, as appropriate, used for
purposes of breeding or |
racing for prizes. This item (27) is exempt from the provisions |
of Section 2-70, and the exemption provided for under this item |
(27) applies for all periods beginning May 30, 1995, but no |
claim for credit or refund is allowed on or after January 1, |
2008 ( the effective date of Public Act 95-88)
this amendatory |
Act of the 95th General Assembly for such taxes paid during the |
period beginning May 30, 2000 and ending on January 1, 2008 |
( the effective date of Public Act 95-88)
this amendatory Act of |
the 95th General Assembly .
|
(28) Computers and communications equipment utilized for |
any
hospital
purpose
and equipment used in the diagnosis,
|
analysis, or treatment of hospital patients sold to a lessor |
who leases the
equipment, under a lease of one year or longer |
executed or in effect at the
time of the purchase, to a
|
hospital
that has been issued an active tax exemption |
identification number by the
Department under Section 1g of |
this Act.
|
(29) Personal property sold to a lessor who leases the
|
property, under a
lease of one year or longer executed or in |
effect at the time of the purchase,
to a governmental body
that |
has been issued an active tax exemption identification number |
|
by the
Department under Section 1g of this Act.
|
(30) Beginning with taxable years ending on or after |
December
31, 1995
and
ending with taxable years ending on or |
before December 31, 2004,
personal property that is
donated for |
disaster relief to be used in a State or federally declared
|
disaster area in Illinois or bordering Illinois by a |
manufacturer or retailer
that is registered in this State to a |
corporation, society, association,
foundation, or institution |
that has been issued a sales tax exemption
identification |
number by the Department that assists victims of the disaster
|
who reside within the declared disaster area.
|
(31) Beginning with taxable years ending on or after |
December
31, 1995 and
ending with taxable years ending on or |
before December 31, 2004, personal
property that is used in the |
performance of infrastructure repairs in this
State, including |
but not limited to municipal roads and streets, access roads,
|
bridges, sidewalks, waste disposal systems, water and sewer |
line extensions,
water distribution and purification |
facilities, storm water drainage and
retention facilities, and |
sewage treatment facilities, resulting from a State
or |
federally declared disaster in Illinois or bordering Illinois |
when such
repairs are initiated on facilities located in the |
declared disaster area
within 6 months after the disaster.
|
(32) Beginning July 1, 1999, game or game birds sold at a |
"game breeding
and
hunting preserve area" or an "exotic game |
hunting area" as those terms are used
in the
Wildlife Code or |
|
at a hunting enclosure approved through rules adopted by the
|
Department of Natural Resources. This paragraph is exempt from |
the provisions
of
Section 2-70.
|
(33) A motor vehicle, as that term is defined in Section |
1-146
of the
Illinois Vehicle Code, that is donated to a |
corporation, limited liability
company, society, association, |
foundation, or institution that is determined by
the Department |
to be organized and operated exclusively for educational
|
purposes. For purposes of this exemption, "a corporation, |
limited liability
company, society, association, foundation, |
or institution organized and
operated
exclusively for |
educational purposes" means all tax-supported public schools,
|
private schools that offer systematic instruction in useful |
branches of
learning by methods common to public schools and |
that compare favorably in
their scope and intensity with the |
course of study presented in tax-supported
schools, and |
vocational or technical schools or institutes organized and
|
operated exclusively to provide a course of study of not less |
than 6 weeks
duration and designed to prepare individuals to |
follow a trade or to pursue a
manual, technical, mechanical, |
industrial, business, or commercial
occupation.
|
(34) Beginning January 1, 2000, personal property, |
including food, purchased
through fundraising events for the |
benefit of a public or private elementary or
secondary school, |
a group of those schools, or one or more school districts if
|
the events are sponsored by an entity recognized by the school |
|
district that
consists primarily of volunteers and includes |
parents and teachers of the
school children. This paragraph |
does not apply to fundraising events (i) for
the benefit of |
private home instruction or (ii) for which the fundraising
|
entity purchases the personal property sold at the events from |
another
individual or entity that sold the property for the |
purpose of resale by the
fundraising entity and that profits |
from the sale to the fundraising entity.
This paragraph is |
exempt from the provisions of Section 2-70.
|
(35) Beginning January 1, 2000 and through December 31, |
2001, new or used
automatic vending machines that prepare and |
serve hot food and beverages,
including coffee, soup, and other |
items, and replacement parts for these
machines. Beginning |
January 1, 2002 and through June 30, 2003, machines
and parts |
for machines used in
commercial, coin-operated amusement and |
vending business if a use or occupation
tax is paid on the |
gross receipts derived from the use of the commercial,
|
coin-operated amusement and vending machines. This paragraph |
is exempt from
the provisions of Section 2-70.
|
(35-5) Beginning August 23, 2001 and through June 30, 2011, |
food for human consumption that is to be consumed off
the |
premises where it is sold (other than alcoholic beverages, soft |
drinks,
and food that has been prepared for immediate |
consumption) and prescription
and nonprescription medicines, |
drugs, medical appliances, and insulin, urine
testing |
materials, syringes, and needles used by diabetics, for human |
|
use, when
purchased for use by a person receiving medical |
assistance under Article 5 of
the Illinois Public Aid Code who |
resides in a licensed long-term care facility,
as defined in |
the Nursing Home Care Act.
|
(36) Beginning August 2, 2001, computers and |
communications equipment
utilized for any hospital purpose and |
equipment used in the diagnosis,
analysis, or treatment of |
hospital patients sold to a lessor who leases the
equipment, |
under a lease of one year or longer executed or in effect at |
the
time of the purchase, to a hospital that has been issued an |
active tax
exemption identification number by the Department |
under Section 1g of this Act.
This paragraph is exempt from the |
provisions of Section 2-70.
|
(37) Beginning August 2, 2001, personal property sold to a |
lessor who
leases the property, under a lease of one year or |
longer executed or in effect
at the time of the purchase, to a |
governmental body that has been issued an
active tax exemption |
identification number by the Department under Section 1g
of |
this Act. This paragraph is exempt from the provisions of |
Section 2-70.
|
(38) Beginning on January 1, 2002 and through June 30, |
2011, tangible personal property purchased
from an Illinois |
retailer by a taxpayer engaged in centralized purchasing
|
activities in Illinois who will, upon receipt of the property |
in Illinois,
temporarily store the property in Illinois (i) for |
the purpose of subsequently
transporting it outside this State |
|
for use or consumption thereafter solely
outside this State or |
(ii) for the purpose of being processed, fabricated, or
|
manufactured into, attached to, or incorporated into other |
tangible personal
property to be transported outside this State |
and thereafter used or consumed
solely outside this State. The |
Director of Revenue shall, pursuant to rules
adopted in |
accordance with the Illinois Administrative Procedure Act, |
issue a
permit to any taxpayer in good standing with the |
Department who is eligible for
the exemption under this |
paragraph (38). The permit issued under
this paragraph (38) |
shall authorize the holder, to the extent and
in the manner |
specified in the rules adopted under this Act, to purchase
|
tangible personal property from a retailer exempt from the |
taxes imposed by
this Act. Taxpayers shall maintain all |
necessary books and records to
substantiate the use and |
consumption of all such tangible personal property
outside of |
the State of Illinois.
|
(39) Beginning January 1, 2008, tangible personal property |
used in the construction or maintenance of a community water |
supply, as defined under Section 3.145 of the Environmental |
Protection Act, that is operated by a not-for-profit |
corporation that holds a valid water supply permit issued under |
Title IV of the Environmental Protection Act. This paragraph is |
exempt from the provisions of Section 2-70.
|
(Source: P.A. 94-1002, eff. 7-3-06; 95-88, eff. 1-1-08; 95-233, |
eff. 8-16-07; 95-304, eff. 8-20-07; 95-538, eff. 1-1-08; |
|
revised 9-11-07.)
|
(35 ILCS 120/2-45) (from Ch. 120, par. 441-45)
|
Sec. 2-45. Manufacturing and assembly exemption. The |
manufacturing
and assembly machinery and equipment exemption |
includes machinery
and equipment that replaces machinery
and |
equipment in an existing manufacturing facility as well as |
machinery
and equipment that are for use in an expanded or new
|
manufacturing facility.
|
The machinery and equipment exemption also includes |
machinery
and equipment used in the
general maintenance or |
repair of exempt machinery and equipment or for
in-house |
manufacture of exempt machinery and equipment.
For the purposes |
of this exemption, terms have the following meanings:
|
(1) "Manufacturing process" means the production of an |
article of
tangible personal property, whether the article |
is a finished product or an
article for use in the process |
of manufacturing or assembling a different
article of |
tangible personal property, by a procedure commonly |
regarded as
manufacturing, processing, fabricating, or |
refining that changes some
existing material or materials |
into a material with a different form, use,
or name. In |
relation to a recognized integrated business composed of a
|
series of operations that collectively constitute |
manufacturing, or
individually constitute manufacturing |
operations, the manufacturing process
commences with the |
|
first operation or stage of production in the series and
|
does not end until the completion of the final product in |
the last
operation or stage of production in the series. |
For purposes of this
exemption, photoprocessing is a |
manufacturing process of tangible personal
property for |
wholesale or retail sale.
|
(2) "Assembling process" means the production of an |
article of
tangible personal property, whether the article |
is a finished product or an
article for use in the process |
of manufacturing or assembling a different
article of |
tangible personal property, by the combination of existing
|
materials in a manner commonly regarded as assembling that |
results in a
material of a different form, use, or name.
|
(3) "Machinery" means major mechanical machines or |
major components of
those machines contributing to a |
manufacturing or assembling process.
|
(4) "Equipment" includes an independent device or tool |
separate from
machinery but essential to an integrated |
manufacturing or assembly process;
including computers |
used primarily in a manufacturer's computer assisted |
design, computer assisted manufacturing
(CAD/CAM) system; |
any subunit or assembly comprising a component of any
|
machinery or auxiliary, adjunct, or attachment parts of |
machinery, such as
tools, dies, jigs, fixtures, patterns, |
and molds; and any parts that
require periodic replacement |
in the course of normal operation; but does
not include |
|
hand tools. Equipment includes chemicals or chemicals |
acting as
catalysts but only if
the chemicals or chemicals |
acting as catalysts effect a direct and
immediate change |
upon a
product being manufactured or assembled for |
wholesale or retail sale or
lease.
|
(5) "Production related tangible personal property" |
means all tangible personal property that is used or |
consumed by the purchaser in a manufacturing facility in |
which a manufacturing process takes place and includes, |
without limitation, tangible personal property that is |
purchased for incorporation into real estate within a |
manufacturing facility and tangible personal property that |
is used or consumed in activities such as research and |
development, preproduction material handling, receiving, |
quality control, inventory control, storage, staging, and |
packaging for shipping and transportation purposes. |
"Production related tangible personal property" does not |
include (i) tangible personal property that is used, within |
or without a manufacturing facility, in sales, purchasing, |
accounting, fiscal management, marketing, personnel |
recruitment or selection, or landscaping or (ii) tangible |
personal property that is required to be titled or |
registered with a department, agency, or unit of federal, |
State, or local government.
|
The manufacturing and assembling machinery and equipment |
exemption includes production related tangible personal |
|
property that is purchased on or after July 1, 2007 and on or |
before June 30, 2008. The exemption for production related |
tangible personal property is subject to both of the following |
limitations: |
(1) The maximum amount of the exemption for any one |
taxpayer may not exceed 5% of the purchase price of |
production related tangible personal property that is |
purchased on or after July 1, 2007 and on or before June |
30, 2008. A credit under Section 3-85 of this Act may not |
be earned by the purchase of production related tangible |
personal property for which an exemption is received under |
this Section. |
(2) The maximum aggregate amount of the exemptions for |
production related tangible personal property awarded |
under this Act and the Retailers' Occupation Tax Act to all |
taxpayers may not exceed $10,000,000. If the claims for the |
exemption exceed $10,000,000, then the Department shall |
reduce the amount of the exemption to each taxpayer on a |
pro rata basis. |
The Department may adopt rules to implement and administer the |
exemption for production related tangible personal property. |
The manufacturing and assembling machinery and equipment |
exemption
includes the sale of materials to a purchaser who |
produces exempted types
of machinery, equipment, or tools and |
who rents or leases that machinery,
equipment, or tools to a |
manufacturer of tangible personal property. This
exemption |
|
also includes the sale of materials to a purchaser who |
manufactures
those materials into an exempted type of |
machinery, equipment, or tools
that the purchaser uses himself |
or herself in the manufacturing of tangible
personal property. |
The purchaser of the machinery and equipment who has an
active |
resale registration number shall furnish that number to the |
seller
at the time of purchase. A purchaser of the machinery, |
equipment, and
tools without an active resale registration |
number shall furnish to the
seller a certificate of exemption |
for each transaction stating facts
establishing the exemption |
for that transaction, and that certificate shall
be available |
to the Department for inspection or audit. Informal
rulings, |
opinions, or letters issued by the Department in response to an
|
inquiry or request for an opinion from any person regarding the |
coverage and
applicability of this exemption to specific |
devices shall be published,
maintained as a public record,
and |
made available for public inspection and copying. If the |
informal
ruling, opinion, or letter contains trade secrets or |
other confidential
information, where possible, the Department |
shall delete that information
before publication. Whenever |
informal rulings, opinions, or letters
contain a policy of |
general applicability, the Department shall
formulate and |
adopt that policy as a rule in accordance with the Illinois
|
Administrative Procedure Act.
|
(Source: P.A. 91-51, eff. 6-30-99; 92-484, eff. 8-23-01.)
|
|
Section 5-20. The School Code is amended by adding Sections |
2-3.143, 2-3.146, 10-20.40, 10-20.41, and 21-29 and by changing |
Sections 2-3.51.5, 2-3.127a, 2-3.131 (as added by Public Act |
93-21), 7-14A, 11E-135, 14-13.01, and 18-8.05 as follows:
|
(105 ILCS 5/2-3.51.5)
|
Sec. 2-3.51.5. School Safety and Educational Improvement |
Block Grant
Program. To improve the level of education and |
safety of students from
kindergarten through grade 12 in school |
districts and State-recognized, non-public schools . The State |
Board of
Education is authorized to fund a School Safety and |
Educational Improvement
Block Grant Program.
|
(1) For school districts, the The program shall provide |
funding for school safety, textbooks and
software, teacher |
training and curriculum development, school improvements, |
remediation programs under subsection (a) of Section 2-3.64, |
school
report cards under Section 10-17a, and criminal history |
records checks
under Sections 10-21.9 and 34-18.5. For |
State-recognized, non-public schools, the program shall |
provide funding for secular textbooks and software, criminal |
history records checks, and health and safety mandates to the |
extent that the funds are expended for purely secular purposes. |
A school district
or laboratory school as defined in Section |
18-8 or 18-8.05 is not required
to file an application in order |
to receive the categorical funding to which it
is entitled |
under this Section. Funds for the School Safety and Educational
|
|
Improvement Block Grant Program shall be distributed to school |
districts and
laboratory schools based on the prior year's best |
3 months average daily
attendance. Funds for the School Safety |
and Educational Improvement Block Grant Program shall be |
distributed to State-recognized, non-public schools based on |
the average daily attendance figure for the previous school |
year provided to the State Board of Education. The State Board |
of Education shall develop an application that requires |
State-recognized, non-public schools to submit average daily |
attendance figures. A State-recognized, non-public school must |
submit the application and average daily attendance figure |
prior to receiving funds under this Section. The State Board of |
Education shall promulgate rules and
regulations necessary for |
the implementation of this program.
|
(2) Distribution of moneys to school districts and |
State-recognized, non-public schools shall be made in 2
|
semi-annual installments, one payment on or before October 30, |
and one
payment prior to April 30, of each fiscal year.
|
(3) Grants under the School Safety and Educational |
Improvement Block Grant
Program shall be awarded provided there |
is an appropriation for the program,
and funding levels for |
each district shall be prorated according to the amount
of the |
appropriation.
|
(4) The provisions of this Section are in the public |
interest, are for the public benefit, and serve secular public |
purposes. |
|
(Source: P.A. 93-909, eff. 8-12-04.)
|
(105 ILCS 5/2-3.127a) |
Sec. 2-3.127a. The State Board of Education Special Purpose |
Trust Fund. The State Board of Education Special Purpose Trust |
Fund is created as a special fund in the State treasury. The |
State Board of Education shall deposit all indirect costs |
recovered from federal programs into the State Board of |
Education Special Purpose Trust Fund. These funds may be used |
by the State Board of Education for its ordinary and contingent |
expenses. Additionally and unless Unless specifically directed |
to be deposited into other funds, all moneys received by the |
State Board of Education from gifts, grants, or donations from |
any source, public or private, shall be deposited into the |
State Board of Education Special Purpose Trust Fund this Fund . |
These funds Moneys in this Fund shall be used, subject to |
appropriation by the General Assembly, by the State Board of |
Education for the purposes established by the gifts, grants, or |
donations.
|
(Source: P.A. 94-69, eff. 7-1-05.)
|
(105 ILCS 5/2-3.131)
|
Sec. 2-3.131. Transitional assistance payments.
|
(a) If the amount that
the State Board of Education will |
pay to
a school
district from fiscal year 2004 appropriations, |
as estimated by the State
Board of Education on April 1, 2004, |
|
is less than the amount that the
State Board of Education paid |
to the school district from fiscal year 2003
appropriations, |
then, subject to appropriation, the State Board of
Education |
shall make a fiscal year 2004 transitional assistance payment
|
to the school district in an amount equal to the difference |
between the
estimated amount to be paid from fiscal year 2004 |
appropriations and
the amount paid from fiscal year 2003 |
appropriations.
|
(b) If the amount that
the State Board of Education will |
pay to
a school
district from fiscal year 2005 appropriations, |
as estimated by the State
Board of Education on April 1, 2005, |
is less than the amount that the
State Board of Education paid |
to the school district from fiscal year 2004
appropriations, |
then the State Board of
Education shall make a fiscal year 2005 |
transitional assistance payment
to the school district in an |
amount equal to the difference between the
estimated amount to |
be paid from fiscal year 2005 appropriations and
the amount |
paid from fiscal year 2004 appropriations.
|
(c) If the amount that
the State Board of Education will |
pay to
a school
district from fiscal year 2006 appropriations, |
as estimated by the State
Board of Education on April 1, 2006, |
is less than the amount that the
State Board of Education paid |
to the school district from fiscal year 2005
appropriations, |
then the State Board of
Education shall make a fiscal year 2006 |
transitional assistance payment
to the school district in an |
amount equal to the difference between the
estimated amount to |
|
be paid from fiscal year 2006 appropriations and
the amount |
paid from fiscal year 2005 appropriations.
|
(d) If the amount that
the State Board of Education will |
pay to
a school
district from fiscal year 2007 appropriations, |
as estimated by the State
Board of Education on April 1, 2007, |
is less than the amount that the
State Board of Education paid |
to the school district from fiscal year 2006
appropriations, |
then the State Board of
Education, subject to appropriation, |
shall make a fiscal year 2007 transitional assistance payment
|
to the school district in an amount equal to the difference |
between the
estimated amount to be paid from fiscal year 2007 |
appropriations and
the amount paid from fiscal year 2006 |
appropriations.
|
(e) Subject to appropriation, beginning on July 1, 2007, |
the State Board of Education shall adjust prior year |
information for the transitional assistance calculations under |
this Section in the event of the creation or reorganization of |
any school district pursuant to Article 11E of this Code, the |
dissolution of an entire district and the annexation of all of |
its territory to one or more other districts pursuant to |
Article 7 of this Code, or a boundary change whereby the |
enrollment of the annexing district increases by 90% or more as |
a result of annexing territory detached from another district |
pursuant to Article 7 of this Code.
|
(f) If the amount that
the State Board of Education will |
pay to
a school
district from fiscal year 2008 appropriations, |
|
as estimated by the State
Board of Education on April 1, 2008, |
is less than the amount that the
State Board of Education paid |
to the school district from fiscal year 2007
appropriations, |
then the State Board of
Education, subject to appropriation, |
shall make a fiscal year 2008 transitional assistance payment
|
to the school district in an amount equal to the difference |
between the
estimated amount to be paid from fiscal year 2008 |
appropriations and
the amount paid from fiscal year 2007 |
appropriations.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-21, eff. 7-1-03; 93-838, eff. 7-30-04; 94-69, |
eff. 7-1-05; 94-835, eff. 6-6-06.)
|
(105 ILCS 5/2-3.143 new)
|
Sec. 2-3.143. Lincoln's ChalleNGe Academy study. The State |
Board of Education shall conduct a study to consider the need |
for an expansion of enrollment at or the replication of |
services in other portions of this State for the Lincoln's |
ChalleNGe Academy as an alternative program for students who |
have dropped out of traditional school. |
(105 ILCS 5/2-3.146 new)
|
Sec. 2-3.146. Severely overcrowded schools grant program. |
There is created a grant program, subject to appropriation, for |
severely overcrowded schools. The State Board of Education |
shall administer the program. Grant funds may be used for |
purposes of relieving overcrowding. In order for a school |
|
district to be eligible for a grant under this Section, (i) the |
main administrative office of the district must be located in a |
city of 85,000 or more in population, according to the 2000 |
U.S. Census, (ii) the school district must have a district-wide |
percentage of low-income students of 70% or more, as identified |
by the 2005-2006 School Report Cards published by the State |
Board of Education, and (iii) the school district must not be |
eligible for a fast growth grant under Section 18-8.10 of this |
Code. The State Board of Education shall distribute the funds |
on a proportional basis with no single district receiving more |
than 75% of the funds in any given year. The State Board of |
Education may adopt rules as needed for the implementation and |
distribution of grants under this Section.
|
(105 ILCS 5/7-14A) (from Ch. 122, par. 7-14A)
|
Sec. 7-14A. Annexation Compensation. There shall be no |
accounting
made after a mere change in boundaries when no new |
district is created , except that those districts whose |
enrollment increases by 90% or more as a result of annexing |
territory detached from another district pursuant to this |
Article are eligible for supplementary State aid payments in |
accordance with Section 11E-135 of this Code. Eligible annexing |
districts shall apply to the State Board of Education for |
supplementary State aid payments by submitting enrollment |
figures for the year immediately preceding and the year |
immediately following the effective date of the boundary change |
|
for both the district gaining territory and the district losing |
territory. Copies of any intergovernmental agreements between |
the district gaining territory and the district losing |
territory detailing any transfer of fund balances and staff |
must also be submitted. In all instances of changes in |
boundaries,
.
However, the district losing territory shall
not |
count the average daily attendance of pupils living in the |
territory
during the year preceding the effective date of the |
boundary change in its
claim for reimbursement under Section |
18-8 for the school year following
the effective date of the |
change in boundaries and the district receiving
the territory |
shall count the average daily attendance of pupils living in
|
the territory during the year preceding the effective date of |
the boundary
change in its claim for reimbursement under |
Section 18-8 for the school
year following the effective date |
of the change in boundaries. The changes to this Section made |
by this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly are |
intended to be retroactive and applicable to any annexation |
taking effect on or after July 1, 2004.
|
(Source: P.A. 84-1250.)
|
(105 ILCS 5/10-20.40 new)
|
Sec. 10-20.40. Report on contracts. |
(a) This Section applies to all school districts, including |
a school district organized under Article 34 of this Code. |
(b) A school board must
list on the district's Internet |
|
website, if any, all contracts
over $25,000 and any contract |
that the school board enters into
with an exclusive bargaining |
representative. |
(c) Each year, in conjunction with the submission of the |
Statement of Affairs to the State Board of Education prior to |
December, 1 provided for in Section 10-17, each school district |
shall submit to the State Board of Education an annual report |
on all contracts over $25,000 awarded by the school district |
during the previous fiscal year. The report shall include at |
least the following: |
(1) the total number of all contracts awarded by the |
school district; |
(2) the total value of all contracts awarded; |
(3) the number of contracts awarded to minority owned |
businesses, female owned businesses, and businesses owned |
by persons with disabilities, as defined in the Business |
Enterprise for Minorities, Females and Persons with |
Disabilities Act, and locally owned businesses; and |
(4) the total value of contracts awarded to minority |
owned businesses, female owned businesses, and businesses |
owned by persons with disabilities, as defined in the |
Business Enterprise for Minorities, Females and Persons |
with Disabilities Act, and locally owned businesses. |
The report shall be made available to the public, including |
publication on the school district's Internet website, if any. |
|
(105 ILCS 5/10-20.41 new)
|
Sec. 10-20.41. Pay for performance.
|
(a) Beginning with all newly-negotiated collective |
bargaining agreements entered into after the effective date of |
this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly, a school |
board and the exclusive bargaining representative, if any, may |
include a performance-based teacher compensation plan in the |
subject of its collective bargaining agreement. Nothing in this |
Section shall preclude the school board and the exclusive |
bargaining representative from agreeing to and implementing a |
new performance-based teacher compensation plan prior to the |
termination of the current collective bargaining agreement. |
(b) The new teacher compensation plan bargained and agreed |
to by the school board and the exclusive bargaining |
representative under subsection (a) of this Section shall |
provide certificated personnel with base salaries and shall |
also provide that any increases in the compensation of |
individual teachers or groups of teachers beyond base salaries |
shall be pursuant, but not limited to, any of the following |
elements: |
(1) Superior teacher evaluations based on multiple |
evaluations of their classroom teaching. |
(2) Evaluation of a teacher's student classroom-level |
achievement growth as measured using a value-added model. |
"Value-added" means the improvement gains in student |
achievement that are made each year based on pre-test and |
|
post-test outcomes. |
(3) Evaluation of school-level achievement growth as |
measured using a value-added model. "Value-added" means |
the improvement gains in student achievement that are made |
each year based on pre-test and post-test outcomes. |
(4) Demonstration of superior, outstanding performance |
by an individual teacher or groups of teachers through the |
meeting of unique and specific teaching practice |
objectives defined and agreed to in advance in any given |
school year. |
(5) Preparation for meeting and contribution to the |
broader needs of the school organization (e.g., curriculum |
development, family liaison and community outreach, |
implementation of a professional development program for |
faculty, and participation in school management).
|
(c) A school board and exclusive bargaining representative |
that initiate their own performance-based teacher compensation |
program shall submit the new plan to the State Board of |
Education for review not later than 150 days before the plan is |
to become effective. If the plan does not conform to this |
Section, the State Board of Education shall return the plan to |
the school board and the exclusive bargaining representative |
for modification. The school board and the exclusive bargaining |
representative shall then have 30 days after the plan is |
returned to them to submit a modified plan.
|
|
(105 ILCS 5/11E-135) |
Sec. 11E-135. Incentives. For districts reorganizing under |
this Article and for a district or districts that annex all of |
the territory of one or more entire other school districts in |
accordance with Article 7 of this Code, the following payments |
shall be made from appropriations made for these purposes: |
(a)(1) For a combined school district, as defined in |
Section 11E-20 of this Code, or for a unit district, as defined |
in Section 11E-25 of this Code, for its first year of |
existence, the general State aid and supplemental general State |
aid calculated under Section 18-8.05 of this Code shall be |
computed for the new district and for the previously existing |
districts for which property is totally included within the new |
district. If the computation on the basis of the previously |
existing districts is greater, a supplementary payment equal to |
the difference shall be made for the first 4 years of existence |
of the new district. |
(2) For a school district that annexes all of the territory |
of one or more entire other school districts as defined in |
Article 7 of this Code, for the first year during which the |
change of boundaries attributable to the annexation becomes |
effective for all purposes, as determined under Section 7-9 of |
this Code, the general State aid and supplemental general State |
aid calculated under Section 18-8.05 of this Code shall be |
computed for the annexing district as constituted after the |
annexation and for the annexing and each annexed district as |
|
constituted prior to the annexation; and if the computation on |
the basis of the annexing and annexed districts as constituted |
prior to the annexation is greater, then a supplementary |
payment equal to the difference shall be made for the first 4 |
years of existence of the annexing school district as |
constituted upon the annexation. |
(3) For 2 or more school districts that annex all of the |
territory of one or more entire other school districts, as |
defined in Article 7 of this Code, for the first year during |
which the change of boundaries attributable to the annexation |
becomes effective for all purposes, as determined under Section |
7-9 of this Code, the general State aid and supplemental |
general State aid calculated under Section 18-8.05 of this Code |
shall be computed for each annexing district as constituted |
after the annexation and for each annexing and annexed district |
as constituted prior to the annexation; and if the aggregate of |
the general State aid and supplemental general State aid as so |
computed for the annexing districts as constituted after the |
annexation is less than the aggregate of the general State aid |
and supplemental general State aid as so computed for the |
annexing and annexed districts, as constituted prior to the |
annexation, then a supplementary payment equal to the |
difference shall be made and allocated between or among the |
annexing districts, as constituted upon the annexation, for the |
first 4 years of their existence. The total difference payment |
shall be allocated between or among the annexing districts in |
|
the same ratio as the pupil enrollment from that portion of the |
annexed district or districts that is annexed to each annexing |
district bears to the total pupil enrollment from the entire |
annexed district or districts, as such pupil enrollment is |
determined for the school year last ending prior to the date |
when the change of boundaries attributable to the annexation |
becomes effective for all purposes. The amount of the total |
difference payment and the amount thereof to be allocated to |
the annexing districts shall be computed by the State Board of |
Education on the basis of pupil enrollment and other data that |
shall be certified to the State Board of Education, on forms |
that it shall provide for that purpose, by the regional |
superintendent of schools for each educational service region |
in which the annexing and annexed districts are located. |
(4) For a school district conversion, as defined in Section |
11E-15 of this Code, or a multi-unit conversion, as defined in |
subsection (b) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, if in their |
first year of existence the newly created elementary districts |
and the newly created high school district, from a school |
district conversion, or the newly created elementary district |
or districts and newly created combined high school - unit |
district, from a multi-unit conversion, qualify for less |
general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of this Code than would |
have been payable under Section 18-8.05 for that same year to |
the previously existing districts, then a supplementary |
payment equal to that difference shall be made for the first 4 |
|
years of existence of the newly created districts. The |
aggregate amount of each supplementary payment shall be |
allocated among the newly created districts in the proportion |
that the deemed pupil enrollment in each district during its |
first year of existence bears to the actual aggregate pupil |
enrollment in all of the districts during their first year of |
existence. For purposes of each allocation: |
(A) the deemed pupil enrollment of the newly created |
high school district from a school district conversion |
shall be an amount equal to its actual pupil enrollment for |
its first year of existence multiplied by 1.25; |
(B) the deemed pupil enrollment of each newly created |
elementary district from a school district conversion |
shall be an amount equal to its actual pupil enrollment for |
its first year of existence reduced by an amount equal to |
the product obtained when the amount by which the newly |
created high school district's deemed pupil enrollment |
exceeds its actual pupil enrollment for its first year of |
existence is multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of |
which is the actual pupil enrollment of the newly created |
elementary district for its first year of existence and the |
denominator of which is the actual aggregate pupil |
enrollment of all of the newly created elementary districts |
for their first year of existence; |
(C) the deemed high school pupil enrollment of the |
newly created combined high school - unit district from a |
|
multi-unit conversion shall be an amount equal to its |
actual grades 9 through 12 pupil enrollment for its first |
year of existence multiplied by 1.25; and |
(D) the deemed elementary pupil enrollment of each |
newly created district from a multi-unit conversion shall |
be an amount equal to each district's actual grade K |
through 8 pupil enrollment for its first year of existence, |
reduced by an amount equal to the product obtained when the |
amount by which the newly created combined high school - |
unit district's deemed high school pupil enrollment |
exceeds its actual grade 9 through 12 pupil enrollment for |
its first year of existence is multiplied by a fraction, |
the numerator of which is the actual grade K through 8 |
pupil enrollment of each newly created district for its |
first year of existence and the denominator of which is the |
actual aggregate grade K through 8 pupil enrollment of all |
such newly created districts for their first year of |
existence. |
The aggregate amount of each supplementary payment under |
this subdivision (4) and the amount thereof to be allocated to |
the newly created districts shall be computed by the State |
Board of Education on the basis of pupil enrollment and other |
data, which shall be certified to the State Board of Education, |
on forms that it shall provide for that purpose, by the |
regional superintendent of schools for each educational |
service region in which the newly created districts are |
|
located.
|
(5) For a partial elementary unit district, as defined in |
subsection (a) or (c) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, if, in |
the first year of existence, the newly created partial |
elementary unit district qualifies for less general State aid |
and supplemental general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of |
this Code than would have been payable under that Section for |
that same year to the previously existing districts that formed |
the partial elementary unit district, then a supplementary |
payment equal to that difference shall be made to the partial |
elementary unit district for the first 4 years of existence of |
that newly created district. |
(6) For an elementary opt-in, as described in subsection |
(d) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the general State aid |
difference shall be computed in accordance with paragraph (5) |
of this subsection (a) as if the elementary opt-in was included |
in an optional elementary unit district at the optional |
elementary unit district's original effective date. If the |
calculation in this paragraph (6) is less than that calculated |
in paragraph (5) of this subsection (a) at the optional |
elementary unit district's original effective date, then no |
adjustments may be made. If the calculation in this paragraph |
(6) is more than that calculated in paragraph (5) of this |
subsection (a) at the optional elementary unit district's |
original effective date, then the excess must be paid as |
follows: |
|
(A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
one year after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, 100% of the calculated excess |
shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
elementary opt-in. |
(B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
2 years after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, 75% of the calculated excess |
shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
elementary opt-in. |
(C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
3 years after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, 50% of the calculated excess |
shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
elementary opt-in. |
(D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
4 years after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, 25% of the calculated excess |
shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
elementary opt-in. |
(E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
5 years after the effective date for the optional |
|
elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit |
district is not eligible for any additional incentives due |
to the elementary opt-in. |
(6.5) For a school district that annexes territory detached |
from another school district whereby the enrollment of the |
annexing district increases by 90% or more as a result of the |
annexation, for the first year during which the change of |
boundaries attributable to the annexation becomes effective |
for all purposes as determined under Section 7-9 of this Code, |
the general State aid and supplemental general State aid |
calculated under this Section shall be computed for the |
district gaining territory and the district losing territory as |
constituted after the annexation and for the same districts as |
constituted prior to the annexation; and if the aggregate of |
the general State aid and supplemental general State aid as so |
computed for the district gaining territory and the district |
losing territory as constituted after the annexation is less |
than the aggregate of the general State aid and supplemental |
general State aid as so computed for the district gaining |
territory and the district losing territory as constituted |
prior to the annexation, then a supplementary payment shall be |
made to the annexing district for the first 4 years of |
existence after the annexation, equal to the difference |
multiplied by the ratio of student enrollment in the territory |
detached to the total student enrollment in the district losing |
territory for the year prior to the effective date of the |
|
annexation. The amount of the total difference and the |
proportion paid to the annexing district shall be computed by |
the State Board of Education on the basis of pupil enrollment |
and other data that must be submitted to the State Board of |
Education in accordance with Section 7-14A of this Code. The |
changes to this Section made by this amendatory Act of the 95th |
General Assembly are intended to be retroactive and applicable |
to any annexation taking effect on or after July 1, 2004. For |
annexations that are eligible for payments under this paragraph |
(6.5) and that are effective on or after July 1, 2004, but |
before the effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th |
General Assembly, the first required yearly payment under this |
paragraph (6.5) shall be paid in the fiscal year of the |
effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th General |
Assembly. Subsequent required yearly payments shall be paid in |
subsequent fiscal years until the payment obligation under this |
paragraph (6.5) is complete.
|
(7) Claims for financial assistance under this subsection |
(a) may not be recomputed except as expressly provided under |
Section 18-8.05 of this Code. |
(8) Any supplementary payment made under this subsection |
(a) must be treated as separate from all other payments made |
pursuant to Section 18-8.05 of this Code. |
(b)(1) After the formation of a combined school district, |
as defined in Section 11E-20 of this Code, or a unit district, |
as defined in Section 11E-25 of this Code, a computation shall |
|
be made to determine the difference between the salaries |
effective in each of the previously existing districts on June |
30, prior to the creation of the new district. For the first 4 |
years after the formation of the new district, a supplementary |
State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the new district equal |
to the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by |
each of the certificated members of the new district, while |
employed in one of the previously existing districts during the |
year immediately preceding the formation of the new district, |
and the sum of the salaries those certificated members would |
have been paid during the year immediately prior to the |
formation of the new district if placed on the salary schedule |
of the previously existing district with the highest salary |
schedule. |
(2) After the territory of one or more school districts is |
annexed by one or more other school districts as defined in |
Article 7 of this Code, a computation shall be made to |
determine the difference between the salaries effective in each |
annexed district and in the annexing district or districts as |
they were each constituted on June 30 preceding the date when |
the change of boundaries attributable to the annexation became |
effective for all purposes, as determined under Section 7-9 of |
this Code. For the first 4 years after the annexation, a |
supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to each |
annexing district as constituted after the annexation equal to |
the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by each |
|
of the certificated members of the annexing district as |
constituted after the annexation, while employed in an annexed |
or annexing district during the year immediately preceding the |
annexation, and the sum of the salaries those certificated |
members would have been paid during the immediately preceding |
year if placed on the salary schedule of whichever of the |
annexing or annexed districts had the highest salary schedule |
during the immediately preceding year. |
(3) For each new high school district formed under a school |
district conversion, as defined in Section 11E-15 of this Code, |
the State shall make a supplementary payment for 4 years equal |
to the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by |
each certified member of the new high school district, while |
employed in one of the previously existing districts, and the |
sum of the salaries those certified members would have been |
paid if placed on the salary schedule of the previously |
existing district with the highest salary schedule. |
(4) For each newly created partial elementary unit |
district, the State shall make a supplementary payment for 4 |
years equal to the difference between the sum of the salaries |
earned by each certified member of the newly created partial |
elementary unit district, while employed in one of the |
previously existing districts that formed the partial |
elementary unit district, and the sum of the salaries those |
certified members would have been paid if placed on the salary |
schedule of the previously existing district with the highest |
|
salary schedule. The salary schedules used in the calculation |
shall be those in effect in the previously existing districts |
for the school year prior to the creation of the new partial |
elementary unit district. |
(5) For an elementary district opt-in, as described in |
subsection (d) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the salary |
difference incentive shall be computed in accordance with |
paragraph (4) of this subsection (b) as if the opted-in |
elementary district was included in the optional elementary |
unit district at the optional elementary unit district's |
original effective date. If the calculation in this paragraph |
(5) is less than that calculated in paragraph (4) of this |
subsection (b) at the optional elementary unit district's |
original effective date, then no adjustments may be made. If |
the calculation in this paragraph (5) is more than that |
calculated in paragraph (4) of this subsection (b) at the |
optional elementary unit district's original effective date, |
then the excess must be paid as follows: |
(A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
one year after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, 100% of the calculated excess |
shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
elementary opt-in. |
(B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
2 years after the effective date for the optional |
|
elementary unit district, 75% of the calculated excess |
shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
elementary opt-in. |
(C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
3 years after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, 50% of the calculated excess |
shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the |
elementary opt-in. |
(D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
4 years after the effective date for the partial elementary |
unit district, 25% of the calculated excess shall be paid |
to the optional elementary unit district in each of the |
first 4 years after the effective date of the elementary |
opt-in. |
(E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
5 years after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit |
district is not eligible for any additional incentives due |
to the elementary opt-in. |
(5.5)
(b-5) After the formation of a cooperative high |
school by 2 or more school districts under Section 10-22.22c of |
this Code, a computation shall be made to determine the |
difference between the salaries effective in each of the |
previously existing high schools on June 30 prior to the |
|
formation of the cooperative high school. For the first 4 years |
after the formation of the cooperative high school, a |
supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the |
cooperative high school equal to the difference between the sum |
of the salaries earned by each of the certificated members of |
the cooperative high school while employed in one of the |
previously existing high schools during the year immediately |
preceding the formation of the cooperative high school and the |
sum of the salaries those certificated members would have been |
paid during the year immediately prior to the formation of the |
cooperative high school if placed on the salary schedule of the |
previously existing high school with the highest salary |
schedule. |
(5.10) After the annexation of territory detached from
|
another school district whereby the enrollment of the annexing
|
district increases by 90% or more as a result of the
|
annexation, a computation shall be made to determine the
|
difference between the salaries effective in the district
|
gaining territory and the district losing territory as they
|
each were constituted on June 30 preceding the date when the
|
change of boundaries attributable to the annexation became
|
effective for all purposes as determined under Section 7-9 of
|
this Code. For the first 4 years after the annexation, a
|
supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the
|
annexing district equal to the difference between the sum of
|
the salaries earned by each of the certificated members of the
|
|
annexing district as constituted after the annexation while
|
employed in the district gaining territory or the district
|
losing territory during the year immediately preceding the
|
annexation and the sum of the salaries those certificated
|
members would have been paid during such immediately preceding
|
year if placed on the salary schedule of whichever of the
|
district gaining territory or district losing territory had the
|
highest salary schedule during the immediately preceding year.
|
To be eligible for supplementary State aid reimbursement under
|
this Section, the intergovernmental agreement to be submitted
|
pursuant to Section 7-14A of this Code must show that staff
|
members were transferred from the control of the district
|
losing territory to the control of the district gaining
|
territory in the annexation. The changes to this Section made
|
by this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly are
|
intended to be retroactive and applicable to any annexation
|
taking effect on or after July 1, 2004. For annexations that |
are eligible for payments under this paragraph (5.10) and that |
are effective on or after July 1, 2004, but before the |
effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th General |
Assembly, the first required yearly payment under this |
paragraph (5.10) shall be paid in the fiscal year of the |
effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th General |
Assembly. Subsequent required yearly payments shall be paid in |
subsequent fiscal years until the payment obligation under this |
paragraph (5.10) is complete.
|
|
(6) The supplementary State aid reimbursement under this |
subsection (b) shall be treated as separate from all other |
payments made pursuant to Section 18-8.05 of this Code. In the |
case of the formation of a new district or cooperative high |
school, reimbursement shall begin during the first year of |
operation of the new district or cooperative high school, and |
in the case of an annexation of the territory of one or more |
school districts by one or more other school districts or the |
annexation of territory detached from a school district whereby
|
the enrollment of the annexing district increases by 90% or
|
more as a result of the annexation , reimbursement shall begin |
during the first year when the change in boundaries |
attributable to the annexation or division becomes effective |
for all purposes as determined pursuant to Section 7-9 of this |
Code , except that for an annexation of territory detached from |
a school district that is effective on or after July 1, 2004, |
but before the effective date of this amendatory Act of the |
95th General Assembly, whereby the enrollment of the annexing |
district increases by 90% or more as a result of the |
annexation, reimbursement shall begin during the fiscal year of |
the effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th General |
Assembly . Each year that the new, annexing, or resulting |
district or cooperative high school, as the case may be, is |
entitled to receive reimbursement, the number of eligible |
certified members who are employed on October 1 in the district |
or cooperative high school shall be certified to the State |
|
Board of Education on prescribed forms by October 15 and |
payment shall be made on or before November 15 of that year. |
(c)(1) For the first year after the formation of a combined |
school district, as defined in Section 11E-20 of this Code or a |
unit district, as defined in Section 11E-25 of this Code, a |
computation shall be made totaling each previously existing |
district's audited fund balances in the educational fund, |
working cash fund, operations and maintenance fund, and |
transportation fund for the year ending June 30 prior to the |
referendum for the creation of the new district. The new |
district shall be paid supplementary State aid equal to the sum |
of the differences between the deficit of the previously |
existing district with the smallest deficit and the deficits of |
each of the other previously existing districts. |
(2) For the first year after the annexation of all of the |
territory of one or more entire school districts by another |
school district, as defined in Article 7 of this Code, |
computations shall be made, for the year ending June 30 prior |
to the date that the change of boundaries attributable to the |
annexation is allowed by the affirmative decision issued by the |
regional board of school trustees under Section 7-6 of this |
Code, notwithstanding any effort to seek administrative review |
of the decision, totaling the annexing district's and totaling |
each annexed district's audited fund balances in their |
respective educational, working cash, operations and |
maintenance, and transportation funds. The annexing district |
|
as constituted after the annexation shall be paid supplementary |
State aid equal to the sum of the differences between the |
deficit of whichever of the annexing or annexed districts as |
constituted prior to the annexation had the smallest deficit |
and the deficits of each of the other districts as constituted |
prior to the annexation. |
(3) For the first year after the annexation of all of the |
territory of one or more entire school districts by 2 or more |
other school districts, as defined by Article 7 of this Code, |
computations shall be made, for the year ending June 30 prior |
to the date that the change of boundaries attributable to the |
annexation is allowed by the affirmative decision of the |
regional board of school trustees under Section 7-6 of this |
Code, notwithstanding any action for administrative review of |
the decision, totaling each annexing and annexed district's |
audited fund balances in their respective educational, working |
cash, operations and maintenance, and transportation funds. |
The annexing districts as constituted after the annexation |
shall be paid supplementary State aid, allocated as provided in |
this paragraph (3), in an aggregate amount equal to the sum of |
the differences between the deficit of whichever of the |
annexing or annexed districts as constituted prior to the |
annexation had the smallest deficit and the deficits of each of |
the other districts as constituted prior to the annexation. The |
aggregate amount of the supplementary State aid payable under |
this paragraph (3) shall be allocated between or among the |
|
annexing districts as follows: |
(A) the regional superintendent of schools for each |
educational service region in which an annexed district is |
located prior to the annexation shall certify to the State |
Board of Education, on forms that it shall provide for that |
purpose, the value of all taxable property in each annexed |
district, as last equalized or assessed by the Department |
of Revenue prior to the annexation, and the equalized |
assessed value of each part of the annexed district that |
was annexed to or included as a part of an annexing |
district; |
(B) using equalized assessed values as certified by the |
regional superintendent of schools under clause (A) of this |
paragraph (3), the combined audited fund balance deficit of |
each annexed district as determined under this Section |
shall be apportioned between or among the annexing |
districts in the same ratio as the equalized assessed value |
of that part of the annexed district that was annexed to or |
included as a part of an annexing district bears to the |
total equalized assessed value of the annexed district; and |
(C) the aggregate supplementary State aid payment |
under this paragraph (3) shall be allocated between or |
among, and shall be paid to, the annexing districts in the |
same ratio as the sum of the combined audited fund balance |
deficit of each annexing district as constituted prior to |
the annexation, plus all combined audited fund balance |
|
deficit amounts apportioned to that annexing district |
under clause (B) of this subsection, bears to the aggregate |
of the combined audited fund balance deficits of all of the |
annexing and annexed districts as constituted prior to the |
annexation. |
(4) For the new elementary districts and new high school |
district formed through a school district conversion, as |
defined in subsection (b) of Section 11E-15 of this Code or the |
new elementary district or districts and new combined high |
school - unit district formed through a multi-unit conversion, |
as defined in subsection (b) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, a |
computation shall be made totaling each previously existing |
district's audited fund balances in the educational fund, |
working cash fund, operations and maintenance fund, and |
transportation fund for the year ending June 30 prior to the |
referendum establishing the new districts. In the first year of |
the new districts, the State shall make a one-time |
supplementary payment equal to the sum of the differences |
between the deficit of the previously existing district with |
the smallest deficit and the deficits of each of the other |
previously existing districts. A district with a combined |
balance among the 4 funds that is positive shall be considered |
to have a deficit of zero. The supplementary payment shall be |
allocated among the newly formed high school and elementary |
districts in the manner provided by the petition for the |
formation of the districts, in the form in which the petition |
|
is approved by the regional superintendent of schools or State |
Superintendent of Education under Section 11E-50 of this Code. |
(5) For each newly created partial elementary unit |
district, as defined in subsection (a) or (c) of Section 11E-30 |
of this Code, a computation shall be made totaling the audited |
fund balances of each previously existing district that formed |
the new partial elementary unit district in the educational |
fund, working cash fund, operations and maintenance fund, and |
transportation fund for the year ending June 30 prior to the |
referendum for the formation of the partial elementary unit |
district. In the first year of the new partial elementary unit |
district, the State shall make a one-time supplementary payment |
to the new district equal to the sum of the differences between |
the deficit of the previously existing district with the |
smallest deficit and the deficits of each of the other |
previously existing districts. A district with a combined |
balance among the 4 funds that is positive shall be considered |
to have a deficit of zero. |
(6) For an elementary opt-in as defined in subsection (d) |
of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the deficit fund balance |
incentive shall be computed in accordance with paragraph (5) of |
this subsection (c) as if the opted-in elementary was included |
in the optional elementary unit district at the optional |
elementary unit district's original effective date. If the |
calculation in this paragraph (6) is less than that calculated |
in paragraph (5) of this subsection (c) at the optional |
|
elementary unit district's original effective date, then no |
adjustments may be made. If the calculation in this paragraph |
(6) is more than that calculated in paragraph (5) of this |
subsection (c) at the optional elementary unit district's |
original effective date, then the excess must be paid as |
follows: |
(A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
one year after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, 100% of the calculated excess |
shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
the first year after the effective date of the elementary |
opt-in. |
(B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
2 years after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, 75% of the calculated excess |
shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
the first year after the effective date of the elementary |
opt-in. |
(C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
3 years after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, 50% of the calculated excess |
shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
the first year after the effective date of the elementary |
opt-in. |
(D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
4 years after the effective date for the optional |
|
elementary unit district, 25% of the calculated excess |
shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in |
the first year after the effective date of the elementary |
opt-in. |
(E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
5 years after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit |
district is not eligible for any additional incentives due |
to the elementary opt-in. |
(6.5) For the first year after the annexation of territory
|
detached from another school district whereby the enrollment of
|
the annexing district increases by 90% or more as a result of
|
the annexation, a computation shall be made totaling the
|
audited fund balances of the district gaining territory and the
|
audited fund balances of the district losing territory in the
|
educational fund, working cash fund, operations and
|
maintenance fund, and transportation fund for the year ending
|
June 30 prior to the date that the change of boundaries
|
attributable to the annexation is allowed by the affirmative
|
decision of the regional board of school trustees under Section
|
7-6 of this Code, notwithstanding any action for administrative
|
review of the decision. The annexing district as constituted
|
after the annexation shall be paid supplementary State aid
|
equal to the difference between the deficit of whichever
|
district included in this calculation as constituted prior to
|
the annexation had the smallest deficit and the deficit of each
|
|
other district included in this calculation as constituted
|
prior to the annexation, multiplied by the ratio of equalized
|
assessed value of the territory detached to the total equalized
|
assessed value of the district losing territory. The regional
|
superintendent of schools for the educational service region in
|
which a district losing territory is located prior to the
|
annexation shall certify to the State Board of Education the
|
value of all taxable property in the district losing territory
|
and the value of all taxable property in the territory being
|
detached, as last equalized or assessed by the Department of
|
Revenue prior to the annexation. To be eligible for
|
supplementary State aid reimbursement under this Section, the
|
intergovernmental agreement to be submitted pursuant to
|
Section 7-14A of this Code must show that fund balances were
|
transferred from the district losing territory to the district
|
gaining territory in the annexation. The changes to this
|
Section made by this amendatory Act of the 95th General
|
Assembly are intended to be retroactive and applicable to any
|
annexation taking effect on or after July 1, 2004. For |
annexations that are eligible for payments under this paragraph |
(6.5) and that are effective on or after July 1, 2004, but |
before the effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th |
General Assembly, the required payment under this paragraph |
(6.5) shall be paid in the fiscal year of the effective date of |
this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly.
|
(7) For purposes of any calculation required under |
|
paragraph (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), or (6) , or (6.5) of this |
subsection (c), a district with a combined fund balance that is |
positive shall be considered to have a deficit of zero. For |
purposes of determining each district's audited fund balances |
in its educational fund, working cash fund, operations and |
maintenance fund, and transportation fund for the specified |
year ending June 30, as provided in paragraphs (1), (2), (3), |
(4), (5), and (6) , and (6.5) of this subsection (c), the |
balance of each fund shall be deemed decreased by an amount |
equal to the amount of the annual property tax theretofore |
levied in the fund by the district for collection and payment |
to the district during the calendar year in which the June 30 |
fell, but only to the extent that the tax so levied in the fund |
actually was received by the district on or before or comprised |
a part of the fund on such June 30. For purposes of determining |
each district's audited fund balances, a calculation shall be |
made for each fund to determine the average for the 3 years |
prior to the specified year ending June 30, as provided in |
paragraphs (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), and (6) , and (6.5) of this |
subsection (c), of the district's expenditures in the |
categories "purchased services", "supplies and materials", and |
"capital outlay", as those categories are defined in rules of |
the State Board of Education. If this 3-year average is less |
than the district's expenditures in these categories for the |
specified year ending June 30, as provided in paragraphs (1), |
(2), (3), (4), (5), and (6) , and (6.5) of this subsection (c), |
|
then the 3-year average shall be used in calculating the |
amounts payable under this Section in place of the amounts |
shown in these categories for the specified year ending June |
30, as provided in paragraphs (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), and (6) , |
and (6.5) of this subsection (c). Any deficit because of State |
aid not yet received may not be considered in determining the |
June 30 deficits. The same basis of accounting shall be used by |
all previously existing districts and by all annexing or |
annexed districts, as constituted prior to the annexation, in |
making any computation required under paragraphs (1), (2), (3), |
(4), (5), and (6) , and (6.5) of this subsection (c). |
(8) The supplementary State aid payments under this |
subsection (c) shall be treated as separate from all other |
payments made pursuant to Section 18-8.05 of this Code. |
(d)(1) Following the formation of a combined school |
district, as defined in Section 11E-20 of this Code, a new |
elementary district or districts and a new high school district |
formed through a school district conversion, as defined in |
subsection (b) of Section 11E-15 of this Code, a new partial |
elementary unit district, as defined in Section 11E-30 of this |
Code, or a new elementary district or districts formed through |
a multi-unit conversion, as defined in subsection (b) of |
Section 11E-30 of this Code, or the annexation of all of the |
territory of one or more entire school districts by one or more |
other school districts, as defined in Article 7 of this Code, a |
supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid for the |
|
number of school years determined under the following table to |
each new or annexing district equal to the sum of $4,000 for |
each certified employee who is employed by the district on a |
full-time basis for the regular term of the school year: |
|
Reorganized District's Rank |
Reorganized District's Rank |
|
by type of district (unit, |
in Average Daily Attendance |
|
high school, elementary) |
By Quintile |
|
in Equalized Assessed Value |
|
|
|
|
Per Pupil by Quintile |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3rd, 4th, |
|
|
1st |
2nd |
or 5th |
|
|
Quintile |
Quintile |
Quintile |
|
1st Quintile |
1 year |
1 year |
1 year |
|
2nd Quintile |
1 year |
2 years |
2 years |
|
3rd Quintile |
2 years |
3 years |
3 years |
|
4th Quintile |
2 years |
3 years |
3 years |
|
5th Quintile |
2 years |
3 years |
3 years |
|
The State Board of Education shall make a one-time calculation |
of a reorganized district's quintile ranks. The average daily |
attendance used in this calculation shall be the best 3 months' |
average daily attendance for the district's first year. The |
equalized assessed value per pupil shall be the district's real |
property equalized assessed value used in calculating the |
district's first-year general State aid claim, under Section |
|
18-8.05 of this Code, divided by the best 3 months' average |
daily attendance. |
No annexing or resulting school district shall be entitled |
to supplementary State aid under this subsection (d) unless the |
district acquires at least 30% of the average daily attendance |
of the district from which the territory is being detached or |
divided. |
If a district results from multiple reorganizations that |
would otherwise qualify the district for multiple payments |
under this subsection (d) in any year, then the district shall |
receive a single payment only for that year based solely on the |
most recent reorganization. |
(2) For an elementary opt-in, as defined in subsection (d) |
of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the full-time certified staff |
incentive shall be computed in accordance with paragraph (1) of |
this subsection (d), equal to the sum of $4,000 for each |
certified employee of the elementary district that opts-in who |
is employed by the optional elementary unit district on a |
full-time basis for the regular term of the school year. The |
calculation from this paragraph (2) must be paid as follows: |
(A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
one year after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, 100% of the amount calculated in |
this paragraph (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary |
unit district for the number of years calculated in |
paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) at the optional |
|
elementary unit district's original effective date, |
starting in the second year after the effective date of the |
elementary opt-in. |
(B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
2 years after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, 75% of the amount calculated in |
this paragraph (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary |
unit district for the number of years calculated in |
paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) at the optional |
elementary unit district's original effective date, |
starting in the second year after the effective date of the |
elementary opt-in. |
(C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
3 years after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, 50% of the amount calculated in |
this paragraph (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary |
unit district for the number of years calculated in |
paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) at the optional |
elementary unit district's original effective date, |
starting in the second year after the effective date of the |
elementary opt-in. |
(D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
4 years after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, 25% of the amount calculated in |
this paragraph (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary |
unit district for the number of years calculated in |
|
paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) at the optional |
elementary unit district's original effective date, |
starting in the second year after the effective date of the |
elementary opt-in. |
(E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is |
5 years after the effective date for the optional |
elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit |
district is not eligible for any additional incentives due |
to the elementary opt-in. |
(2.5)
(a-5) Following the formation of a cooperative high |
school by 2 or more school districts under Section 10-22.22c of |
this Code, a supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be |
paid for 3 school years to the cooperative high school equal to |
the sum of $4,000 for each certified employee who is employed |
by the cooperative high school on a full-time basis for the |
regular term of any such school year. If a cooperative high |
school results from multiple agreements that would otherwise |
qualify the cooperative high school for multiple payments under |
this Section in any year, the cooperative high school shall |
receive a single payment for that year based solely on the most |
recent agreement. |
(2.10) Following the annexation of territory detached from
|
another school district whereby the enrollment of the annexing
|
district increases 90% or more as a result of the annexation, a
|
supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the
|
annexing district equal to the sum of $4,000 for each certified
|
|
employee who is employed by the annexing district on a
|
full-time basis and shall be calculated in accordance with
|
subsection (a) of this Section. To be eligible for
|
supplementary State aid reimbursement under this Section, the
|
intergovernmental agreement to be submitted pursuant to
|
Section 7-14A of this Code must show that certified staff
|
members were transferred from the control of the district
|
losing territory to the control of the district gaining
|
territory in the annexation. The changes to this Section made
|
by this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly are
|
intended to be retroactive and applicable to any annexation
|
taking effect on or after July 1, 2004. For annexations that |
are eligible for payments under this paragraph (2.10) and that |
are effective on or after July 1, 2004, but before the |
effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th General |
Assembly, the first required yearly payment under this |
paragraph (2.10) shall be paid in the second fiscal year after |
the effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th General |
Assembly. Any subsequent required yearly payments shall be paid |
in subsequent fiscal years until the payment obligation under |
this paragraph (2.10) is complete.
|
(3) The supplementary State aid reimbursement payable |
under this subsection (d) shall be separate from and in |
addition to all other payments made to the district pursuant to |
any other Section of this Article. |
(4) During May of each school year for which a |
|
supplementary State aid reimbursement is to be paid to a new or |
annexing school district or cooperative high school pursuant to |
this subsection (d), the school board or governing board shall |
certify to the State Board of Education, on forms furnished to |
the school board or governing board by the State Board of |
Education for purposes of this subsection (d), the number of |
certified employees for which the district or cooperative high |
school is entitled to reimbursement under this Section, |
together with the names, certificate numbers, and positions |
held by the certified employees. |
(5) Upon certification by the State Board of Education to |
the State Comptroller of the amount of the supplementary State |
aid reimbursement to which a school district or cooperative |
high school is entitled under this subsection (d), the State |
Comptroller shall draw his or her warrant upon the State |
Treasurer for the payment thereof to the school district or |
cooperative high school and shall promptly transmit the payment |
to the school district or cooperative high school through the |
appropriate school treasurer.
|
(Source: P.A. 94-1019, eff. 7-10-06; incorporates P.A. 94-902, |
eff. 7-1-06; revised 9-13-06.)
|
(105 ILCS 5/14-13.01) (from Ch. 122, par. 14-13.01)
|
Sec. 14-13.01. Reimbursement payable by State; Amounts. |
Reimbursement for furnishing special educational facilities in |
a
recognized school to the type of children defined in Section |
|
14-1.02
shall be paid to the school districts in accordance |
with Section 14-12.01
for each school year ending June 30 by |
the State Comptroller out of any money
in the treasury |
appropriated for such purposes on the presentation of vouchers
|
by the State Board of Education.
|
The reimbursement shall be limited to funds expended for |
construction
and maintenance of special education facilities |
designed and utilized to
house instructional programs, |
diagnostic services, other special
education services for |
children with disabilities and
reimbursement as
provided in |
Section 14-13.01. There shall be no reimbursement for
|
construction and maintenance of any administrative facility |
separated
from special education facilities designed and |
utilized to house
instructional programs, diagnostic services |
and other special education
services for children with |
disabilities.
|
(a) For children who have not been identified as eligible |
for special
education and for eligible children with physical
|
disabilities, including all
eligible children whose placement |
has been determined under Section 14-8.02 in
hospital or home |
instruction, 1/2 of the teacher's salary but not more than
|
$1,000 annually per child or $8,000 per teacher for the |
1985-1986 school year through the 2005-2006 school year and |
$1,000 per child or $9,000 per teacher for the 2006-2007 school |
year and for each school year
and thereafter, whichever is |
less. Children
to be included in any reimbursement under this |
|
paragraph must regularly
receive a minimum of one hour of |
instruction each school day, or in lieu
thereof of a minimum of |
5 hours of instruction in each school week in
order to qualify |
for full reimbursement under this Section. If the
attending |
physician for such a child has certified that the child should
|
not receive as many as 5 hours of instruction in a school week, |
however,
reimbursement under this paragraph on account of that |
child shall be
computed proportionate to the actual hours of |
instruction per week for
that child divided by 5.
|
(b) For children described in Section 14-1.02, 4/5 of the |
cost of
transportation for each such child, whom the State |
Superintendent of
Education determined in advance requires |
special transportation service
in order to take advantage of |
special educational facilities.
Transportation costs shall be |
determined in the same fashion as provided
in Section 29-5. For |
purposes of this subsection (b), the dates for
processing |
claims specified in Section 29-5 shall apply.
|
(c) For each professional worker excluding those included |
in
subparagraphs (a), (d), (e), and (f) of this Section, the |
annual sum of
$8,000 for the 1985-1986 school year through the |
2005-2006 school year and $9,000 for the 2006-2007 school year |
and for each school year and thereafter.
|
(d) For one full time qualified director of the special |
education
program of each school district which maintains a |
fully approved program
of special education the annual sum of |
$8,000 for the 1985-1986 school
year through the 2005-2006 |
|
school year and $9,000 for the 2006-2007 school year and for |
each school year and thereafter. Districts participating in a |
joint agreement special
education program shall not receive |
such reimbursement if reimbursement is made
for a director of |
the joint agreement program.
|
(e) For each school psychologist as defined in Section |
14-1.09 the
annual sum of $8,000 for the 1985-1986 school year |
through the 2005-2006 school year and $9,000 for the 2006-2007 |
school year and for each school year and thereafter.
|
(f) For each qualified teacher working in a fully approved |
program
for children of preschool age who are deaf or |
hard-of-hearing the annual
sum of $8,000 for the 1985-1986 |
school year through the 2005-2006 school year and $9,000 for |
the 2006-2007 school year and for each school year and |
thereafter.
|
(g) For readers, working with blind or partially seeing |
children 1/2
of their salary but not more than $400 annually |
per child. Readers may
be employed to assist such children and |
shall not be required to be
certified but prior to employment |
shall meet standards set up by the
State Board of Education.
|
(h) For necessary non-certified employees working in any |
class or
program for children defined in this Article, 1/2 of |
the salary paid or
$2,800 annually per employee through the |
2005-2006 school year and $3,500 per employee for the 2006-2007 |
school year and for each school year thereafter , whichever is |
less.
|
|
The State Board of Education shall set standards and |
prescribe rules
for determining the allocation of |
reimbursement under this section on
less than a full time basis |
and for less than a school year.
|
When any school district eligible for reimbursement under |
this
Section operates a school or program approved by the State
|
Superintendent of Education for a number of days in excess of |
the
adopted school calendar but not to exceed 235 school days, |
such
reimbursement shall be increased by 1/180 of the amount or |
rate paid
hereunder for each day such school is operated in |
excess of 180 days per
calendar year.
|
Notwithstanding any other provision of law, any school |
district receiving
a payment under this Section or under |
Section 14-7.02, 14-7.02b, or
29-5 of this Code may classify |
all or a portion of the funds that it receives
in a particular |
fiscal year or from general State aid pursuant to Section
|
18-8.05 of this Code as
funds received in connection with any |
funding program for which it is
entitled to receive funds from |
the State in that fiscal year (including,
without limitation, |
any funding program referenced in this Section),
regardless of |
the source or timing of the receipt. The district may not
|
classify more funds as funds received in connection with the |
funding
program than the district is entitled to receive in |
that fiscal year for that
program. Any
classification by a |
district must be made by a resolution of its board of
|
education. The resolution must identify the amount of any |
|
payments or
general State aid to be classified under this |
paragraph and must specify
the funding program to which the |
funds are to be treated as received in
connection therewith. |
This resolution is controlling as to the
classification of |
funds referenced therein. A certified copy of the
resolution |
must be sent to the State Superintendent of Education.
The |
resolution shall still take effect even though a copy of the |
resolution has
not been sent to the State
Superintendent of |
Education in a timely manner.
No
classification under this |
paragraph by a district shall affect the total amount
or timing |
of money the district is entitled to receive under this Code.
|
No classification under this paragraph by a district shall
in |
any way relieve the district from or affect any
requirements |
that otherwise would apply with respect to
that funding |
program, including any
accounting of funds by source, reporting |
expenditures by
original source and purpose,
reporting |
requirements,
or requirements of providing services.
|
(Source: P.A. 95-415, eff. 8-24-07.)
|
(105 ILCS 5/18-8.05)
|
Sec. 18-8.05. Basis for apportionment of general State |
financial aid and
supplemental general State aid to the common |
schools for the 1998-1999 and
subsequent school years.
|
(A) General Provisions.
|
(1) The provisions of this Section apply to the 1998-1999 |
|
and subsequent
school years. The system of general State |
financial aid provided for in this
Section
is designed to |
assure that, through a combination of State financial aid and
|
required local resources, the financial support provided each |
pupil in Average
Daily Attendance equals or exceeds a
|
prescribed per pupil Foundation Level. This formula approach |
imputes a level
of per pupil Available Local Resources and |
provides for the basis to calculate
a per pupil level of |
general State financial aid that, when added to Available
Local |
Resources, equals or exceeds the Foundation Level. The
amount |
of per pupil general State financial aid for school districts, |
in
general, varies in inverse
relation to Available Local |
Resources. Per pupil amounts are based upon
each school |
district's Average Daily Attendance as that term is defined in |
this
Section.
|
(2) In addition to general State financial aid, school |
districts with
specified levels or concentrations of pupils |
from low income households are
eligible to receive supplemental |
general State financial aid grants as provided
pursuant to |
subsection (H).
The supplemental State aid grants provided for |
school districts under
subsection (H) shall be appropriated for |
distribution to school districts as
part of the same line item |
in which the general State financial aid of school
districts is |
appropriated under this Section.
|
(3) To receive financial assistance under this Section, |
school districts
are required to file claims with the State |
|
Board of Education, subject to the
following requirements:
|
(a) Any school district which fails for any given |
school year to maintain
school as required by law, or to |
maintain a recognized school is not
eligible to file for |
such school year any claim upon the Common School
Fund. In |
case of nonrecognition of one or more attendance centers in |
a
school district otherwise operating recognized schools, |
the claim of the
district shall be reduced in the |
proportion which the Average Daily
Attendance in the |
attendance center or centers bear to the Average Daily
|
Attendance in the school district. A "recognized school" |
means any
public school which meets the standards as |
established for recognition
by the State Board of |
Education. A school district or attendance center
not |
having recognition status at the end of a school term is |
entitled to
receive State aid payments due upon a legal |
claim which was filed while
it was recognized.
|
(b) School district claims filed under this Section are |
subject to
Sections 18-9 and 18-12, except as otherwise |
provided in this
Section.
|
(c) If a school district operates a full year school |
under Section
10-19.1, the general State aid to the school |
district shall be determined
by the State Board of |
Education in accordance with this Section as near as
may be |
applicable.
|
(d) (Blank).
|
|
(4) Except as provided in subsections (H) and (L), the |
board of any district
receiving any of the grants provided for |
in this Section may apply those funds
to any fund so received |
for which that board is authorized to make expenditures
by law.
|
School districts are not required to exert a minimum |
Operating Tax Rate in
order to qualify for assistance under |
this Section.
|
(5) As used in this Section the following terms, when |
capitalized, shall
have the meaning ascribed herein:
|
(a) "Average Daily Attendance": A count of pupil |
attendance in school,
averaged as provided for in |
subsection (C) and utilized in deriving per pupil
financial |
support levels.
|
(b) "Available Local Resources": A computation of |
local financial
support, calculated on the basis of Average |
Daily Attendance and derived as
provided pursuant to |
subsection (D).
|
(c) "Corporate Personal Property Replacement Taxes": |
Funds paid to local
school districts pursuant to "An Act in |
relation to the abolition of ad valorem
personal property |
tax and the replacement of revenues lost thereby, and
|
amending and repealing certain Acts and parts of Acts in |
connection therewith",
certified August 14, 1979, as |
amended (Public Act 81-1st S.S.-1).
|
(d) "Foundation Level": A prescribed level of per pupil |
financial support
as provided for in subsection (B).
|
|
(e) "Operating Tax Rate": All school district property |
taxes extended for
all purposes, except Bond and
Interest, |
Summer School, Rent, Capital Improvement, and Vocational |
Education
Building purposes.
|
(B) Foundation Level.
|
(1) The Foundation Level is a figure established by the |
State representing
the minimum level of per pupil financial |
support that should be available to
provide for the basic |
education of each pupil in
Average Daily Attendance. As set |
forth in this Section, each school district
is assumed to exert
|
a sufficient local taxing effort such that, in combination with |
the aggregate
of general State
financial aid provided the |
district, an aggregate of State and local resources
are |
available to meet
the basic education needs of pupils in the |
district.
|
(2) For the 1998-1999 school year, the Foundation Level of |
support is
$4,225. For the 1999-2000 school year, the |
Foundation Level of support is
$4,325. For the 2000-2001 school |
year, the Foundation Level of support is
$4,425. For the |
2001-2002 school year and 2002-2003 school year, the
Foundation |
Level of support is $4,560. For the 2003-2004 school year, the |
Foundation Level of support is $4,810. For the 2004-2005 school |
year, the Foundation Level of support is $4,964.
For the |
2005-2006 school year,
the Foundation Level of support is |
$5,164. For the 2006-2007 school year, the Foundation Level of |
|
support is $5,334.
|
(3) For the 2007-2008
2006-2007 school year and each school |
year thereafter,
the Foundation Level of support is $5,734
|
$5,334 or such greater amount as
may be established by law by |
the General Assembly.
|
(C) Average Daily Attendance.
|
(1) For purposes of calculating general State aid pursuant |
to subsection
(E), an Average Daily Attendance figure shall be |
utilized. The Average Daily
Attendance figure for formula
|
calculation purposes shall be the monthly average of the actual |
number of
pupils in attendance of
each school district, as |
further averaged for the best 3 months of pupil
attendance for |
each
school district. In compiling the figures for the number |
of pupils in
attendance, school districts
and the State Board |
of Education shall, for purposes of general State aid
funding, |
conform
attendance figures to the requirements of subsection |
(F).
|
(2) The Average Daily Attendance figures utilized in |
subsection (E) shall be
the requisite attendance data for the |
school year immediately preceding
the
school year for which |
general State aid is being calculated
or the average of the |
attendance data for the 3 preceding school
years, whichever is |
greater. The Average Daily Attendance figures
utilized in |
subsection (H) shall be the requisite attendance data for the
|
school year immediately preceding the school year for which |
|
general
State aid is being calculated.
|
(D) Available Local Resources.
|
(1) For purposes of calculating general State aid pursuant |
to subsection
(E), a representation of Available Local |
Resources per pupil, as that term is
defined and determined in |
this subsection, shall be utilized. Available Local
Resources |
per pupil shall include a calculated
dollar amount representing |
local school district revenues from local property
taxes and |
from
Corporate Personal Property Replacement Taxes, expressed |
on the basis of pupils
in Average
Daily Attendance. Calculation |
of Available Local Resources shall exclude any tax amnesty |
funds received as a result of Public Act 93-26.
|
(2) In determining a school district's revenue from local |
property taxes,
the State Board of Education shall utilize the |
equalized assessed valuation of
all taxable property of each |
school
district as of September 30 of the previous year. The |
equalized assessed
valuation utilized shall
be obtained and |
determined as provided in subsection (G).
|
(3) For school districts maintaining grades kindergarten |
through 12, local
property tax
revenues per pupil shall be |
calculated as the product of the applicable
equalized assessed
|
valuation for the district multiplied by 3.00%, and divided by |
the district's
Average Daily
Attendance figure. For school |
districts maintaining grades kindergarten
through 8, local
|
property tax revenues per pupil shall be calculated as the |
|
product of the
applicable equalized
assessed valuation for the |
district multiplied by 2.30%, and divided by the
district's |
Average
Daily Attendance figure. For school districts |
maintaining grades 9 through 12,
local property
tax revenues |
per pupil shall be the applicable equalized assessed valuation |
of
the district
multiplied by 1.05%, and divided by the |
district's Average Daily
Attendance
figure.
|
For partial elementary unit districts created pursuant to |
Article 11E of this Code, local property tax revenues per pupil |
shall be calculated as the product of the equalized assessed |
valuation for property within the elementary and high school |
classification of the partial elementary unit district |
multiplied by 2.06% and divided by the Average Daily Attendance |
figure for grades kindergarten through 8, plus the product of |
the equalized assessed valuation for property within the high |
school only classification of the partial elementary unit |
district multiplied by 0.94% and divided by the Average Daily |
Attendance figure for grades 9 through 12.
|
(4) The Corporate Personal Property Replacement Taxes paid |
to each school
district during the calendar year 2 years before |
the calendar year in which a
school year begins, divided by the |
Average Daily Attendance figure for that
district, shall be |
added to the local property tax revenues per pupil as
derived |
by the application of the immediately preceding paragraph (3). |
The sum
of these per pupil figures for each school district |
shall constitute Available
Local Resources as that term is |
|
utilized in subsection (E) in the calculation
of general State |
aid.
|
(E) Computation of General State Aid.
|
(1) For each school year, the amount of general State aid |
allotted to a
school district shall be computed by the State |
Board of Education as provided
in this subsection.
|
(2) For any school district for which Available Local |
Resources per pupil
is less than the product of 0.93 times the |
Foundation Level, general State aid
for that district shall be |
calculated as an amount equal to the Foundation
Level minus |
Available Local Resources, multiplied by the Average Daily
|
Attendance of the school district.
|
(3) For any school district for which Available Local |
Resources per pupil
is equal to or greater than the product of |
0.93 times the Foundation Level and
less than the product of |
1.75 times the Foundation Level, the general State aid
per |
pupil shall be a decimal proportion of the Foundation Level |
derived using a
linear algorithm. Under this linear algorithm, |
the calculated general State
aid per pupil shall decline in |
direct linear fashion from 0.07 times the
Foundation Level for |
a school district with Available Local Resources equal to
the |
product of 0.93 times the Foundation Level, to 0.05 times the |
Foundation
Level for a school district with Available Local |
Resources equal to the product
of 1.75 times the Foundation |
Level. The allocation of general
State aid for school districts |
|
subject to this paragraph 3 shall be the
calculated general |
State aid
per pupil figure multiplied by the Average Daily |
Attendance of the school
district.
|
(4) For any school district for which Available Local |
Resources per pupil
equals or exceeds the product of 1.75 times |
the Foundation Level, the general
State aid for the school |
district shall be calculated as the product of $218
multiplied |
by the Average Daily Attendance of the school
district.
|
(5) The amount of general State aid allocated to a school |
district for
the 1999-2000 school year meeting the requirements |
set forth in paragraph (4)
of subsection
(G) shall be increased |
by an amount equal to the general State aid that
would have |
been received by the district for the 1998-1999 school year by
|
utilizing the Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed |
Valuation as calculated
in paragraph (4) of subsection (G) less |
the general State aid allotted for the
1998-1999
school year. |
This amount shall be deemed a one time increase, and shall not
|
affect any future general State aid allocations.
|
(F) Compilation of Average Daily Attendance.
|
(1) Each school district shall, by July 1 of each year, |
submit to the State
Board of Education, on forms prescribed by |
the State Board of Education,
attendance figures for the school |
year that began in the preceding calendar
year. The attendance |
information so transmitted shall identify the average
daily |
attendance figures for each month of the school year. Beginning |
|
with
the general State aid claim form for the 2002-2003 school
|
year, districts shall calculate Average Daily Attendance as |
provided in
subdivisions (a), (b), and (c) of this paragraph |
(1).
|
(a) In districts that do not hold year-round classes,
|
days of attendance in August shall be added to the month of |
September and any
days of attendance in June shall be added |
to the month of May.
|
(b) In districts in which all buildings hold year-round |
classes,
days of attendance in July and August shall be |
added to the month
of September and any days of attendance |
in June shall be added to
the month of May.
|
(c) In districts in which some buildings, but not all, |
hold
year-round classes, for the non-year-round buildings, |
days of
attendance in August shall be added to the month of |
September
and any days of attendance in June shall be added |
to the month of
May. The average daily attendance for the |
year-round buildings
shall be computed as provided in |
subdivision (b) of this paragraph
(1). To calculate the |
Average Daily Attendance for the district, the
average |
daily attendance for the year-round buildings shall be
|
multiplied by the days in session for the non-year-round |
buildings
for each month and added to the monthly |
attendance of the
non-year-round buildings.
|
Except as otherwise provided in this Section, days of
|
attendance by pupils shall be counted only for sessions of not |
|
less than
5 clock hours of school work per day under direct |
supervision of: (i)
teachers, or (ii) non-teaching personnel or |
volunteer personnel when engaging
in non-teaching duties and |
supervising in those instances specified in
subsection (a) of |
Section 10-22.34 and paragraph 10 of Section 34-18, with
pupils |
of legal school age and in kindergarten and grades 1 through |
12.
|
Days of attendance by tuition pupils shall be accredited |
only to the
districts that pay the tuition to a recognized |
school.
|
(2) Days of attendance by pupils of less than 5 clock hours |
of school
shall be subject to the following provisions in the |
compilation of Average
Daily Attendance.
|
(a) Pupils regularly enrolled in a public school for |
only a part of
the school day may be counted on the basis |
of 1/6 day for every class hour
of instruction of 40 |
minutes or more attended pursuant to such enrollment,
|
unless a pupil is
enrolled in a block-schedule format of 80 |
minutes or more of instruction,
in which case the pupil may |
be counted on the basis of the proportion of
minutes of |
school work completed each day to the minimum number of
|
minutes that school work is required to be held that day.
|
(b) Days of attendance may be less than 5 clock hours |
on the opening
and closing of the school term, and upon the |
first day of pupil
attendance, if preceded by a day or days |
utilized as an institute or
teachers' workshop.
|
|
(c) A session of 4 or more clock hours may be counted |
as a day of
attendance upon certification by the regional |
superintendent, and
approved by the State Superintendent |
of Education to the extent that the
district has been |
forced to use daily multiple sessions.
|
(d) A session of 3 or more clock hours may be counted |
as a day of
attendance (1) when the remainder of the school |
day or at least
2 hours in the evening of that day is |
utilized for an
in-service training program for teachers, |
up to a maximum of 5 days per
school year of which a |
maximum of 4 days of such 5 days may be used for
|
parent-teacher conferences, provided a district conducts |
an in-service
training program for teachers which has been |
approved by the State
Superintendent of Education; or, in |
lieu of 4 such days, 2 full days may
be used, in which |
event each such day
may be counted as a day of attendance; |
and (2) when days in
addition to
those provided in item (1) |
are scheduled by a school pursuant to its school
|
improvement plan adopted under Article 34 or its revised or |
amended school
improvement plan adopted under Article 2, |
provided that (i) such sessions of
3 or more clock hours |
are scheduled to occur at regular intervals, (ii) the
|
remainder of the school days in which such sessions occur |
are utilized
for in-service training programs or other |
staff development activities for
teachers, and (iii) a |
sufficient number of minutes of school work under the
|
|
direct supervision of teachers are added to the school days |
between such
regularly scheduled sessions to accumulate |
not less than the number of minutes
by which such sessions |
of 3 or more clock hours fall short of 5 clock hours.
Any |
full days used for the purposes of this paragraph shall not |
be considered
for
computing average daily attendance. Days |
scheduled for in-service training
programs, staff |
development activities, or parent-teacher conferences may |
be
scheduled separately for different
grade levels and |
different attendance centers of the district.
|
(e) A session of not less than one clock hour of |
teaching
hospitalized or homebound pupils on-site or by |
telephone to the classroom may
be counted as 1/2 day of |
attendance, however these pupils must receive 4 or
more |
clock hours of instruction to be counted for a full day of |
attendance.
|
(f) A session of at least 4 clock hours may be counted |
as a day of
attendance for first grade pupils, and pupils |
in full day kindergartens,
and a session of 2 or more hours |
may be counted as 1/2 day of attendance by
pupils in |
kindergartens which provide only 1/2 day of attendance.
|
(g) For children with disabilities who are below the |
age of 6 years and
who
cannot attend 2 or more clock hours |
because of their disability or
immaturity, a session of not |
less than one clock hour may be counted as 1/2 day
of |
attendance; however for such children whose educational |
|
needs so require
a session of 4 or more clock hours may be |
counted as a full day of attendance.
|
(h) A recognized kindergarten which provides for only |
1/2 day of
attendance by each pupil shall not have more |
than 1/2 day of attendance
counted in any one day. However, |
kindergartens may count 2 1/2 days
of
attendance in any 5 |
consecutive school days. When a pupil attends such a
|
kindergarten for 2 half days on any one school day, the |
pupil shall have
the following day as a day absent from |
school, unless the school district
obtains permission in |
writing from the State Superintendent of Education.
|
Attendance at kindergartens which provide for a full day of |
attendance by
each pupil shall be counted the same as |
attendance by first grade pupils.
Only the first year of |
attendance in one kindergarten shall be counted,
except in |
case of children who entered the kindergarten in their |
fifth year
whose educational development requires a second |
year of kindergarten as
determined under the rules and |
regulations of the State Board of Education.
|
(i) On the days when the Prairie State Achievement |
Examination is
administered under subsection (c) of |
Section 2-3.64 of this Code, the day
of attendance for a |
pupil whose school
day must be shortened to accommodate |
required testing procedures may
be less than 5 clock hours |
and shall be counted towards the 176 days of actual pupil |
attendance required under Section 10-19 of this Code, |
|
provided that a sufficient number of minutes
of school work |
in excess of 5 clock hours are first completed on other |
school
days to compensate for the loss of school work on |
the examination days.
|
(G) Equalized Assessed Valuation Data.
|
(1) For purposes of the calculation of Available Local |
Resources required
pursuant to subsection (D), the
State Board |
of Education shall secure from the Department of
Revenue the |
value as equalized or assessed by the Department of Revenue of
|
all taxable property of every school district, together with |
(i) the applicable
tax rate used in extending taxes for the |
funds of the district as of
September 30 of the previous year
|
and (ii) the limiting rate for all school
districts subject to |
property tax extension limitations as imposed under the
|
Property Tax Extension Limitation Law.
|
The Department of Revenue shall add to the equalized |
assessed value of all
taxable
property of each school district |
situated entirely or partially within a county
that is or was |
subject to the alternative general homestead exemption |
provisions of Section 15-176 of the Property Tax Code (a)
an |
amount equal to the total amount by which the
homestead |
exemption allowed under Section 15-176 of the Property Tax Code |
for
real
property situated in that school district exceeds the |
total amount that would
have been
allowed in that school |
district if the maximum reduction under Section 15-176
was
(i) |
|
$4,500 in Cook County or $3,500 in all other counties in tax |
year 2003 or (ii) $5,000 in all counties in tax year 2004 and |
thereafter and (b) an amount equal to the aggregate amount for |
the taxable year of all additional exemptions under Section |
15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with a household |
income of $30,000 or less. The county clerk of any county that |
is or was subject to the alternative general homestead |
exemption provisions of Section 15-176 of the Property Tax Code |
shall
annually calculate and certify to the Department of |
Revenue for each school
district all
homestead exemption |
amounts under Section 15-176 of the Property Tax Code and all |
amounts of additional exemptions under Section 15-175 of the |
Property Tax Code for owners with a household income of $30,000 |
or less. It is the intent of this paragraph that if the general |
homestead exemption for a parcel of property is determined |
under Section 15-176 of the Property Tax Code rather than |
Section 15-175, then the calculation of Available Local |
Resources shall not be affected by the difference, if any, |
between the amount of the general homestead exemption allowed |
for that parcel of property under Section 15-176 of the |
Property Tax Code and the amount that would have been allowed |
had the general homestead exemption for that parcel of property |
been determined under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code. |
It is further the intent of this paragraph that if additional |
exemptions are allowed under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax |
Code for owners with a household income of less than $30,000, |
|
then the calculation of Available Local Resources shall not be |
affected by the difference, if any, because of those additional |
exemptions.
|
This equalized assessed valuation, as adjusted further by |
the requirements of
this subsection, shall be utilized in the |
calculation of Available Local
Resources.
|
(2) The equalized assessed valuation in paragraph (1) shall |
be adjusted, as
applicable, in the following manner:
|
(a) For the purposes of calculating State aid under |
this Section,
with respect to any part of a school district |
within a redevelopment
project area in respect to which a |
municipality has adopted tax
increment allocation |
financing pursuant to the Tax Increment Allocation
|
Redevelopment Act, Sections 11-74.4-1 through 11-74.4-11 |
of the Illinois
Municipal Code or the Industrial Jobs |
Recovery Law, Sections 11-74.6-1 through
11-74.6-50 of the |
Illinois Municipal Code, no part of the current equalized
|
assessed valuation of real property located in any such |
project area which is
attributable to an increase above the |
total initial equalized assessed
valuation of such |
property shall be used as part of the equalized assessed
|
valuation of the district, until such time as all
|
redevelopment project costs have been paid, as provided in |
Section 11-74.4-8
of the Tax Increment Allocation |
Redevelopment Act or in Section 11-74.6-35 of
the |
Industrial Jobs Recovery Law. For the purpose of
the |
|
equalized assessed valuation of the
district, the total |
initial equalized assessed valuation or the current
|
equalized assessed valuation, whichever is lower, shall be |
used until
such time as all redevelopment project costs |
have been paid.
|
(b) The real property equalized assessed valuation for |
a school district
shall be adjusted by subtracting from the |
real property
value as equalized or assessed by the |
Department of Revenue for the
district an amount computed |
by dividing the amount of any abatement of
taxes under |
Section 18-170 of the Property Tax Code by 3.00% for a |
district
maintaining grades kindergarten through 12, by |
2.30% for a district
maintaining grades kindergarten |
through 8, or by 1.05% for a
district
maintaining grades 9 |
through 12 and adjusted by an amount computed by dividing
|
the amount of any abatement of taxes under subsection (a) |
of Section 18-165 of
the Property Tax Code by the same |
percentage rates for district type as
specified in this |
subparagraph (b).
|
(3) For the 1999-2000 school year and each school year |
thereafter, if a
school district meets all of the criteria of |
this subsection (G)(3), the school
district's Available Local |
Resources shall be calculated under subsection (D)
using the |
district's Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation |
as
calculated under this
subsection (G)(3).
|
For purposes of this subsection (G)(3) the following terms |
|
shall have
the following meanings:
|
"Budget Year": The school year for which general State |
aid is calculated
and
awarded under subsection (E).
|
"Base Tax Year": The property tax levy year used to |
calculate the Budget
Year
allocation of general State aid.
|
"Preceding Tax Year": The property tax levy year |
immediately preceding the
Base Tax Year.
|
"Base Tax Year's Tax Extension": The product of the |
equalized assessed
valuation utilized by the County Clerk |
in the Base Tax Year multiplied by the
limiting rate as |
calculated by the County Clerk and defined in the Property |
Tax
Extension Limitation Law.
|
"Preceding Tax Year's Tax Extension": The product of |
the equalized assessed
valuation utilized by the County |
Clerk in the Preceding Tax Year multiplied by
the Operating |
Tax Rate as defined in subsection (A).
|
"Extension Limitation Ratio": A numerical ratio, |
certified by the
County Clerk, in which the numerator is |
the Base Tax Year's Tax
Extension and the denominator is |
the Preceding Tax Year's Tax Extension.
|
"Operating Tax Rate": The operating tax rate as defined |
in subsection (A).
|
If a school district is subject to property tax extension |
limitations as
imposed under
the Property Tax Extension |
Limitation Law, the State Board of Education shall
calculate |
the Extension
Limitation
Equalized Assessed Valuation of that |
|
district. For the 1999-2000 school
year, the
Extension |
Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation of a school district as
|
calculated by the State Board of Education shall be equal to |
the product of the
district's 1996 Equalized Assessed Valuation |
and the district's Extension
Limitation Ratio. For the |
2000-2001 school year and each school year
thereafter,
the |
Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation of a school |
district as
calculated by the State Board of Education shall be |
equal to the product of
the Equalized Assessed Valuation last |
used in the calculation of general State
aid and the
district's |
Extension Limitation Ratio. If the Extension Limitation
|
Equalized
Assessed Valuation of a school district as calculated |
under
this subsection (G)(3) is less than the district's |
equalized assessed valuation
as calculated pursuant to |
subsections (G)(1) and (G)(2), then for purposes of
calculating |
the district's general State aid for the Budget Year pursuant |
to
subsection (E), that Extension
Limitation Equalized |
Assessed Valuation shall be utilized to calculate the
|
district's Available Local Resources
under subsection (D).
|
Partial elementary unit districts created in accordance |
with Article 11E of this Code shall not be eligible for the |
adjustment in this subsection (G)(3) until the fifth year |
following the effective date of the reorganization.
|
(4) For the purposes of calculating general State aid for |
the 1999-2000
school year only, if a school district |
experienced a triennial reassessment on
the equalized assessed |
|
valuation used in calculating its general State
financial aid |
apportionment for the 1998-1999 school year, the State Board of
|
Education shall calculate the Extension Limitation Equalized |
Assessed Valuation
that would have been used to calculate the |
district's 1998-1999 general State
aid. This amount shall equal |
the product of the equalized assessed valuation
used to
|
calculate general State aid for the 1997-1998 school year and |
the district's
Extension Limitation Ratio. If the Extension |
Limitation Equalized Assessed
Valuation of the school district |
as calculated under this paragraph (4) is
less than the |
district's equalized assessed valuation utilized in |
calculating
the
district's 1998-1999 general State aid |
allocation, then for purposes of
calculating the district's |
general State aid pursuant to paragraph (5) of
subsection (E),
|
that Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation shall |
be utilized to
calculate the district's Available Local |
Resources.
|
(5) For school districts having a majority of their |
equalized assessed
valuation in any county except Cook, DuPage, |
Kane, Lake, McHenry, or Will, if
the amount of general State |
aid allocated to the school district for the
1999-2000 school |
year under the provisions of subsection (E), (H), and (J) of
|
this Section is less than the amount of general State aid |
allocated to the
district for the 1998-1999 school year under |
these subsections, then the
general
State aid of the district |
for the 1999-2000 school year only shall be increased
by the |
|
difference between these amounts. The total payments made under |
this
paragraph (5) shall not exceed $14,000,000. Claims shall |
be prorated if they
exceed $14,000,000.
|
(H) Supplemental General State Aid.
|
(1) In addition to the general State aid a school district |
is allotted
pursuant to subsection (E), qualifying school |
districts shall receive a grant,
paid in conjunction with a |
district's payments of general State aid, for
supplemental |
general State aid based upon the concentration level of |
children
from low-income households within the school |
district.
Supplemental State aid grants provided for school |
districts under this
subsection shall be appropriated for |
distribution to school districts as part
of the same line item |
in which the general State financial aid of school
districts is |
appropriated under this Section.
If the appropriation in any |
fiscal year for general State aid and
supplemental general |
State aid is insufficient to pay the amounts required
under the |
general State aid and supplemental general State aid |
calculations,
then the
State Board of Education shall ensure |
that
each school district receives the full amount due for |
general State aid
and the remainder of the appropriation shall |
be used
for supplemental general State aid, which the State |
Board of Education shall
calculate and pay to eligible |
districts on a prorated basis.
|
(1.5) This paragraph (1.5) applies only to those school |
|
years
preceding the 2003-2004 school year.
For purposes of this
|
subsection (H), the term "Low-Income Concentration Level" |
shall be the
low-income
eligible pupil count from the most |
recently available federal census divided by
the Average Daily |
Attendance of the school district.
If, however, (i) the |
percentage decrease from the 2 most recent federal
censuses
in |
the low-income eligible pupil count of a high school district |
with fewer
than 400 students exceeds by 75% or more the |
percentage change in the total
low-income eligible pupil count |
of contiguous elementary school districts,
whose boundaries |
are coterminous with the high school district,
or (ii) a high |
school district within 2 counties and serving 5 elementary
|
school
districts, whose boundaries are coterminous with the |
high school
district, has a percentage decrease from the 2 most |
recent federal
censuses in the low-income eligible pupil count |
and there is a percentage
increase in the total low-income |
eligible pupil count of a majority of the
elementary school |
districts in excess of 50% from the 2 most recent
federal |
censuses, then
the
high school district's low-income eligible |
pupil count from the earlier federal
census
shall be the number |
used as the low-income eligible pupil count for the high
school |
district, for purposes of this subsection (H).
The changes made |
to this paragraph (1) by Public Act 92-28 shall apply to
|
supplemental general State aid
grants for school years |
preceding the 2003-2004 school year that are paid
in fiscal |
year 1999 or thereafter
and to
any State aid payments made in |
|
fiscal year 1994 through fiscal year
1998 pursuant to |
subsection 1(n) of Section 18-8 of this Code (which was
|
repealed on July 1, 1998), and any high school district that is |
affected by
Public Act 92-28 is
entitled to a
recomputation of |
its supplemental general State aid grant or State aid
paid in |
any of those fiscal years. This recomputation shall not be
|
affected by any other funding.
|
(1.10) This paragraph (1.10) applies to the 2003-2004 |
school year
and each school year thereafter. For purposes of |
this subsection (H), the
term "Low-Income Concentration Level" |
shall, for each fiscal year, be the
low-income eligible
pupil |
count
as of July 1 of the immediately preceding fiscal year
(as |
determined by the Department of Human Services based
on the |
number of pupils
who are eligible for at least one of the |
following
low income programs: Medicaid, KidCare, TANF, or Food |
Stamps,
excluding pupils who are eligible for services provided |
by the Department
of Children and Family Services,
averaged |
over
the 2 immediately preceding fiscal years for fiscal year |
2004 and over the 3
immediately preceding fiscal years for each |
fiscal year thereafter)
divided by the Average Daily Attendance |
of the school district.
|
(2) Supplemental general State aid pursuant to this |
subsection (H) shall
be
provided as follows for the 1998-1999, |
1999-2000, and 2000-2001 school years
only:
|
(a) For any school district with a Low Income |
Concentration Level of at
least 20% and less than 35%, the |
|
grant for any school year
shall be $800
multiplied by the |
low income eligible pupil count.
|
(b) For any school district with a Low Income |
Concentration Level of at
least 35% and less than 50%, the |
grant for the 1998-1999 school year shall be
$1,100 |
multiplied by the low income eligible pupil count.
|
(c) For any school district with a Low Income |
Concentration Level of at
least 50% and less than 60%, the |
grant for the 1998-99 school year shall be
$1,500 |
multiplied by the low income eligible pupil count.
|
(d) For any school district with a Low Income |
Concentration Level of 60%
or more, the grant for the |
1998-99 school year shall be $1,900 multiplied by
the low |
income eligible pupil count.
|
(e) For the 1999-2000 school year, the per pupil amount |
specified in
subparagraphs (b), (c), and (d) immediately |
above shall be increased to $1,243,
$1,600, and $2,000, |
respectively.
|
(f) For the 2000-2001 school year, the per pupil |
amounts specified in
subparagraphs (b), (c), and (d) |
immediately above shall be
$1,273, $1,640, and $2,050, |
respectively.
|
(2.5) Supplemental general State aid pursuant to this |
subsection (H)
shall be provided as follows for the 2002-2003 |
school year:
|
(a) For any school district with a Low Income |
|
Concentration Level of less
than 10%, the grant for each |
school year shall be $355 multiplied by the low
income |
eligible pupil count.
|
(b) For any school district with a Low Income |
Concentration
Level of at least 10% and less than 20%, the |
grant for each school year shall
be $675
multiplied by the |
low income eligible pupil
count.
|
(c) For any school district with a Low Income |
Concentration
Level of at least 20% and less than 35%, the |
grant for each school year shall
be $1,330
multiplied by |
the low income eligible pupil
count.
|
(d) For any school district with a Low Income |
Concentration
Level of at least 35% and less than 50%, the |
grant for each school year shall
be $1,362
multiplied by |
the low income eligible pupil
count.
|
(e) For any school district with a Low Income |
Concentration
Level of at least 50% and less than 60%, the |
grant for each school year shall
be $1,680
multiplied by |
the low income eligible pupil
count.
|
(f) For any school district with a Low Income |
Concentration
Level of 60% or more, the grant for each |
school year shall be $2,080
multiplied by the low income |
eligible pupil count.
|
(2.10) Except as otherwise provided, supplemental general |
State aid
pursuant to this subsection
(H) shall be provided as |
follows for the 2003-2004 school year and each
school year |
|
thereafter:
|
(a) For any school district with a Low Income |
Concentration
Level of 15% or less, the grant for each |
school year
shall be $355 multiplied by the low income |
eligible pupil count.
|
(b) For any school district with a Low Income |
Concentration
Level greater than 15%, the grant for each |
school year shall be
$294.25 added to the product of $2,700 |
and the square of the Low
Income Concentration Level, all |
multiplied by the low income
eligible pupil count.
|
For the 2003-2004 school year and each school year through |
the 2007-2008 school year , 2004-2005 school year,
2005-2006 |
school year, and 2006-2007 school year only, the grant shall be |
no less than the
grant
for
the 2002-2003 school year. For the |
2008-2009
2007-2008 school year only, the grant shall
be no
|
less than the grant for the 2002-2003 school year multiplied by |
0.66. For the
2009-2010
2008-2009
school year only, the grant |
shall be no less than the grant for the 2002-2003
school year
|
multiplied by 0.33. Notwithstanding the provisions of this |
paragraph to the contrary, if for any school year supplemental |
general State aid grants are prorated as provided in paragraph |
(1) of this subsection (H), then the grants under this |
paragraph shall be prorated.
|
For the 2003-2004 school year only, the grant shall be no |
greater
than the grant received during the 2002-2003 school |
year added to the
product of 0.25 multiplied by the difference |
|
between the grant amount
calculated under subsection (a) or (b) |
of this paragraph (2.10), whichever
is applicable, and the |
grant received during the 2002-2003 school year.
For the |
2004-2005 school year only, the grant shall be no greater than
|
the grant received during the 2002-2003 school year added to |
the
product of 0.50 multiplied by the difference between the |
grant amount
calculated under subsection (a) or (b) of this |
paragraph (2.10), whichever
is applicable, and the grant |
received during the 2002-2003 school year.
For the 2005-2006 |
school year only, the grant shall be no greater than
the grant |
received during the 2002-2003 school year added to the
product |
of 0.75 multiplied by the difference between the grant amount
|
calculated under subsection (a) or (b) of this paragraph |
(2.10), whichever
is applicable, and the grant received during |
the 2002-2003
school year.
|
(3) School districts with an Average Daily Attendance of |
more than 1,000
and less than 50,000 that qualify for |
supplemental general State aid pursuant
to this subsection |
shall submit a plan to the State Board of Education prior to
|
October 30 of each year for the use of the funds resulting from |
this grant of
supplemental general State aid for the |
improvement of
instruction in which priority is given to |
meeting the education needs of
disadvantaged children. Such |
plan shall be submitted in accordance with
rules and |
regulations promulgated by the State Board of Education.
|
(4) School districts with an Average Daily Attendance of |
|
50,000 or more
that qualify for supplemental general State aid |
pursuant to this subsection
shall be required to distribute |
from funds available pursuant to this Section,
no less than |
$261,000,000 in accordance with the following requirements:
|
(a) The required amounts shall be distributed to the |
attendance centers
within the district in proportion to the |
number of pupils enrolled at each
attendance center who are |
eligible to receive free or reduced-price lunches or
|
breakfasts under the federal Child Nutrition Act of 1966 |
and under the National
School Lunch Act during the |
immediately preceding school year.
|
(b) The distribution of these portions of supplemental |
and general State
aid among attendance centers according to |
these requirements shall not be
compensated for or |
contravened by adjustments of the total of other funds
|
appropriated to any attendance centers, and the Board of |
Education shall
utilize funding from one or several sources |
in order to fully implement this
provision annually prior |
to the opening of school.
|
(c) Each attendance center shall be provided by the
|
school district a distribution of noncategorical funds and |
other
categorical funds to which an attendance center is |
entitled under law in
order that the general State aid and |
supplemental general State aid provided
by application of |
this subsection supplements rather than supplants the
|
noncategorical funds and other categorical funds provided |
|
by the school
district to the attendance centers.
|
(d) Any funds made available under this subsection that |
by reason of the
provisions of this subsection are not
|
required to be allocated and provided to attendance centers |
may be used and
appropriated by the board of the district |
for any lawful school purpose.
|
(e) Funds received by an attendance center
pursuant to |
this
subsection shall be used
by the attendance center at |
the discretion
of the principal and local school council |
for programs to improve educational
opportunities at |
qualifying schools through the following programs and
|
services: early childhood education, reduced class size or |
improved adult to
student classroom ratio, enrichment |
programs, remedial assistance, attendance
improvement, and |
other educationally beneficial expenditures which
|
supplement
the regular and basic programs as determined by |
the State Board of Education.
Funds provided shall not be |
expended for any political or lobbying purposes
as defined |
by board rule.
|
(f) Each district subject to the provisions of this |
subdivision (H)(4)
shall submit an
acceptable plan to meet |
the educational needs of disadvantaged children, in
|
compliance with the requirements of this paragraph, to the |
State Board of
Education prior to July 15 of each year. |
This plan shall be consistent with the
decisions of local |
school councils concerning the school expenditure plans
|
|
developed in accordance with part 4 of Section 34-2.3. The |
State Board shall
approve or reject the plan within 60 days |
after its submission. If the plan is
rejected, the district |
shall give written notice of intent to modify the plan
|
within 15 days of the notification of rejection and then |
submit a modified plan
within 30 days after the date of the |
written notice of intent to modify.
Districts may amend |
approved plans pursuant to rules promulgated by the State
|
Board of Education.
|
Upon notification by the State Board of Education that |
the district has
not submitted a plan prior to July 15 or a |
modified plan within the time
period specified herein, the
|
State aid funds affected by that plan or modified plan |
shall be withheld by the
State Board of Education until a |
plan or modified plan is submitted.
|
If the district fails to distribute State aid to |
attendance centers in
accordance with an approved plan, the |
plan for the following year shall
allocate funds, in |
addition to the funds otherwise required by this
|
subsection, to those attendance centers which were |
underfunded during the
previous year in amounts equal to |
such underfunding.
|
For purposes of determining compliance with this |
subsection in relation
to the requirements of attendance |
center funding, each district subject to the
provisions of |
this
subsection shall submit as a separate document by |
|
December 1 of each year a
report of expenditure data for |
the prior year in addition to any
modification of its |
current plan. If it is determined that there has been
a |
failure to comply with the expenditure provisions of this |
subsection
regarding contravention or supplanting, the |
State Superintendent of
Education shall, within 60 days of |
receipt of the report, notify the
district and any affected |
local school council. The district shall within
45 days of |
receipt of that notification inform the State |
Superintendent of
Education of the remedial or corrective |
action to be taken, whether by
amendment of the current |
plan, if feasible, or by adjustment in the plan
for the |
following year. Failure to provide the expenditure report |
or the
notification of remedial or corrective action in a |
timely manner shall
result in a withholding of the affected |
funds.
|
The State Board of Education shall promulgate rules and |
regulations
to implement the provisions of this |
subsection. No funds shall be released
under this |
subdivision (H)(4) to any district that has not submitted a |
plan
that has been approved by the State Board of |
Education.
|
(I) (Blank).
|
(J) Supplementary Grants in Aid.
|
|
(1) Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Section, |
the amount of the
aggregate general State aid in combination |
with supplemental general State aid
under this Section for |
which
each school district is eligible shall be no
less than |
the amount of the aggregate general State aid entitlement that |
was
received by the district under Section
18-8 (exclusive of |
amounts received
under subsections 5(p) and 5(p-5) of that |
Section)
for the 1997-98 school year,
pursuant to the |
provisions of that Section as it was then in effect.
If a |
school district qualifies to receive a supplementary payment |
made under
this subsection (J), the amount
of the aggregate |
general State aid in combination with supplemental general
|
State aid under this Section
which that district is eligible to |
receive for each school year shall be no less than the amount |
of the aggregate
general State aid entitlement that was |
received by the district under
Section 18-8 (exclusive of |
amounts received
under subsections 5(p) and 5(p-5) of that |
Section)
for the 1997-1998 school year, pursuant to the |
provisions of that
Section as it was then in effect.
|
(2) If, as provided in paragraph (1) of this subsection |
(J), a school
district is to receive aggregate general State |
aid in
combination with supplemental general State aid under |
this Section for the 1998-99 school year and any subsequent |
school
year that in any such school year is less than the |
amount of the aggregate
general
State
aid entitlement that the |
district received for the 1997-98 school year, the
school |
|
district shall also receive, from a separate appropriation made |
for
purposes of this subsection (J), a supplementary payment |
that is equal to the
amount of the difference in the aggregate |
State aid figures as described in
paragraph (1).
|
(3) (Blank).
|
(K) Grants to Laboratory and Alternative Schools.
|
In calculating the amount to be paid to the governing board |
of a public
university that operates a laboratory school under |
this Section or to any
alternative school that is operated by a |
regional superintendent of schools,
the State
Board of |
Education shall require by rule such reporting requirements as |
it
deems necessary.
|
As used in this Section, "laboratory school" means a public |
school which is
created and operated by a public university and |
approved by the State Board of
Education. The governing board |
of a public university which receives funds
from the State |
Board under this subsection (K) may not increase the number of
|
students enrolled in its laboratory
school from a single |
district, if that district is already sending 50 or more
|
students, except under a mutual agreement between the school |
board of a
student's district of residence and the university |
which operates the
laboratory school. A laboratory school may |
not have more than 1,000 students,
excluding students with |
disabilities in a special education program.
|
As used in this Section, "alternative school" means a |
|
public school which is
created and operated by a Regional |
Superintendent of Schools and approved by
the State Board of |
Education. Such alternative schools may offer courses of
|
instruction for which credit is given in regular school |
programs, courses to
prepare students for the high school |
equivalency testing program or vocational
and occupational |
training. A regional superintendent of schools may contract
|
with a school district or a public community college district |
to operate an
alternative school. An alternative school serving |
more than one educational
service region may be established by |
the regional superintendents of schools
of the affected |
educational service regions. An alternative school
serving |
more than one educational service region may be operated under |
such
terms as the regional superintendents of schools of those |
educational service
regions may agree.
|
Each laboratory and alternative school shall file, on forms |
provided by the
State Superintendent of Education, an annual |
State aid claim which states the
Average Daily Attendance of |
the school's students by month. The best 3 months'
Average |
Daily Attendance shall be computed for each school.
The general |
State aid entitlement shall be computed by multiplying the
|
applicable Average Daily Attendance by the Foundation Level as |
determined under
this Section.
|
(L) Payments, Additional Grants in Aid and Other Requirements.
|
(1) For a school district operating under the financial |
|
supervision
of an Authority created under Article 34A, the |
general State aid otherwise
payable to that district under this |
Section, but not the supplemental general
State aid, shall be |
reduced by an amount equal to the budget for
the operations of |
the Authority as certified by the Authority to the State
Board |
of Education, and an amount equal to such reduction shall be |
paid
to the Authority created for such district for its |
operating expenses in
the manner provided in Section 18-11. The |
remainder
of general State school aid for any such district |
shall be paid in accordance
with Article 34A when that Article |
provides for a disposition other than that
provided by this |
Article.
|
(2) (Blank).
|
(3) Summer school. Summer school payments shall be made as |
provided in
Section 18-4.3.
|
(M) Education Funding Advisory Board.
|
The Education Funding Advisory
Board, hereinafter in this |
subsection (M) referred to as the "Board", is hereby
created. |
The Board
shall consist of 5 members who are appointed by the |
Governor, by and with the
advice and consent of the Senate. The |
members appointed shall include
representatives of education, |
business, and the general public. One of the
members so |
appointed shall be
designated by the Governor at the time the |
appointment is made as the
chairperson of the
Board.
The |
initial members of the Board may
be appointed any time after |
|
the effective date of this amendatory Act of
1997. The regular |
term of each member of the
Board shall be for 4 years from the |
third Monday of January of the
year in which the term of the |
member's appointment is to commence, except that
of the 5 |
initial members appointed to serve on the
Board, the member who |
is appointed as the chairperson shall serve for
a term that |
commences on the date of his or her appointment and expires on |
the
third Monday of January, 2002, and the remaining 4 members, |
by lots drawn at
the first meeting of the Board that is
held
|
after all 5 members are appointed, shall determine 2 of their |
number to serve
for terms that commence on the date of their
|
respective appointments and expire on the third
Monday of |
January, 2001,
and 2 of their number to serve for terms that |
commence
on the date of their respective appointments and |
expire on the third Monday
of January, 2000. All members |
appointed to serve on the
Board shall serve until their |
respective successors are
appointed and confirmed. Vacancies |
shall be filled in the same manner as
original appointments. If |
a vacancy in membership occurs at a time when the
Senate is not |
in session, the Governor shall make a temporary appointment |
until
the next meeting of the Senate, when he or she shall |
appoint, by and with the
advice and consent of the Senate, a |
person to fill that membership for the
unexpired term. If the |
Senate is not in session when the initial appointments
are |
made, those appointments shall
be made as in the case of |
vacancies.
|
|
The Education Funding Advisory Board shall be deemed |
established,
and the initial
members appointed by the Governor |
to serve as members of the
Board shall take office,
on the date |
that the
Governor makes his or her appointment of the fifth |
initial member of the
Board, whether those initial members are |
then serving
pursuant to appointment and confirmation or |
pursuant to temporary appointments
that are made by the |
Governor as in the case of vacancies.
|
The State Board of Education shall provide such staff |
assistance to the
Education Funding Advisory Board as is |
reasonably required for the proper
performance by the Board of |
its responsibilities.
|
For school years after the 2000-2001 school year, the |
Education
Funding Advisory Board, in consultation with the |
State Board of Education,
shall make recommendations as |
provided in this subsection (M) to the General
Assembly for the |
foundation level under subdivision (B)(3) of this Section and
|
for the
supplemental general State aid grant level under |
subsection (H) of this Section
for districts with high |
concentrations of children from poverty. The
recommended |
foundation level shall be determined based on a methodology |
which
incorporates the basic education expenditures of |
low-spending schools
exhibiting high academic performance. The |
Education Funding Advisory Board
shall make such |
recommendations to the General Assembly on January 1 of odd
|
numbered years, beginning January 1, 2001.
|
|
(N) (Blank).
|
(O) References.
|
(1) References in other laws to the various subdivisions of
|
Section 18-8 as that Section existed before its repeal and |
replacement by this
Section 18-8.05 shall be deemed to refer to |
the corresponding provisions of
this Section 18-8.05, to the |
extent that those references remain applicable.
|
(2) References in other laws to State Chapter 1 funds shall |
be deemed to
refer to the supplemental general State aid |
provided under subsection (H) of
this Section.
|
(P) Public Act 93-838 and Public Act 93-808 make inconsistent |
changes to this Section. Under Section 6 of the Statute on |
Statutes there is an irreconcilable conflict between Public Act |
93-808 and Public Act 93-838. Public Act 93-838, being the last |
acted upon, is controlling. The text of Public Act 93-838 is |
the law regardless of the text of Public Act 93-808. |
(Source: P.A. 93-21, eff. 7-1-03; 93-715, eff. 7-12-04; 93-808, |
eff. 7-26-04; 93-838, eff. 7-30-04; 93-875, eff. 8-6-04; 94-69, |
eff. 7-1-05; 94-438, eff. 8-4-05; 94-835, eff. 6-6-06; 94-1019, |
eff. 7-10-06; 94-1105, eff. 6-1-07; revised 2-18-07.)
|
(105 ILCS 5/21-29 new)
|
Sec. 21-29. Salary Incentive Program for Hard-to-Staff |
|
Schools. |
(a) The Salary Incentive Program for Hard-to-Staff Schools |
is established to provide categorical funding for monetary |
incentives and bonuses for teachers and school administrators |
who are employed by school districts designated as |
hard-to-staff by the State Board of Education. The State Board |
of Education shall allocate and distribute to qualifying school |
districts an amount as annually appropriated by the General |
Assembly for the Salary Incentive Program for Hard-to-Staff |
Schools. The State Board of Education's annual budget must set |
out by separate line item the appropriation for the program. |
(b) Unless otherwise provided by appropriation, each |
school district's annual allocation under the Salary Incentive |
Program for Hard-to-Staff Schools shall be the sum of the |
following incentives and bonuses: |
(1) An annual payment of $3,000 to be paid to each |
certificated teacher employed as a school teacher by a |
school district. The school district shall distribute this |
payment to each eligible teacher as a single payment or in |
not more than 3 payments. |
(2) An annual payment of $5,000 to each certificated |
principal that is employed as a school principal by a |
school district. The school district shall distribute this |
payment to each eligible principal as a single payment or |
in not more than 3 payments. |
(c) Each regional superintendent of schools shall provide |
|
information about the Salary Incentive Program for |
Hard-to-Staff Schools to each individual seeking to register or |
renew a certificate. |
Section 5-23. The Hospital Licensing Act is amended by |
changing Section 8 as follows:
|
(210 ILCS 85/8) (from Ch. 111 1/2, par. 149)
|
Sec. 8. Facility plan review; fees.
|
(a) Before commencing construction of new facilities or |
specified types
of alteration or additions to an existing |
hospital involving major
construction, as defined by rule by |
the Department, with an estimated
cost greater than $100,000, |
architectural plans and
specifications therefor shall be |
submitted by the licensee to the
Department for review and |
approval.
A hospital may submit architectural drawings and |
specifications for other
construction projects for Department |
review according to subsection (b) that
shall not be subject to |
fees under subsection (d).
The Department must give a hospital |
that is planning to submit a construction
project for review |
the opportunity to discuss its plans and specifications with
|
the Department before the hospital formally submits the plans |
and
specifications for Department review.
Review of drawings |
and specifications shall be conducted by an employee of
the |
Department meeting the qualifications established by the |
Department of
Central Management Services class specifications |
|
for such an individual's
position or by a person contracting |
with the Department who meets those class
specifications.
Final |
approval of the plans and specifications for compliance
with |
design and construction standards shall be obtained from the
|
Department before the alteration, addition, or new |
construction is begun. Subject to this Section 8, and prior to |
January 1, 2012, the Department shall consider the re-licensing |
of an existing hospital structure according to the standards |
for an existing hospital, as set forth in the Department's |
rules. Re-licensing under this provision shall occur only if |
that facility operated as a licensed hospital on July 1, 2005, |
has had no intervening use as other than a hospital, and exists |
in a county with a population of less than 20,000 that does not |
have another licensed hospital on the effective date of this |
amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly.
|
(b) The Department shall inform an applicant in writing |
within 10 working
days after receiving drawings and |
specifications and the required fee, if any,
from the applicant |
whether the applicant's submission is complete or
incomplete. |
Failure to provide the applicant with this notice within 10
|
working days shall result in the submission being deemed |
complete for purposes
of initiating the 60-day review period |
under this Section. If the submission
is incomplete, the |
Department shall inform the applicant of the deficiencies
with |
the submission in writing. If the submission is complete and |
the required
fee, if any, has been paid,
the Department shall |
|
approve or disapprove drawings and specifications
submitted to |
the Department no later than 60 days following receipt by the
|
Department. The drawings and specifications shall be of |
sufficient detail, as
provided by Department rule, to
enable |
the Department to
render a determination of compliance with |
design and construction standards
under this Act.
If the |
Department finds that the drawings are not of sufficient detail |
for it
to render a determination of compliance, the plans shall |
be determined to be
incomplete and shall not be considered for |
purposes of initiating the 60 day
review period.
If a |
submission of drawings and specifications is incomplete, the |
applicant
may submit additional information. The 60-day review |
period shall not commence
until the Department determines that |
a submission of drawings and
specifications is complete or the |
submission is deemed complete.
If the Department has not |
approved or disapproved the
drawings and specifications within |
60 days, the construction, major alteration,
or addition shall |
be deemed approved. If the drawings and specifications are
|
disapproved, the Department shall state in writing, with |
specificity, the
reasons for the disapproval. The entity |
submitting the drawings and
specifications may submit |
additional information in response to the written
comments from |
the Department or request a reconsideration of the disapproval.
|
A final decision of approval or disapproval shall be made |
within 45 days of the
receipt of the additional information or |
reconsideration request. If denied,
the Department shall state |
|
the specific reasons for the denial
and the applicant may elect |
to seek dispute resolution pursuant to Section
25 of the |
Illinois Building Commission Act, which the Department must
|
participate in.
|
(c) The Department shall provide written approval for |
occupancy pursuant
to subsection (g) and shall not issue a |
violation to a facility as a result of
a licensure or complaint |
survey based upon the facility's physical structure
if:
|
(1) the Department reviewed and approved or deemed |
approved the drawing
and specifications for compliance |
with design and construction standards;
|
(2) the construction, major alteration, or addition |
was built as
submitted;
|
(3) the law or rules have not been amended since the |
original approval;
and
|
(4) the conditions at the facility indicate that there |
is a reasonable
degree of safety provided for the patients.
|
(c-5) The Department shall not issue a violation to a |
facility if the
inspected aspects of the facility were |
previously found to be in compliance
with applicable standards, |
the relevant law or rules have not been amended,
conditions at |
the facility
reasonably protect the safety of its patients, and |
alterations or new hazards
have not been
identified.
|
(d) The Department shall charge the following fees in |
connection with its
reviews conducted before June 30, 2004 |
under this Section:
|
|
(1) (Blank).
|
(2) (Blank).
|
(3) If the estimated dollar value of the major
|
construction is greater than $500,000, the fee shall be
|
established by the Department pursuant to rules that |
reflect the reasonable
and
direct cost of the Department in |
conducting the architectural reviews required
under this |
Section. The estimated dollar value of the major |
construction
subject to review under this Section shall be |
annually readjusted to
reflect the
increase in |
construction costs due to inflation.
|
The fees provided in this subsection (d) shall not apply to |
major
construction projects involving facility changes that |
are required by
Department rule amendments or to projects |
related to homeland security.
|
The fees provided in this subsection (d) shall also not |
apply to major
construction projects if 51% or more of the |
estimated cost of the project is
attributed to capital |
equipment. For major construction projects where 51% or
more of |
the estimated cost of the project is attributed to capital |
equipment,
the Department shall by rule establish a fee that is |
reasonably related to the
cost of reviewing the project.
|
Disproportionate share hospitals and rural hospitals shall |
only pay
one-half of the fees
required in this subsection (d).
|
For the purposes of this subsection (d),
(i) "disproportionate |
share hospital" means a hospital described in items (1)
through |
|
(5) of subsection (b) of Section 5-5.02 of the Illinois Public |
Aid
Code and (ii)
"rural hospital" means a hospital that
is (A) |
located
outside a metropolitan statistical area or (B) located |
15 miles or less from a
county that is
outside a metropolitan |
statistical area and is licensed to perform
medical/surgical or
|
obstetrical services and has a combined total bed capacity of |
75 or fewer beds
in these 2
service categories as of July 14, |
1993, as determined by the Department.
|
The Department shall not commence the facility plan review |
process under this
Section until the applicable fee has been |
paid.
|
(e) All fees received by the Department under this Section |
shall be
deposited into the Health Facility Plan Review Fund, a |
special fund created in
the State treasury.
All fees paid by |
hospitals under subsection (d) shall be used only to cover
the |
direct and reasonable costs relating to the Department's review |
of hospital
projects under this
Section.
Moneys shall be |
appropriated from that Fund to the
Department only to pay the |
costs of conducting reviews under this Section.
None of the |
moneys in the Health Facility Plan Review Fund shall be used to
|
reduce the amount of General Revenue Fund moneys appropriated |
to the Department
for facility plan reviews conducted pursuant |
to this Section.
|
(f) (Blank).
|
(g) The Department shall conduct an on-site inspection of |
the completed
project no later than 15 business days after |
|
notification from the
applicant that the
project has been |
completed and all certifications required by the Department
|
have been received and accepted by the Department. The |
Department may extend
this deadline only if a federally |
mandated survey time frame takes
precedence. The Department |
shall
provide written approval for occupancy to the applicant |
within 5 working days
of the Department's final inspection, |
provided the applicant has demonstrated
substantial compliance |
as defined by Department rule.
Occupancy of new major |
construction is prohibited until Department approval is
|
received, unless the Department has not acted within the time |
frames provided
in this subsection (g), in which case the |
construction shall be deemed
approved. Occupancy shall be |
authorized after any
required health inspection by the |
Department has been conducted.
|
(h) The Department shall establish, by rule, a procedure to |
conduct interim
on-site review of large or complex construction |
projects.
|
(i) The Department shall establish, by rule, an expedited |
process for
emergency repairs or replacement of like equipment.
|
(j) Nothing in this Section shall be construed to apply to |
maintenance,
upkeep, or renovation that does not affect the |
structural integrity of the
building, does not add beds or |
services over the number for which the facility
is licensed, |
and provides a reasonable degree of safety for the patients.
|
(Source: P.A. 92-563, eff. 6-24-02; 92-803, eff. 8-16-02; |
|
93-41, eff.
6-27-03.)
|
Section 5-25. The Illinois Public Aid Code is amended by |
changing Sections 5-5.4, 5A-8, 5B-8, 5C-2, and 12-10.7 and by |
adding Section 12-10.8 as follows: |
(305 ILCS 5/5-5.4) (from Ch. 23, par. 5-5.4)
|
Sec. 5-5.4. Standards of Payment - Department of Healthcare |
and Family Services.
The Department of Healthcare and Family |
Services shall develop standards of payment of skilled
nursing |
and intermediate care services in facilities providing such |
services
under this Article which:
|
(1) Provide for the determination of a facility's payment
|
for skilled nursing and intermediate care services on a |
prospective basis.
The amount of the payment rate for all |
nursing facilities certified by the
Department of Public Health |
under the Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate
Care for the |
Developmentally Disabled facilities, Long Term Care for Under |
Age
22 facilities, Skilled Nursing facilities, or Intermediate |
Care facilities
under the
medical assistance program shall be |
prospectively established annually on the
basis of historical, |
financial, and statistical data reflecting actual costs
from |
prior years, which shall be applied to the current rate year |
and updated
for inflation, except that the capital cost element |
for newly constructed
facilities shall be based upon projected |
budgets. The annually established
payment rate shall take |
|
effect on July 1 in 1984 and subsequent years. No rate
increase |
and no
update for inflation shall be provided on or after July |
1, 1994 and before
July 1, 2008, unless specifically provided |
for in this
Section.
The changes made by Public Act 93-841
|
extending the duration of the prohibition against a rate |
increase or update for inflation are effective retroactive to |
July 1, 2004.
|
For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health |
under the Nursing
Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the |
Developmentally Disabled facilities
or Long Term Care for Under |
Age 22 facilities, the rates taking effect on July
1, 1998 |
shall include an increase of 3%. For facilities licensed by the
|
Department of Public Health under the Nursing Home Care Act as |
Skilled Nursing
facilities or Intermediate Care facilities, |
the rates taking effect on July 1,
1998 shall include an |
increase of 3% plus $1.10 per resident-day, as defined by
the |
Department. For facilities licensed by the Department of Public |
Health under the Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care |
Facilities for the Developmentally Disabled or Long Term Care |
for Under Age 22 facilities, the rates taking effect on January |
1, 2006 shall include an increase of 3%.
|
For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health |
under the
Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the |
Developmentally Disabled
facilities or Long Term Care for Under |
Age 22 facilities, the rates taking
effect on July 1, 1999 |
shall include an increase of 1.6% plus $3.00 per
resident-day, |
|
as defined by the Department. For facilities licensed by the
|
Department of Public Health under the Nursing Home Care Act as |
Skilled Nursing
facilities or Intermediate Care facilities, |
the rates taking effect on July 1,
1999 shall include an |
increase of 1.6% and, for services provided on or after
October |
1, 1999, shall be increased by $4.00 per resident-day, as |
defined by
the Department.
|
For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health |
under the
Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the |
Developmentally Disabled
facilities or Long Term Care for Under |
Age 22 facilities, the rates taking
effect on July 1, 2000 |
shall include an increase of 2.5% per resident-day,
as defined |
by the Department. For facilities licensed by the Department of
|
Public Health under the Nursing Home Care Act as Skilled |
Nursing facilities or
Intermediate Care facilities, the rates |
taking effect on July 1, 2000 shall
include an increase of 2.5% |
per resident-day, as defined by the Department.
|
For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health |
under the
Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities |
or intermediate care
facilities, a new payment methodology must |
be implemented for the nursing
component of the rate effective |
July 1, 2003. The Department of Public Aid
(now Healthcare and |
Family Services) shall develop the new payment methodology |
using the Minimum Data Set
(MDS) as the instrument to collect |
information concerning nursing home
resident condition |
necessary to compute the rate. The Department
shall develop the |
|
new payment methodology to meet the unique needs of
Illinois |
nursing home residents while remaining subject to the |
appropriations
provided by the General Assembly.
A transition |
period from the payment methodology in effect on June 30, 2003
|
to the payment methodology in effect on July 1, 2003 shall be |
provided for a
period not exceeding 3 years and 184 days after |
implementation of the new payment
methodology as follows:
|
(A) For a facility that would receive a lower
nursing |
component rate per patient day under the new system than |
the facility
received
effective on the date immediately |
preceding the date that the Department
implements the new |
payment methodology, the nursing component rate per |
patient
day for the facility
shall be held at
the level in |
effect on the date immediately preceding the date that the
|
Department implements the new payment methodology until a |
higher nursing
component rate of
reimbursement is achieved |
by that
facility.
|
(B) For a facility that would receive a higher nursing |
component rate per
patient day under the payment |
methodology in effect on July 1, 2003 than the
facility |
received effective on the date immediately preceding the |
date that the
Department implements the new payment |
methodology, the nursing component rate
per patient day for |
the facility shall be adjusted.
|
(C) Notwithstanding paragraphs (A) and (B), the |
nursing component rate per
patient day for the facility |
|
shall be adjusted subject to appropriations
provided by the |
General Assembly.
|
For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health |
under the
Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the |
Developmentally Disabled
facilities or Long Term Care for Under |
Age 22 facilities, the rates taking
effect on March 1, 2001 |
shall include a statewide increase of 7.85%, as
defined by the |
Department.
|
Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, for |
facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health under |
the
Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities or |
intermediate care
facilities, the numerator of the ratio used |
by the Department of Healthcare and Family Services to compute |
the rate payable under this Section using the Minimum Data Set |
(MDS) methodology shall incorporate the following annual |
amounts as the additional funds appropriated to the Department |
specifically to pay for rates based on the MDS nursing |
component methodology in excess of the funding in effect on |
December 31, 2006: |
(i) For rates taking effect January 1, 2007, |
$60,000,000. |
(ii) For rates taking effect January 1, 2008, |
$110,000,000. |
Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, for |
facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health under |
the Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities or |
|
intermediate care facilities, the support component of the |
rates taking effect on January 1, 2008 shall be computed using |
the most recent cost reports on file with the Department of |
Healthcare and Family Services no later than April 1, 2005, |
updated for inflation to January 1, 2006. |
For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health |
under the
Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the |
Developmentally Disabled
facilities or Long Term Care for Under |
Age 22 facilities, the rates taking
effect on April 1, 2002 |
shall include a statewide increase of 2.0%, as
defined by the |
Department.
This increase terminates on July 1, 2002;
beginning |
July 1, 2002 these rates are reduced to the level of the rates
|
in effect on March 31, 2002, as defined by the Department.
|
For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health |
under the
Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities |
or intermediate care
facilities, the rates taking effect on |
July 1, 2001 shall be computed using the most recent cost |
reports
on file with the Department of Public Aid no later than |
April 1, 2000,
updated for inflation to January 1, 2001. For |
rates effective July 1, 2001
only, rates shall be the greater |
of the rate computed for July 1, 2001
or the rate effective on |
June 30, 2001.
|
Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, for |
facilities
licensed by the Department of Public Health under |
the Nursing Home Care Act
as skilled nursing facilities or |
intermediate care facilities, the Illinois
Department shall |
|
determine by rule the rates taking effect on July 1, 2002,
|
which shall be 5.9% less than the rates in effect on June 30, |
2002.
|
Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, for |
facilities
licensed by the Department of Public Health under |
the Nursing Home Care Act as
skilled nursing
facilities or |
intermediate care facilities, if the payment methodologies |
required under Section 5A-12 and the waiver granted under 42 |
CFR 433.68 are approved by the United States Centers for |
Medicare and Medicaid Services, the rates taking effect on July |
1, 2004 shall be 3.0% greater than the rates in effect on June |
30, 2004. These rates shall take
effect only upon approval and
|
implementation of the payment methodologies required under |
Section 5A-12.
|
Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Section, for |
facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health under |
the Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities or |
intermediate care facilities, the rates taking effect on |
January 1, 2005 shall be 3% more than the rates in effect on |
December 31, 2004.
|
Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Section, for |
facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health under |
the Nursing Home Care Act as intermediate care facilities that |
are federally defined as Institutions for Mental Disease, a |
socio-development component rate equal to 6.6% of the |
facility's nursing component rate as of January 1, 2006 shall |
|
be established and paid effective July 1, 2006. The |
socio-development component of the rate shall be increased by a |
factor of 2.53 on the first day of the month that begins at |
least 45 days after the effective date of this amendatory Act |
of the 95th General Assembly. The Illinois Department may by |
rule adjust these socio-development component rates, but in no |
case may such rates be diminished.
|
For facilities
licensed
by the
Department of Public Health |
under the Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate
Care for
the |
Developmentally Disabled facilities or as long-term care |
facilities for
residents under 22 years of age, the rates |
taking effect on July 1,
2003 shall
include a statewide |
increase of 4%, as defined by the Department.
|
For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health |
under the
Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the |
Developmentally Disabled
facilities or Long Term Care for Under |
Age 22 facilities, the rates taking
effect on the first day of |
the month that begins at least 45 days after the effective date |
of this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly shall |
include a statewide increase of 2.5%, as
defined by the |
Department. |
Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, for |
facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health under |
the Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities or |
intermediate care facilities, effective January 1, 2005, |
facility rates shall be increased by the difference between (i) |
|
a facility's per diem property, liability, and malpractice |
insurance costs as reported in the cost report filed with the |
Department of Public Aid and used to establish rates effective |
July 1, 2001 and (ii) those same costs as reported in the |
facility's 2002 cost report. These costs shall be passed |
through to the facility without caps or limitations, except for |
adjustments required under normal auditing procedures.
|
Rates established effective each July 1 shall govern |
payment
for services rendered throughout that fiscal year, |
except that rates
established on July 1, 1996 shall be |
increased by 6.8% for services
provided on or after January 1, |
1997. Such rates will be based
upon the rates calculated for |
the year beginning July 1, 1990, and for
subsequent years |
thereafter until June 30, 2001 shall be based on the
facility |
cost reports
for the facility fiscal year ending at any point |
in time during the previous
calendar year, updated to the |
midpoint of the rate year. The cost report
shall be on file |
with the Department no later than April 1 of the current
rate |
year. Should the cost report not be on file by April 1, the |
Department
shall base the rate on the latest cost report filed |
by each skilled care
facility and intermediate care facility, |
updated to the midpoint of the
current rate year. In |
determining rates for services rendered on and after
July 1, |
1985, fixed time shall not be computed at less than zero. The
|
Department shall not make any alterations of regulations which |
would reduce
any component of the Medicaid rate to a level |
|
below what that component would
have been utilizing in the rate |
effective on July 1, 1984.
|
(2) Shall take into account the actual costs incurred by |
facilities
in providing services for recipients of skilled |
nursing and intermediate
care services under the medical |
assistance program.
|
(3) Shall take into account the medical and psycho-social
|
characteristics and needs of the patients.
|
(4) Shall take into account the actual costs incurred by |
facilities in
meeting licensing and certification standards |
imposed and prescribed by the
State of Illinois, any of its |
political subdivisions or municipalities and by
the U.S. |
Department of Health and Human Services pursuant to Title XIX |
of the
Social Security Act.
|
The Department of Healthcare and Family Services
shall |
develop precise standards for
payments to reimburse nursing |
facilities for any utilization of
appropriate rehabilitative |
personnel for the provision of rehabilitative
services which is |
authorized by federal regulations, including
reimbursement for |
services provided by qualified therapists or qualified
|
assistants, and which is in accordance with accepted |
professional
practices. Reimbursement also may be made for |
utilization of other
supportive personnel under appropriate |
supervision.
|
(Source: P.A. 94-48, eff. 7-1-05; 94-85, eff. 6-28-05; 94-697, |
eff. 11-21-05; 94-838, eff. 6-6-06; 94-964, eff. 6-28-06; |
|
95-12, eff. 7-2-07.)
|
(305 ILCS 5/5A-8) (from Ch. 23, par. 5A-8)
|
Sec. 5A-8. Hospital Provider Fund.
|
(a) There is created in the State Treasury the Hospital |
Provider Fund.
Interest earned by the Fund shall be credited to |
the Fund. The
Fund shall not be used to replace any moneys |
appropriated to the
Medicaid program by the General Assembly.
|
(b) The Fund is created for the purpose of receiving moneys
|
in accordance with Section 5A-6 and disbursing moneys only for |
the following
purposes, notwithstanding any other provision of |
law:
|
(1) For making payments to hospitals as required under |
Articles V, VI,
and XIV of this Code and
under the |
Children's Health Insurance Program Act.
|
(2) For the reimbursement of moneys collected by the
|
Illinois Department from hospitals or hospital providers |
through error or
mistake in performing the
activities |
authorized under this Article and Article V of this Code.
|
(3) For payment of administrative expenses incurred by |
the
Illinois Department or its agent in performing the |
activities
authorized by this Article.
|
(4) For payments of any amounts which are reimbursable |
to
the federal government for payments from this Fund which |
are
required to be paid by State warrant.
|
(5) For making transfers, as those transfers are |
|
authorized
in the proceedings authorizing debt under the |
Short Term Borrowing Act,
but transfers made under this |
paragraph (5) shall not exceed the
principal amount of debt |
issued in anticipation of the receipt by
the State of |
moneys to be deposited into the Fund.
|
(6) For making transfers to any other fund in the State |
treasury, but
transfers made under this paragraph (6) shall |
not exceed the amount transferred
previously from that |
other fund into the Hospital Provider Fund.
|
(7) For State fiscal years 2004 and 2005 for making |
transfers to the Health and Human Services
Medicaid Trust |
Fund, including 20% of the moneys received from
hospital |
providers under Section 5A-4 and transferred into the |
Hospital
Provider
Fund under Section 5A-6. For State fiscal |
year 2006 for making transfers to the Health and Human |
Services Medicaid Trust Fund of up to $130,000,000 per year |
of the moneys received from hospital providers under |
Section 5A-4 and transferred into the Hospital Provider |
Fund under Section 5A-6. Transfers under this paragraph |
shall be made within 7
days after the payments have been |
received pursuant to the schedule of payments
provided in |
subsection (a) of Section 5A-4.
|
(7.5) For State fiscal year years 2007 and 2008 for |
making
transfers of the moneys received from hospital |
providers under Section 5A-4 and transferred into the |
Hospital Provider Fund under Section 5A-6 to the designated |
|
funds not exceeding the following amounts
in that any State |
fiscal year: |
Health and Human Services |
Medicaid Trust Fund .................
$20,000,000 |
Long-Term Care Provider Fund ............
$30,000,000 |
General Revenue Fund ...................
$80,000,000. |
Transfers under this paragraph shall be made within 7 |
days after the payments have been received pursuant to the |
schedule of payments provided in subsection (a) of Section |
5A-4.
|
(7.8) For State fiscal year 2008, for making transfers |
of the moneys received from hospital providers under |
Section 5A-4 and transferred into the Hospital Provider |
Fund under Section 5A-6 to the designated funds not |
exceeding the following amounts in that State fiscal year: |
Health and Human Services |
Medicaid Trust Fund ..................$40,000,000 |
Long-Term Care Provider Fund ..............$60,000,000 |
General Revenue Fund ...................$160,000,000. |
Transfers under this paragraph shall be made within 7 |
days after the payments have been received pursuant to the |
schedule of payments provided in subsection (a) of Section |
5A-4. |
(8) For making refunds to hospital providers pursuant |
to Section 5A-10.
|
Disbursements from the Fund, other than transfers |
|
authorized under
paragraphs (5) and (6) of this subsection, |
shall be by
warrants drawn by the State Comptroller upon |
receipt of vouchers
duly executed and certified by the Illinois |
Department.
|
(c) The Fund shall consist of the following:
|
(1) All moneys collected or received by the Illinois
|
Department from the hospital provider assessment imposed |
by this
Article.
|
(2) All federal matching funds received by the Illinois
|
Department as a result of expenditures made by the Illinois
|
Department that are attributable to moneys deposited in the |
Fund.
|
(3) Any interest or penalty levied in conjunction with |
the
administration of this Article.
|
(4) Moneys transferred from another fund in the State |
treasury.
|
(5) All other moneys received for the Fund from any |
other
source, including interest earned thereon.
|
(d) (Blank).
|
(Source: P.A. 93-659, eff. 2-3-04; 94-242, eff. 7-18-05; |
94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
|
(305 ILCS 5/5B-8) (from Ch. 23, par. 5B-8)
|
Sec. 5B-8. Long-Term Care Provider Fund.
|
(a) There is created in the State Treasury the Long-Term
|
Care Provider Fund. Interest earned by the Fund shall be
|
|
credited to the Fund. The Fund shall not be used to replace any
|
moneys appropriated to the Medicaid program by the General |
Assembly.
|
(b) The Fund is created for the purpose of receiving and
|
disbursing moneys in accordance with this Article. |
Disbursements
from the Fund shall be made only as follows:
|
(1) For payments to skilled or intermediate nursing
|
facilities, including county nursing facilities but |
excluding
State-operated facilities, under Title XIX of |
the Social Security
Act and Article V of this Code.
|
(2) For the reimbursement of moneys collected by the
|
Illinois Department through error or mistake, and for |
making
required payments under Section 5-4.38(a)(1) if |
there are no
moneys available for such payments in the |
Medicaid Long Term Care
Provider Participation Fee Trust |
Fund.
|
(3) For payment of administrative expenses incurred by |
the
Illinois Department or its agent in performing the |
activities
authorized by this Article.
|
(3.5) For reimbursement of expenses incurred by |
long-term care facilities, and payment of administrative |
expenses incurred by the Department of Public Health, in |
relation to the conduct and analysis of background checks |
for identified offenders under the Nursing Home Care Act.
|
(4) For payments of any amounts that are reimbursable |
to the
federal government for payments from this Fund that |
|
are required
to be paid by State warrant.
|
(5) For making transfers to the General Obligation Bond
|
Retirement and Interest Fund, as those transfers are |
authorized
in the proceedings authorizing debt under the |
Short Term Borrowing Act,
but transfers made under this |
paragraph (5) shall not exceed the
principal amount of debt |
issued in anticipation of the receipt by
the State of |
moneys to be deposited into the Fund.
|
Disbursements from the Fund, other than transfers to the
|
General Obligation Bond Retirement and Interest Fund, shall be |
by
warrants drawn by the State Comptroller upon receipt of |
vouchers
duly executed and certified by the Illinois |
Department.
|
(c) The Fund shall consist of the following:
|
(1) All moneys collected or received by the Illinois
|
Department from the long-term care provider assessment |
imposed by
this Article.
|
(2) All federal matching funds received by the Illinois
|
Department as a result of expenditures made by the Illinois
|
Department that are attributable to moneys deposited in the |
Fund.
|
(3) Any interest or penalty levied in conjunction with |
the
administration of this Article.
|
(4) Any balance in the Medicaid Long Term Care Provider |
Participation
Fee Fund in the State Treasury. The balance |
shall be transferred to the
Fund upon certification by the |
|
Illinois Department to the State Comptroller
that all of |
the disbursements required by Section 5-4.31(b) of this |
Code
have been made.
|
(5) All other monies received for the Fund from any |
other source,
including interest earned thereon.
|
(Source: P.A. 89-626, eff. 8-9-96.)
|
(305 ILCS 5/5C-2) (from Ch. 23, par. 5C-2)
|
Sec. 5C-2. Assessment; no local authorization to tax.
|
(a) For the privilege of engaging in the occupation of |
developmentally
disabled care provider, an assessment is |
imposed upon each developmentally
disabled care provider in an |
amount equal to 6% , or the maximum allowed under federal |
regulation, whichever is less, of its adjusted
gross |
developmentally disabled care revenue for the prior State |
fiscal
year. Notwithstanding any provision of any other Act to |
the contrary, this
assessment shall be construed as a tax, but |
may not be added to the charges
of an individual's nursing home |
care that is paid for in whole, or in part,
by a federal, |
State, or combined federal-state medical care program, except
|
those individuals receiving Medicare Part B benefits solely.
|
(b) Nothing in this amendatory Act of 1995 shall be |
construed
to authorize any home rule unit or other unit of |
local government to license
for revenue or impose a tax or |
assessment upon a developmentally disabled care
provider or the |
occupation of developmentally disabled care provider, or a tax
|
|
or assessment measured by the income or earnings of a |
developmentally disabled
care provider.
|
(Source: P.A. 88-88; 89-21, eff. 7-1-95.)
|
(305 ILCS 5/12-10.7)
|
Sec. 12-10.7. The Health and Human Services Medicaid Trust |
Fund. |
(a) The Health and Human Services Medicaid Trust Fund shall |
consist of (i) moneys appropriated or transferred into the |
Fund, pursuant to statute, (ii) federal financial |
participation moneys received pursuant to expenditures from |
the Fund, and (iii) the interest earned on moneys in the Fund. |
(b) Subject to appropriation, the moneys in the Fund shall |
be used by a State agency for such purposes as that agency may, |
by the appropriation language, be directed.
|
(c) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided |
for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as |
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State |
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $3,500,000 from the Health |
and Human Services Medicaid Trust Fund to the Human Services |
Priority Capital Program Fund.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-841, eff. 7-30-04.) |
(305 ILCS 5/12-10.8 new)
|
Sec. 12-10.8. Mental health contracts. Subject to |
appropriations available for these purposes, including, |
|
without limitation, the FY08 appropriations to the Department |
for federally defined Institutions for Mental Disease, the |
Department of Healthcare and Family Services shall enter into a |
contract for $1,000,000 with the provider of community mental |
health services that has more than 700 beds at over 30 service |
locations in multiple counties for purposes of supporting the |
implementation of time-limited resident review and rapid |
reintegration targeted to residents of federally defined |
Institutions for Mental Disease. |
Section 5-30. The Illinois Affordable Housing Act is |
amended by changing Section 8 as follows:
|
(310 ILCS 65/8) (from Ch. 67 1/2, par. 1258)
|
Sec. 8. Uses of Trust Fund.
|
(a) Subject to annual appropriation to
the Funding Agent |
and subject to the prior dedication, allocation, transfer
and |
use of Trust Fund Moneys as provided in Sections 8(b), 8(c) and |
9 of this
Act, the Trust Fund may be used to make grants,
|
mortgages, or
other loans to acquire, construct, rehabilitate, |
develop, operate, insure,
and retain affordable single-family |
and multi-family housing in this State
for low-income
and very |
low-income households. The majority of monies appropriated to |
the
Trust Fund in any given year are to be used for affordable |
housing for very
low-income households. For the fiscal years |
2007 and 2008
year beginning July 1, 2006 only, the Department |
|
of Human Services is authorized to receive appropriations and |
spend moneys from the Illinois Affordable Housing Trust Fund |
for the purpose of developing and coordinating public and |
private resources targeted to meet the affordable housing needs |
of low-income, very low-income, and special needs households in |
the State of Illinois.
|
(b) For each fiscal year commencing with fiscal year 1994, |
the Program
Administrator shall certify from time to time to |
the Funding Agent, the
Comptroller and the State
Treasurer |
amounts, up to an aggregate in any fiscal year of $10,000,000, |
of
Trust Fund Moneys expected to be used or pledged by the |
Program Administrator
during the fiscal year for the purposes |
and uses specified in Sections 8(c) and
9 of this Act. Subject |
to annual appropriation, upon receipt of such
certification, |
the Funding Agent and the
Comptroller shall dedicate and the |
State Treasurer shall transfer not less
often than monthly to |
the Program Administrator or its designated payee,
without |
requisition or further
request therefor, all amounts |
accumulated in the Trust Fund within the State
Treasury and not |
already transferred to the Loan Commitment Account prior to
the |
Funding Agent's receipt of such certification, until the |
Program
Administrator has received the aggregate amount |
certified by the Program
Administrator, to be used solely for |
the purposes and uses authorized and
provided in Sections 8(c) |
and 9 of this Act. Neither the Comptroller nor the
Treasurer |
shall transfer, dedicate or allocate any of the Trust Fund |
|
Moneys
transferred or certified for transfer by the Program |
Administrator as provided
above to any other fund, nor shall |
the Governor authorize any such transfer,
dedication or |
allocation, nor shall any of the Trust Fund Moneys so |
dedicated,
allocated or transferred be used, temporarily or |
otherwise, for interfund
borrowing, or be otherwise used or |
appropriated, except as expressly authorized
and provided in |
Sections 8(c) and 9 of this Act for the purposes and subject to
|
the priorities, limitations and conditions provided for |
therein until such
obligations, uses and dedications as therein |
provided, have been satisfied.
|
(c) Notwithstanding Section 5(b) of this Act, any Trust |
Fund Moneys
transferred to the Program Administrator pursuant |
to Section 8(b) of this Act,
or otherwise obtained, paid to or |
held by or for the Program Administrator, or
pledged pursuant |
to resolution of the Program Administrator, for Affordable
|
Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes under the Illinois |
Housing
Development Act, and all proceeds, payments and |
receipts from investments or
use of such moneys, including any |
residual or additional funds or moneys
generated or obtained in |
connection with any of the foregoing, may be held,
pledged, |
applied or dedicated by the Program Administrator as follows:
|
(1) as required by the terms of any pledge of or |
resolution of the Program
Administrator authorized under |
Section 9 of this Act in connection with
Affordable Housing |
Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes issued pursuant to the
|
|
Illinois Housing Development Act;
|
(2) to or for costs of issuance and administration
and |
the payments of any principal, interest, premium or other |
amounts or
expenses incurred or accrued in connection with |
Affordable Housing Program
Trust Fund Bonds or Notes, |
including rate protection contracts and credit
support |
arrangements pertaining thereto, and, provided such |
expenses, fees and
charges are obligations, whether |
recourse or nonrecourse, and whether financed
with or paid |
from the proceeds of Affordable Housing Program Trust Fund |
Bonds
or Notes, of the developers, mortgagors or other |
users, the Program
Administrator's expenses and servicing, |
administration and origination fees and
charges in |
connection with any loans, mortgages, or developments |
funded or
financed or expected to be funded or financed, in |
whole or in part, from the
issuance of Affordable Housing |
Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes;
|
(3) to or for costs of issuance and administration and |
the payments of
principal, interest, premium, loan fees, |
and other amounts or other obligations
of the Program |
Administrator, including rate protection contracts and |
credit
support arrangements pertaining thereto, for loans, |
commercial paper or other
notes or bonds issued by the |
Program Administrator pursuant to the Illinois
Housing |
Development Act, provided that the proceeds of such loans, |
commercial
paper or other notes or bonds are paid or |
|
expended in connection with, or
refund or repay, loans, |
commercial paper or other notes or bonds issued or made
in |
connection with bridge loans or loans for the construction, |
renovation,
redevelopment, restructuring, reorganization |
of Affordable Housing and related
expenses, including |
development costs, technical assistance, or other amounts
|
to construct, preserve, improve, renovate, rehabilitate, |
refinance, or assist
Affordable Housing, including |
financially troubled Affordable Housing,
permanent or |
other financing for which has been funded or financed or is
|
expected to be funded or financed in whole or in part by |
the Program
Administrator through the issuance of or use of |
proceeds from Affordable
Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds |
or Notes;
|
(4) to or for direct expenditures or reimbursement for |
development costs,
technical assistance, or other amounts |
to construct, preserve, improve,
renovate, rehabilitate, |
refinance, or assist Affordable Housing, including
|
financially troubled Affordable Housing, permanent or |
other financing for which
has been funded or financed or is |
expected to be funded or financed in whole or
in part by |
the Program Administrator through the issuance of or use of |
proceeds
from Affordable Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds |
or Notes; and
|
(5) for deposit into any residual, sinking, reserve or |
revolving fund or
pool established by the Program |
|
Administrator, whether or not pledged to secure
Affordable |
Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes, to support or be
|
utilized for the
issuance, redemption, or payment of the |
principal, interest, premium or other
amounts payable on or |
with respect to any existing, additional or future
|
Affordable Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes, or to |
or for any other
expenditure authorized by this Section |
8(c).
|
(d) All or a portion of the Trust Fund Moneys on
deposit or |
to be
deposited in
the Trust Fund not already certified for |
transfer or transferred to the
Program Administrator pursuant |
to Section 8(b) of this Act may be used to
secure the repayment |
of Affordable Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds or
Notes, or |
otherwise to supplement or support Affordable Housing funded or
|
financed
or
intended to be funded or financed, in whole or in |
part, by Affordable Housing
Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes.
|
(e) Assisted housing may include housing for special needs
|
populations
such as the homeless, single-parent families, the |
elderly, or the
physically and mentally disabled. The Trust |
Fund shall be used to
implement a demonstration congregate |
housing project for any such special
needs population.
|
(f) Grants from the Trust Fund may include, but are not |
limited
to,
rental assistance and security deposit subsidies |
for low and very low-income
households.
|
(g) The Trust Fund may be used to pay actual and reasonable
|
costs for
Commission members to attend Commission meetings, and |
|
any litigation costs
and expenses, including legal fees, |
incurred by the Program Administrator
in any litigation related |
to this Act or its action as Program
Administrator.
|
(h) The Trust Fund may be used to make grants for (1) the
|
provision of
technical assistance, (2) outreach, and (3) |
building an organization's
capacity to develop affordable |
housing projects.
|
(i) Amounts on deposit in the Trust Fund may be used to |
reimburse the
Program
Administrator and the Funding Agent for |
costs incurred in the performance of
their duties under this |
Act, excluding costs and fees of the Program
Administrator |
associated with the Program Escrow to the extent withheld
|
pursuant to paragraph (8) of subsection (b) of Section 5.
|
(Source: P.A. 94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
|
Section 5-40. The Reviewing Court Alternative Dispute |
Resolution Act is amended by changing Section 10 as follows: |
(710 ILCS 40/10)
|
Sec. 10. Reviewing Court Alternative Dispute Resolution |
Fund. The Reviewing Court Alternative Dispute Resolution Fund |
is created as a special fund in the State Treasury. The Supreme |
Court may designate an amount to be included in the filing fees |
collected by the clerks of the Appellate Court for the funding |
of alternative dispute resolution programs in the reviewing |
courts. The portion of the filing fees designated for |
|
alternative dispute resolution programs in the reviewing |
courts shall be remitted within one month after receipt to the |
State Treasurer for deposit in the Reviewing Court Alternative |
Dispute Resolution Fund. All money in the Reviewing Court |
Alternative Dispute Resolution Fund shall be maintained in |
separate accounts for each Appellate Court district that has |
established approved alternative dispute resolution programs |
pursuant to Supreme Court rule and used, subject to |
appropriation, by the Supreme Court solely for the purpose of |
funding alternative dispute resolution programs in the |
reviewing courts. Notwithstanding any other provision of this |
Section, the Reviewing Court Alternative Dispute Resolution |
Fund may be used for any other purpose authorized by the |
Supreme Court. |
(Source: P.A. 93-801, eff. 7-22-04.) |
Section 5-45. The Pretrial Services Act is amended by |
changing Section 33 as follows:
|
(725 ILCS 185/33) (from Ch. 38, par. 333)
|
Sec. 33. The Supreme Court shall pay from funds |
appropriated to it for this purpose
100% of all approved costs |
for pretrial services, including pretrial
services officers, |
necessary support personnel, travel costs reasonably
related |
to the delivery of pretrial services, space costs, equipment,
|
telecommunications, postage, commodities, printing and |
|
contractual
services. Costs shall be reimbursed monthly, based |
on a plan and budget
approved by the Supreme Court. No
|
department may be reimbursed for costs which exceed or are not |
provided for
in the approved plan and budget.
The For State |
fiscal years 2004, 2005, and 2006, and 2007 only, the Mandatory |
Arbitration Fund may be used
to
reimburse approved costs for |
pretrial services.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-25, eff. 6-20-03; 93-839, eff. 7-30-04; 94-91, |
eff. 7-1-05; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06; revised 8-3-06.)
|
Section 5-50. The Probation and Probation Officers Act is |
amended by changing Sections 15 and 15.1 as follows:
|
(730 ILCS 110/15) (from Ch. 38, par. 204-7)
|
Sec. 15. (1) The Supreme Court of Illinois may establish a |
Division of
Probation Services whose purpose shall be the |
development, establishment,
promulgation, and enforcement of |
uniform standards for probation services in
this State, and to |
otherwise carry out the intent of this Act. The Division
may:
|
(a) establish qualifications for chief probation |
officers and other
probation and court services personnel |
as to hiring, promotion, and training.
|
(b) make available, on a timely basis, lists of those |
applicants whose
qualifications meet the regulations |
referred to herein, including on said
lists all candidates |
found qualified.
|
|
(c) establish a means of verifying the conditions for |
reimbursement
under this Act and develop criteria for |
approved costs for reimbursement.
|
(d) develop standards and approve employee |
compensation schedules for
probation and court services |
departments.
|
(e) employ sufficient personnel in the Division to |
carry out the
functions of the Division.
|
(f) establish a system of training and establish |
standards for personnel
orientation and training.
|
(g) develop standards for a system of record keeping |
for cases and
programs, gather statistics, establish a |
system of uniform forms, and
develop research for planning |
of Probation
Services.
|
(h) develop standards to assure adequate support |
personnel, office
space, equipment and supplies, travel |
expenses, and other essential items
necessary for |
Probation and Court Services
Departments to carry out their
|
duties.
|
(i) review and approve annual plans submitted by
|
Probation and Court
Services Departments.
|
(j) monitor and evaluate all programs operated by
|
Probation and Court
Services Departments, and may include |
in the program evaluation criteria
such factors as the |
percentage of Probation sentences for felons convicted
of |
Probationable offenses.
|
|
(k) seek the cooperation of local and State government |
and private
agencies to improve the quality of probation |
and
court services.
|
(l) where appropriate, establish programs and |
corresponding standards
designed to generally improve the |
quality of
probation and court services
and reduce the rate |
of adult or juvenile offenders committed to the
Department |
of Corrections.
|
(m) establish such other standards and regulations and |
do all acts
necessary to carry out the intent and purposes |
of this Act.
|
The Division shall establish a model list of structured |
intermediate
sanctions that may be imposed by a probation |
agency for violations of terms and
conditions of a sentence of |
probation, conditional discharge, or supervision.
|
The State of Illinois shall provide for the costs of |
personnel, travel,
equipment, telecommunications, postage, |
commodities, printing, space,
contractual services and other |
related costs necessary to carry out the
intent of this Act.
|
(2) (a) The chief judge of each circuit shall provide
|
full-time probation services for all counties
within the |
circuit, in a
manner consistent with the annual probation plan,
|
the standards, policies,
and regulations established by the |
Supreme Court. A
probation district of
two or more counties |
within a circuit may be created for the purposes of
providing |
full-time probation services. Every
county or group of
counties |
|
within a circuit shall maintain a
probation department which |
shall
be under the authority of the Chief Judge of the circuit |
or some other
judge designated by the Chief Judge. The Chief |
Judge, through the
Probation and Court Services Department |
shall
submit annual plans to the
Division for probation and |
related services.
|
(b) The Chief Judge of each circuit shall appoint the Chief
|
Probation
Officer and all other probation officers for his
or |
her circuit from lists
of qualified applicants supplied by the |
Supreme Court. Candidates for chief
managing officer and other |
probation officer
positions must apply with both
the Chief |
Judge of the circuit and the Supreme Court.
|
(3) A Probation and Court Service Department
shall apply to |
the
Supreme Court for funds for basic services, and may apply |
for funds for new
and expanded programs or Individualized |
Services and Programs. Costs shall
be reimbursed monthly based |
on a plan and budget approved by the Supreme
Court. No |
Department may be reimbursed for costs which exceed or are not
|
provided for in the approved annual plan and budget. After the |
effective
date of this amendatory Act of 1985, each county must |
provide basic
services in accordance with the annual plan and |
standards created by the
division. No department may receive |
funds for new or expanded programs or
individualized services |
and programs unless they are in compliance with
standards as |
enumerated in paragraph (h) of subsection (1) of this Section,
|
the annual plan, and standards for basic services.
|
|
(4) The Division shall reimburse the county or counties for
|
probation
services as follows:
|
(a) 100% of the salary of all chief managing officers |
designated as such
by the Chief Judge and the division.
|
(b) 100% of the salary for all probation
officer and |
supervisor
positions approved for reimbursement by the |
division after April 1, 1984,
to meet workload standards |
and to implement intensive sanction and
probation
|
supervision
programs and other basic services as defined in |
this Act.
|
(c) 100% of the salary for all secure detention |
personnel and non-secure
group home personnel approved for |
reimbursement after December 1, 1990.
For all such |
positions approved for reimbursement
before
December 1, |
1990, the counties shall be reimbursed $1,250 per month |
beginning
July 1, 1995, and an additional $250 per month |
beginning each July 1st
thereafter until the positions |
receive 100% salary reimbursement.
Allocation of such |
positions will be based on comparative need considering
|
capacity, staff/resident ratio, physical plant and |
program.
|
(d) $1,000 per month for salaries for the remaining
|
probation officer
positions engaged in basic services and |
new or expanded services. All such
positions shall be |
approved by the division in accordance with this Act and
|
division standards.
|
|
(e) 100% of the travel expenses in accordance with |
Division standards
for all Probation positions approved |
under
paragraph (b) of subsection 4
of this Section.
|
(f) If the amount of funds reimbursed to the county |
under paragraphs
(a) through (e) of subsection 4 of this |
Section on an annual basis is less
than the amount the |
county had received during the 12 month period
immediately |
prior to the effective date of this amendatory Act of 1985,
|
then the Division shall reimburse the amount of the |
difference to the
county. The effect of paragraph (b) of |
subsection 7 of this Section shall
be considered in |
implementing this supplemental reimbursement provision.
|
(5) The Division shall provide funds beginning on April 1, |
1987 for the
counties to provide Individualized Services and |
Programs as provided in
Section 16 of this Act.
|
(6) A Probation and Court Services Department
in order to |
be eligible
for the reimbursement must submit to the Supreme |
Court an application
containing such information and in such a |
form and by such dates as the
Supreme Court may require. |
Departments to be eligible for funding must
satisfy the |
following conditions:
|
(a) The Department shall have on file with the Supreme
|
Court an annual Probation plan for continuing,
improved, |
and
new Probation and Court Services Programs
approved by |
the Supreme Court or its
designee. This plan shall indicate |
the manner in which
Probation and Court
Services will be |
|
delivered and improved, consistent with the minimum
|
standards and regulations for Probation and Court
|
Services, as established
by the Supreme Court. In counties |
with more than one
Probation and Court
Services Department |
eligible to receive funds, all Departments within that
|
county must submit plans which are approved by the Supreme |
Court.
|
(b) The annual probation plan shall seek to
generally |
improve the
quality of probation services and to reduce the
|
commitment of adult offenders to the Department of |
Corrections and to reduce the
commitment of juvenile |
offenders to the Department of Juvenile Justice and shall |
require, when
appropriate, coordination with the |
Department of Corrections, the Department of Juvenile |
Justice, and the
Department of Children and Family Services |
in the development and use of
community resources, |
information systems, case review and permanency
planning |
systems to avoid the duplication of services.
|
(c) The Department shall be in compliance with |
standards developed by the
Supreme Court for basic, new and |
expanded services, training, personnel
hiring and |
promotion.
|
(d) The Department shall in its annual plan indicate |
the manner in which
it will support the rights of crime |
victims and in which manner it will
implement Article I, |
Section 8.1 of the Illinois Constitution and in what
manner |
|
it will coordinate crime victims' support services with |
other criminal
justice agencies within its jurisdiction, |
including but not limited to, the
State's Attorney, the |
Sheriff and any municipal police department.
|
(7) No statement shall be verified by the Supreme Court or |
its
designee or vouchered by the Comptroller unless each of the |
following
conditions have been met:
|
(a) The probation officer is a full-time
employee |
appointed by the Chief
Judge to provide probation services.
|
(b) The probation officer, in order to be
eligible for |
State
reimbursement, is receiving a salary of at least |
$17,000 per year.
|
(c) The probation officer is appointed or
was |
reappointed in accordance
with minimum qualifications or |
criteria established by the Supreme
Court; however, all |
probation officers appointed
prior to January 1, 1978,
|
shall be exempted from the minimum requirements |
established by the Supreme
Court. Payments shall be made to |
counties employing these exempted
probation officers as |
long as they are employed
in the position held on the
|
effective date of this amendatory Act of 1985. Promotions |
shall be
governed by minimum qualifications established by |
the Supreme Court.
|
(d) The Department has an established compensation |
schedule approved by
the Supreme Court. The compensation |
schedule shall include salary ranges
with necessary |
|
increments to compensate each employee. The increments
|
shall, within the salary ranges, be based on such factors |
as bona fide
occupational qualifications, performance, and |
length of service. Each
position in the Department shall be |
placed on the compensation schedule
according to job duties |
and responsibilities of such position. The policy
and |
procedures of the compensation schedule shall be made |
available to each
employee.
|
(8) In order to obtain full reimbursement of all approved |
costs, each
Department must continue to employ at least the |
same number of
probation
officers and probation managers as |
were
authorized for employment for the
fiscal year which |
includes January 1, 1985. This number shall be designated
as |
the base amount of the Department. No positions approved by the |
Division
under paragraph (b) of subsection 4 will be included |
in the base amount.
In the event that the Department employs |
fewer
Probation officers and
Probation managers than the base |
amount for a
period of 90 days, funding
received by the |
Department under subsection 4 of this
Section may be reduced on |
a monthly basis by the amount of the current
salaries of any |
positions below the base amount.
|
(9) Before the 15th day of each month, the treasurer of any |
county which
has a Probation and Court Services Department, or
|
the treasurer of the most
populous county, in the case of a |
Probation or
Court Services Department
funded by more than one |
county, shall submit an itemized statement of all
approved |
|
costs incurred in the delivery of Basic
Probation and Court
|
Services under this Act to the Supreme Court.
The treasurer may |
also submit an itemized statement of all approved costs
|
incurred in the delivery of new and expanded
Probation and |
Court Services
as well as Individualized Services and Programs. |
The Supreme Court or
its designee shall verify compliance with |
this Section and shall examine
and audit the monthly statement |
and, upon finding them to be correct, shall
forward them to the |
Comptroller for payment to the county treasurer. In the
case of |
payment to a treasurer of a county which is the most populous |
of
counties sharing the salary and expenses of a
Probation and |
Court Services
Department, the treasurer shall divide the money |
between the counties in a
manner that reflects each county's |
share of the cost incurred by the
Department.
|
(10) The county treasurer must certify that funds received |
under this
Section shall be used solely to maintain and improve
|
Probation and Court
Services. The county or circuit shall |
remain in compliance with all
standards, policies and |
regulations established by the Supreme Court.
If at any time |
the Supreme Court determines that a county or circuit is not
in |
compliance, the Supreme Court shall immediately notify the |
Chief Judge,
county board chairman and the Director of Court |
Services Chief
Probation Officer. If after 90 days of written
|
notice the noncompliance
still exists, the Supreme Court shall |
be required to reduce the amount of
monthly reimbursement by |
10%. An additional 10% reduction of monthly
reimbursement shall |
|
occur for each consecutive month of noncompliance.
Except as |
provided in subsection 5 of Section 15, funding to counties |
shall
commence on April 1, 1986. Funds received under this Act |
shall be used to
provide for Probation Department expenses
|
including those required under
Section 13 of this Act. The For |
State fiscal years 2004, 2005, 2006, and 2007 only, the |
Mandatory
Arbitration Fund may be used to provide for Probation |
Department expenses,
including those required under Section 13 |
of this Act.
|
(11) The respective counties shall be responsible for |
capital and space
costs, fringe benefits, clerical costs, |
equipment, telecommunications,
postage, commodities and |
printing.
|
(12) For purposes of this Act only, probation officers |
shall be
considered
peace officers. In the
exercise of their |
official duties, probation
officers, sheriffs, and police
|
officers may, anywhere within the State, arrest any probationer |
who is in
violation of any of the conditions of his or her |
probation, conditional
discharge, or supervision, and it shall |
be the
duty of the officer making the arrest to take the |
probationer
before the
Court having jurisdiction over the |
probationer for further order.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-25, eff. 6-20-03; 93-576, eff. 1-1-04; 93-839, |
eff. 7-30-04; 94-91, eff. 7-1-05; 94-696, eff. 6-1-06; 94-839, |
eff. 6-6-06.)
|
|
(730 ILCS 110/15.1) (from Ch. 38, par. 204-7.1) |
Sec. 15.1. Probation and Court Services Fund.
|
(a) The county treasurer in each county shall establish a
|
probation and court services fund consisting of fees collected |
pursuant to
subsection (i) of Section 5-6-3 and subsection (i) |
of Section 5-6-3.1
of the Unified Code of Corrections, |
subsection (10) of Section 5-615
and
subsection (5) of Section |
5-715 of the Juvenile Court Act of 1987, and
paragraph 14.3 of |
subsection (b) of Section 110-10 of the Code of Criminal
|
Procedure of 1963.
The
county treasurer shall disburse monies |
from the fund only at the direction
of the chief judge of the |
circuit court in such circuit where the county is
located. The |
county treasurer of each county shall, on or before January
10 |
of each year, submit an annual report to the Supreme Court.
|
(b) Monies in the probation and court services fund shall |
be
appropriated by the county board to be used within the |
county or
jurisdiction where
collected in accordance
with |
policies and guidelines approved by the Supreme Court for the |
costs
of operating the probation and court services department |
or departments;
however, except as provided in subparagraph |
(g), monies
in the probation and court services fund shall not |
be used for the payment
of salaries of probation and court |
services personnel.
|
(c) Monies expended from the probation and court services |
fund shall
be used to supplement, not supplant, county |
appropriations for probation
and court services.
|
|
(d) Interest earned on monies deposited in a probation and |
court
services fund may be used by the county for its ordinary |
and contingent
expenditures.
|
(e) The county board may appropriate moneys from the |
probation and court
services fund, upon the direction of the |
chief judge, to support programs that
are part of the continuum |
of juvenile delinquency intervention programs which
are or may |
be developed within the county. The grants from the probation |
and
court services fund shall be for no more than one year and |
may be used for any
expenses attributable to the program |
including administration and oversight of
the program by the |
probation department.
|
(f) The county board may appropriate moneys from the |
probation and court
services fund, upon the direction of the |
chief judge, to support practices
endorsed or required under |
the Sex Offender Management Board Act, including but
not |
limited to sex offender evaluation, treatment, and monitoring |
programs that
are or may be developed within the county.
|
(g) For the State Fiscal Years 2005, 2006, and 2007
only, |
the Administrative Office of the Illinois Courts may permit a |
county or circuit to use its probation and court services fund |
for the payment of salaries of probation officers and other |
court services personnel whose salaries are reimbursed under |
this Act if the State's FY2005, FY2006, or FY2007 appropriation |
to the Supreme Court for reimbursement to counties for |
probation salaries and services is less than the amount |
|
appropriated to the Supreme Court for these
purposes for State |
Fiscal Year 2004. The Administrative Office of the Illinois |
Courts shall take into account each county's or circuit's |
probation fee collections and expenditures when apportioning |
the total reimbursement for each county or circuit.
|
(h) The Administrative Office of the Illinois Courts may |
permit a county or circuit to use its probation and court |
services fund for the payment of salaries of probation officers |
and other court services personnel whose salaries are |
reimbursed under this Act in any State fiscal year that the |
appropriation for reimbursement to counties for probation |
salaries and services is less than the amount appropriated to |
the Supreme Court for these purposes for State Fiscal Year |
2002. The Administrative Office of the Illinois Courts shall |
take into account each county's or circuit's probation fee |
collections and expenditures when appropriating the total |
reimbursement for each county or circuit. Any amount |
appropriated to the Supreme Court in any State fiscal year for |
the purpose of reimbursing Cook County for the salaries and |
operations of the Cook County Juvenile Temporary Detention |
Center shall not be counted in the total appropriation to the |
Supreme Court in that State fiscal year for reimbursement to |
counties for probation salaries and services, for the purposes |
of this paragraph (h). |
(Source: P.A. 93-616, eff. 1-1-04; 93-839, eff. 7-30-04; 94-91, |
eff. 7-1-05; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
|
|
Section 5-55. The Code of Civil Procedure is amended by |
changing Section 2-1009A as follows:
|
(735 ILCS 5/2-1009A) (from Ch. 110, par. 2-1009A)
|
Sec. 2-1009A. Filing Fees. In each county authorized by the |
Supreme
Court to utilize mandatory arbitration, the clerk of |
the
circuit court shall charge and collect, in addition to any |
other fees, an
arbitration fee of $8, except in counties with |
3,000,000 or more inhabitants
the fee shall be $10, at the time |
of filing the first pleading, paper
or
other appearance filed |
by each party in all civil cases, but no additional
fee shall |
be required if more than one party is represented in a single
|
pleading, paper or other appearance. Arbitration fees received |
by the
clerk of the circuit court pursuant to this Section |
shall be remitted within
one month after receipt to the State |
Treasurer for deposit into the
Mandatory Arbitration Fund, a |
special fund in the State treasury for the
purpose of funding |
mandatory arbitration programs and such other alternative
|
dispute resolution programs as may be authorized by circuit |
court rule for
operation in counties that have implemented |
mandatory arbitration, with a
separate account
being |
maintained for each county.
Notwithstanding any other |
provision of this Section to the contrary, and for
State fiscal
|
years 2004, 2005, 2006, and 2007 only, the Mandatory |
Arbitration Fund may be used
for any
other purpose authorized |
|
by the Supreme Court.
|
(Source: P.A. 93-25, eff. 6-20-03; 93-839, eff. 7-30-04; 94-91, |
eff. 7-1-05; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
|
Section 5-60. The Residential Real Property Disclosure Act |
is amended by adding Section 80 as follows: |
(765 ILCS 77/80 new)
|
Sec. 80. Predatory Lending Database Program Fund. The |
Predatory Lending Database Program Fund is created as a special |
fund in the State treasury. Subject to appropriation, moneys in |
the Fund shall be appropriated to the Illinois Housing |
Development Authority for the purpose of making grants for |
HUD-certified counseling agencies participating in the |
Predatory Lending Database Program to assist with |
implementation and development of the Predatory Lending |
Database Program.
|
Section 5-65. The Business Corporation Act of 1983 is |
amended by changing Sections 15.90 and 16.05 as follows:
|
(805 ILCS 5/15.90) (from Ch. 32, par. 15.90)
|
Sec. 15.90. Statute of limitations.
|
(a) Except as otherwise provided
in this Section and |
notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in
any other |
Section of this Act, no domestic corporation or foreign
|
|
corporation shall be obligated to pay any annual franchise tax, |
fee,
or penalty or interest thereon imposed under this Act, nor |
shall any
administrative or judicial sanction
(including |
dissolution) be imposed or enforced nor access to the courts of
|
this State be denied based upon nonpayment thereof more than 7 |
years
after the date of filing the annual report with respect |
to the period
during which the obligation for the tax, fee, |
penalty or
interest arose, unless (1) within that 7 year period |
the Secretary of State
sends a written notice to the |
corporation to the effect that (A)
administrative or judicial |
action to dissolve the corporation or revoke its
certificate of |
authority for nonpayment of a tax, fee, penalty or interest
has |
been commenced; or (B) the corporation has submitted a report
|
but has
failed to pay a tax, fee, penalty or interest required |
to be paid
therewith; or (C) a report with respect to an event |
or action giving rise
to an obligation to pay a tax, fee, |
penalty or interest is required but has
not been filed, or has |
been filed and is in error or incomplete; or (2)
the annual |
report by the corporation was filed with fraudulent
intent to |
evade taxes payable under this Act. A corporation
nonetheless |
shall be required to pay all taxes
that would have been payable |
during the most recent 7 year period due to a
previously |
unreported increase in paid-in capital that occurred prior to
|
that 7 year period and interest and penalties thereon for that |
period, except that , from February 1, 2008 through March 15, |
2008, with respect to any corporation that participates in the |
|
Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty Act of 2007, the |
corporation shall be only required to pay all taxes that would |
have been payable during the most recent 4 year period due to a |
previously unreported increase in paid-in capital that |
occurred prior to that 7 year period.
|
(b) If within 2 years following a change in control of a |
corporation the
corporation voluntarily pays in good faith all |
known obligations of
the corporation imposed by this Article 15 |
with respect to reports that
were required to have been filed |
since the beginning of the 7 year period
ending on the |
effective date of the change in control, no action shall be
|
taken to enforce or collect obligations of that corporation |
imposed by this
Article 15 with respect to reports that were |
required to have been filed
prior to that 7 year period |
regardless of whether the limitation period set
forth in |
subsection (a) is otherwise applicable. For purposes of this
|
subsection (b), a change in control means a transaction, or a |
series of
transactions consummated within a period of 180 |
consecutive days, as a
result of which a person which owned |
less than 10% of the shares having the
power to elect directors |
of the corporation acquires shares such that the
person becomes |
the holder of 80% or more of the shares having such power.
For |
purposes of this subsection (b) a person means any natural |
person,
corporation, partnership, trust or other entity |
together with all other
persons controlled by, controlling or |
under common control with such person.
|
|
(c) Except as otherwise provided in this Section and |
notwithstanding
anything to the contrary contained in any other |
Section of this Act, no foreign
corporation that has not |
previously obtained a certificate of authority under
this Act |
shall, upon voluntary application for a certificate of |
authority filed
with the Secretary of State prior to January 1, |
2001, be obligated to pay any
tax, fee, penalty, or interest |
imposed under this Act, nor shall any
administrative or |
judicial sanction be imposed or enforced based upon
nonpayment |
thereof with respect to a period during which the obligation |
arose
that is prior to January 1, 1993 unless (1) prior to |
receipt of the application
for a certificate of authority the |
Secretary of State had sent written notice
to
the corporation |
regarding its failure to obtain a certificate of authority, (2)
|
the corporation had submitted an application for a certificate |
of authority
previously but had failed to pay any tax, fee, |
penalty or interest to be paid
therewith, or (3) the |
application for a certificate of authority was submitted
by
the |
corporation with fraudulent intent to evade taxes payable under |
this Act.
A
corporation nonetheless shall be required to pay |
all taxes and fees due under
this Act that would have been |
payable since January 1, 1993 as a result of
commencing the |
transaction of its business in this State and interest thereon
|
for that period.
|
(Source: P.A. 95-233, eff. 8-16-07.)
|
|
(805 ILCS 5/16.05) (from Ch. 32, par. 16.05)
|
Sec. 16.05. Penalties and interest imposed upon |
corporations.
|
(a) Each
corporation, domestic or foreign, that fails or |
refuses to file any annual
report or report of cumulative |
changes in paid-in capital and pay any
franchise tax due |
pursuant to the report prior to the first day of its
|
anniversary month
or, in the case of a corporation which has |
established an extended filing
month, the extended filing month |
of the corporation
shall pay a penalty of 10% of the amount of |
any
delinquent franchise tax due for the report. From February |
1, 2008 through March 15, 2008, no No penalty shall be imposed |
with respect to any amount of delinquent franchise tax paid |
pursuant to the Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty Act of |
2007.
|
(b) Each corporation, domestic or foreign, that fails or |
refuses to file
a report of issuance of shares or increase in |
paid-in capital within the
time prescribed by this Act is |
subject to a penalty on any obligation
occurring prior to |
January 1, 1991, and interest on those obligations on or
after |
January 1, 1991, for each calendar month or part of month that |
it is
delinquent in the amount of 2% 1% of the amount of |
license fees and franchise
taxes provided by this Act to be |
paid on account of the issuance of shares
or increase in |
paid-in capital. From February 1, 2008 through March 15, 2008, |
no No penalty shall be imposed, or interest charged, with |
|
respect to any amount of delinquent license fees and franchise |
taxes paid pursuant to the Franchise Tax and License Fee |
Amnesty Act of 2007.
|
(c) Each corporation, domestic or foreign, that fails or |
refuses to file
a
report of cumulative changes in paid-in |
capital or report following merger
within the time prescribed |
by this Act is subject to interest on or after
January 1, 1992, |
for each calendar month or part of month that it is
delinquent, |
in the amount of 2% 1% of the amount of franchise taxes |
provided
by this Act to be paid on account of the issuance of |
shares or increase in
paid-in capital disclosed on the report |
of cumulative changes in paid-in
capital or report following |
merger, or $1, whichever is greater. From February 1, 2008 |
through March 15, 2008, no No interest shall be charged with |
respect to any amount of delinquent franchise tax paid pursuant |
to the Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty Act of 2007.
|
(d) If the annual franchise tax, or the supplemental annual |
franchise
tax
for any 12-month period commencing July 1, 1968, |
or July 1 of any
subsequent year through June 30, 1983, |
assessed in accordance with this
Act, is not paid by July 31, |
it is delinquent, and there is added a penalty
prior to January |
1, 1991, and interest on and after January 1, 1991, of 2% 1%
|
for each month or part of month that it is delinquent |
commencing with the
month of August, or $1, whichever is |
greater. From February 1, 2008 through March 15, 2008, no No |
penalty shall be imposed, or interest charged, with respect to |
|
any amount of delinquent franchise taxes paid pursuant to the |
Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty Act of 2007.
|
(e) If the supplemental annual franchise tax assessed in |
accordance with
the provisions of this Act for the 12-month |
period commencing July 1,
1967, is not paid by September 30, |
1967, it is delinquent, and there is
added a penalty prior to |
January 1, 1991, and interest on and after
January 1, 1991, of |
2% 1% for each month or part of month that it is
delinquent |
commencing with the month of October, 1967. From February 1, |
2008 through March 15, 2008, no No penalty shall be imposed, or |
interest charged, with respect to any amount of delinquent |
franchise taxes paid pursuant to the Franchise Tax and License |
Fee Amnesty Act of 2007.
|
(f) If any annual franchise tax for any period beginning on |
or after
July 1,
1983, is not paid by the time period herein |
prescribed, it is delinquent
and there is added a penalty prior |
to January 1, 1991, and interest on
and after January 1, 1991, |
of 2% 1% for each month or part of a month that
it is delinquent |
commencing with the anniversary month or in the case of
a |
corporation that has established an extended filing month, the |
extended
filing month, or $1, whichever is greater. From |
February 1, 2008 through March 15, 2008, no No penalty shall be |
imposed, or interest charged, with respect to any amount of |
delinquent franchise taxes paid pursuant to the Franchise Tax |
and License Fee Amnesty Act of 2007.
|
(g) Any corporation, domestic or foreign, failing to pay |
|
the prescribed
fee for assumed corporate name renewal when due |
and payable shall be given
notice of nonpayment by the |
Secretary of State by regular mail; and if
the fee together |
with a penalty fee of $5 is not paid within
90 days after the |
notice is mailed, the right to use the assumed
name shall |
cease.
|
(h) Any corporation which (i) puts forth any sign or
|
advertisement, assuming
any name other than that by which it is |
incorporated or otherwise
authorized by law to act or (ii) |
violates Section 3.25, shall be guilty of
a Class C misdemeanor |
and
shall be deemed guilty of an additional offense for each |
day it shall
continue to so offend.
|
(i) Each corporation, domestic or foreign, that fails or |
refuses (1) to
file in the office of the recorder within the |
time prescribed
by this Act any document required by this Act |
to be so filed, or (2) to
answer truthfully and fully within |
the time prescribed by this Act
interrogatories propounded by |
the Secretary of State in accordance with
this Act, or (3) to |
perform any other act required by this Act to be
performed by |
the corporation, is guilty of a Class C misdemeanor.
|
(j) Each corporation that fails or refuses to file articles |
of
revocation
of dissolution within the time prescribed by this |
Act is subject to a
penalty for each calendar month or part of |
the month that it is delinquent
in the amount of $50.
|
(Source: P.A. 95-233, eff. 8-16-07.)
|
|
Section 5-70. The Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty Act |
of 2007 is amended by changing Section 5-10 and by adding |
Section 5-6 as follows: |
(805 ILCS 8/5-6 new)
|
Sec. 5-6. The Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty |
Administration Fund. The Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty |
Administration Fund is created as a special fund in the State |
treasury. The Fund shall consist of any fund transfers, fees, |
or moneys from other sources received for the purpose of |
funding the administration of this Act. All moneys in the |
Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty Administration Fund shall |
be used, subject to appropriation, by the Secretary for any |
costs associated with the administration of this Act. |
(805 ILCS 8/5-10)
|
Sec. 5-10. Amnesty program. The Secretary shall establish |
an amnesty program for all taxpayers owing any franchise tax or |
license fee imposed by Article XV of the Business Corporation |
Act of 1983. The amnesty program shall be for a period from |
February 1, 2008 through March 15, 2008. The amnesty program |
shall provide that, upon payment by a taxpayer of all franchise |
taxes and license fees due from that taxpayer to the State of |
Illinois for any taxable period, the Secretary shall abate and |
not seek to collect any interest or penalties that may be |
applicable, and the Secretary shall not seek civil or criminal |
|
prosecution for any taxpayer for the period of time for which |
amnesty has been granted to the taxpayer. Failure to pay all |
taxes due to the State for a taxable period shall not |
invalidate any amnesty granted under this Act with respect to |
the taxes paid pursuant to the amnesty program. Amnesty shall |
be granted only if all amnesty conditions are satisfied by the |
taxpayer. Amnesty shall not be granted to taxpayers who are a |
party to any criminal investigation or to any civil or criminal |
litigation that is pending in any circuit court or appellate |
court or the Supreme Court of this State for nonpayment, |
delinquency, or fraud in relation to any franchise tax or |
license fee imposed by Article XV of the Business Corporation |
Act of 1983. Voluntary payments made under this Act shall be |
made by cash, check, guaranteed remittance, or ACH debit. The |
Secretary shall adopt rules as necessary to implement the |
provisions of this Act. Except as otherwise provided in this |
Section, all money collected under this Act that would |
otherwise be deposited into the General Revenue Fund shall be |
deposited into the General Revenue Fund. Two percent of all |
money collected under this Act shall be deposited by the State |
Treasurer into the Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty |
Administration Department of Business Services Special |
Operations Fund and, subject to appropriation, shall be used by |
the Secretary to cover costs associated with the administration |
of this Act.
|
(Source: P.A. 95-233, eff. 8-16-07.)
|